Skip to main content

Full text of "Sar Bachan"

See other formats


SAR BACHAN 
RADHASOAMI 

(Poetry) 

OF 

PARAM PURUSH PURAN DHANI 

SOAMIJI MAHARAJ 

(Part I) 

Translated into English Prose 



by 



S.D. MAHESHWARI, M.Sc. 

Personal Assistant to Babuji Maharaj 

RADHASOAMI SATSANG 

Soami Bagh, Agra (India) 



Published by : 

MRS. RITA MAHESHWARI 

Soami Bagh, Agra-282005. (India) 



First Edition : 1970 1000 Copies 
Second Edition : 1981 1000 Copies 
Third Edition : 2001 1000 Copies 

AN Rights Reserved 



Price 

Inland Rupees 50.00 

Foreign : U.S. Dollars 6.50 
Pounds 4.00 



Printed by : 
ALOK MEHRA at J K. Offset Printer, 315 Jama Masjid. Delhi 





SOAMIJI MAHARAJ 
1818 - 1878 



HUZUR MAHARAJ 

1829 - 1898 





MAHARAJ SAHEB 

1861 - 1907 



BABUJI MAHARAJ 

1861 - 1949 




SANT DAS MAHESHWARI 

(1910- 1983) 



Maharaj Saheb and Babuji Maharaj had prayed to Huzur Maharaj 
to write some book in English ooRadhasoami Faith. Huzur 
Maharaj observed that as both of them were M.A.'s in English 
Literature, they should themselves write. Maharaj Saheb dictated 
one book in English known as "Discourses on Radhasoami 
Faith" but left its last chapter on "Karams (actions)" incomplete 
due to His failing health and eventual departure to His Original 
Abode. Babuji Maharaj did not write any book. Sant Das 
Maheshwari M.Sc. alias Sant Das Ji, Personal Assistant to 
Babuji Maharaj, wrote mainly in English, translated into English 
the entire literature of the Radhasoami Faith, including Soamiji 
Maharaj's "Sar Bachan Radhasoami Poetry", brought out many 
original books and also completed the chapter left incomplete 
by Maharaj Saheb, thus fulfilling the mission which Huzur Maharaj 
had assigned to Maharaj Saheb and Babuji Maharaj. 

He brought out the esoteric meaning of the great Indian epic 
Ramayan in 1952 in Hindi under the title of 'Ramayan ka Gurh 
Rahasya'. 

While translating, into English, the elucidation of Jap// as 
given out by Soamiji Maharaj, Sant Das ji revealed the names 
of the heavenly spheres, which Soamiji Maharaj had not then 
disclosed in His Mauj. 



TRANSLATOR'S NOTE 



"Sar Bachan Radhasoami Poetry" is the most 
important treatise on Radhasoami Faith, being the 
original and authentic exposition of the principles of 
the Faith, the genesis and evolution of creation, the 
status and position of other religions vis-a-vis Sant 
Mat, the scope and method of devotional practices 
as enjoined in the Radhasoami Faith and their effi- 
cacy as compared with the Yogic and other prac- 
tices taught by other faiths, and the necessity for the 
advent of the Supreme Being as Sant Sat Guru in 
this world for effecting the emancipation of the soul, 
and the need for opening up a royal road of Surat 
Shabd Yoga for taking the Jiva to the Inaccessible 
Region. 

"Sar Bachan Radhasoami Poetry" is in two parts, 
consisting of forty two Bachans or chapters. The first 
part begins with the most High. It opens with the 
sublimity and efficacy of RADHASOAMI Nam, the true, 
real and Dhwanyatmak Name of the Supreme Being: 

RADHASOAMI Nam whoever recites 
gets across the ocean of life; 
his troubles vanish, bliss abides 
and gone's complete all strife. 

In the domain of Kal and Maya, the Jiva is ut- 
terly helpless. He is badly engrossed in passions and 



desires. The Supreme Father Radhasoami Dayal in 
His unbounded grace and mercy reveals the secrets 
of His August Abode, and saves the Jiva from the 
clutches of Kal and Maya. The second part of "Sar 
Bachan Radhasoami Poetry" is a vivid description of 
the Jiva's homeward journey, with all the details of 
the regions and stages on the way. It is an account 
of his rising from below and merging in the Ultimate. 
It opens thus — 

Was created a Chaupar of four species of life. 
The scripture closes with a strong, positive note — 

RADHASOAMI HAS NOW DEVOURED ALL 
meaning that Radhasoami has emancipated all. 

The editing of the manuscript was done by Huzur 
Maharaj, second Sant Sat Guru of the parent line of 
the Radhasoami Faith. The preface to the scripture 
was also written by Him. The first edition of the scripture 
in Hindi was published in January 1884. A.D. under 
the joint authority of Huzur Maharaj and Lala Pratap 
Singh Seth, the youngest brother of Soamiji Maharaj. 
On the title page of the first edition is written — 

Published 

under the joint authority of 

Rai Salig Ram Bahadur 

the chief and most devoted disciple 

and 

Lala Pratap Singh Saheb 

the youngest brother 

of 
Radhasoami Saheb 



The first edition of the English translation of "Sar 
Bachan Radhasoami Poetry" is being brought out by 
the undersigned on 24 August, Monday, 1970 A.D. 
the day of Soamiji Maharaj's annual Bhandara. 

Soamiji Maharaj, the incarnation of the Supreme 
Being Radhasoami Dayal, was born on Monday, 
Janmashtmi, the eighth day of the dark half of the 
month of Bhadon in 1875 Vikram, corresponding to 
twentyfourth August, 1818 A.D. Janmashtmi of the Vikram 
calendar and twentyfourth August of the Gregorian, 
seldom fall together and that too on Monday. It is a 
rare and unique coincidence that the first edition of 
the English translation of this scripture is brought out 
also on a day which is Janmashtmi according to Vikram 
calendar as well as the 24th August, a Monday of 
the Gregorian calendar. 



Janmashtmi, Samvat 2027 Vikram, 
Monday, 24th August, 1970 A.D. 





y^im si-oiHi chi 




"W 


TW4JH 


TPTT 




^^T 


15 




TTfMf^m 


26 


!. 


^?r 


30 




smift 


32 


2. 


ftwd utiiwml ^m ^D 


40 


3. 


Mf^l WT T£F% IP ^S TMIHIHl ^t # 1% TTfT 

W|S ^1 *JTW + <=£ ril^t 3-.&K "4Nf ^ ^FTW f 






"srara ^q, 3lU ^H 3fa Tffa ^<£ ^T^ +=W *f 


42 


4. 


TTfpri ^#T WT "5^ TJH M^ TTMI-Wml efrf 3ffc 






o^H "^Tl ifa afa; jqpf^ Sf>l iU+1 "MlfccT 3 


88 


5. 


^"fa "^ Hl J f #fa jjiliMi ^Tlell* *l afk hP^hi 

fr^T W^M 3?fc f^rST WR WT "J^T ""JJFI *Rt 






"u^R^mt ^t 


100 


6. 


m$$\ ^ ^^r ^ ti-ft ti*h^i41 <£ ^T*n 






^■fi H 


115 


7. 


f^Hdl ^lk wefar wr g^ ^ tnl Tmswi4t ^ 






^<H *^d A' 


161 


8. 


H^MI yd J Jt> W^q TfVRSlI^ ^ 


167 


9. 


HU^\ ¥K W<M ^d'J,^ *1 


201 


10. 


fnutij ^ ^Kf^r ^ sfn 


218 



10 



12. 


3#t *reicm 'qfaR m 




237 


U. 


w^h ^ "3? "^ 3ff< tf4 wM '3H 




243 




MR'^r-i wfi*ff ^t 




243 




fsriV i<# ait 




244 




fafa ^ti -^ft 




245 




TJSPT cR $3 ^T 




245 




\ „ -l _\ 




246 




_-"l S . jl_ _-,-f!r-^ _ _ry -A— j - * 

ws$ *ft str *p[ ^t w 




247 




"^ "grw afrt Pud ^ ^r ^rrft 3TcR ar^jra 




247 


14. 


f^ara^t *Ff t^ti 




252 


15. 


f^dirdRt Ml'M '^H<I 




265 


16. 


P=ldl<=Hl "HPl dlWW, <JM<^I WJ? ^f*i oFl 




292 


1 I. 


f3c1M-fl A&f) 3F3, ^1 ^^ 




300 


18. 


•5^?I ®ft|p Hfel ^T 




304 


19. 


dM<^l *£§ affa ?T^ Sl^m ^FR qfet ^R 




322 


20. 


^?r grd '?r< <$ ^^TTH %i 




351 


21. 


f^4?Rm[- 




385 




7T^ 5^» SWfff "5FJT sftr % 7F^ TTF 1 ^ afo ^ 





11 



Contents 



Bachan 

or 

Chapter Subject Page 

Bhoomika (Preface) 15 

MANGLACHARAN 26 

1. SANDESH (MESSAGE) 30 
Advent of Param Purush Puran Dhani 
Radhasoami as Sant Sat Guru for the 

salvation of Jivas 30 

2. Attributes of RADHASOAMI Nam 40 

3. In praise of Param Purush Puran Dhani 
Radhasoami who incarnated Himself here 
as Sant Sat Guru for the redemption of Jivas. 
Importance of love for and faith in His 

august Feet. 42 

4 The glory and importance of Darshan of 

Param Purush Puran Dhani Radhasoami 
and the exalted state of love and bliss which 
His Darshan brings in 88 

5. Secrets of the Path. The glory of Sat Lok. 
The majestic grandeur of the true form and 
true abode of Param Purush Puran Dhani 
Radhasoami 100 

6. Arti (hymn of praise and salutation) at the 
holy feet of Param Purush Puran Dhani 
Radhasoami 115 

7. Binti and Prarthna (prayer) at the holy feet 

of Param Purush Puran Dhani Radhasoami 161 

8. Eminence of Radhasoami as Sat Guru 167 



12 

9. In praise of Sat Guru as the embodiment of 

Shabd 201 

10. Shabd or Nam 218 

11. Importance of Satsang and revelation of Sat 

Nam (True Name) 226 

12. Importance of Bhakti (devotion) 237 

13. Characteristics of a perfect Guru and true 
Parmarthi 243 

Test of a Parmarthi 243 

Mode of Darshan 244 

Mode of Sewa 245 

Sewa by body 245 

Sewa by riches 246 

Sewa by mind and intellect 247 

Sewa by Surat and Nirat 247 

14. Chitaoni (admonition) Part 1 252 

15. Chitaoni (admonition) Part 2 265 

16. Chitaoni (admonition) Part 3 

Devotion to Sat Guru 292 

17. Chitaoni (admonition) to Bhekhs, Part 4 300 

18. Devotion to Sat Guru 304 

19. Devotion to Guru and Nam 322 

20. The Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga 351 

21. HIDAYAT-NAMA 385 

Revelation made in the course of 
teachings imparted about the value of 
association with, and service of, the perfect 
Guide, and about the different grades of 
adepts, and instructions concerning the 
practice of Shabd, the secrets of Shabd 
Marg (Yoga) with details of the stages on 
the journey to the Highest Region. 

GHAZALS 394-399 






RADHASOAMI DAYAL Kl DAYA 
RADHASOAMI SAHAI 



GRANT 
MERCIFUL RADHASOAMI 

THY 
GRACE & PROTECTION 



RADHASOAMI DAYAL Kl DAYA 
RADHASOAMI SAHAI 

BHOOMIKA 

(Preface) 

Originally written in Hindi 

by 

Rai Salig Ram Bahadur alias Huzur Maharaj, 
the second Sant Sat Guru of the Radhasoami Faith 



1. This scripture was written to the dictation 

of Huzur Radhasoami Saheb Himself. He had no intention 
to compose any Bani. 1 But some devoted Satsangis 2 
and Sansangins 3 persistently beseeched Him, and He 
was pleased to accede to their prayer. 

2. Soamiji Maharaj was born at Panni Gali in 
the city of Agra, at half past twelve on the night of 

the eighth day of the dark half of the month of Bhadon, 
Samvat 1875 of Vikram calendar (corresponding to 
August 1818 A.D.) Since the tender age of six-seven 
years, He started explaining Parmarth 4 of the highest 
order to selected men and women. 



1. Sacred writing in verse. 2. Followers or devotees of the 
Radhasomai Faith. 3. Women-devotees of the Faith. 
4. Religion. 



16 ] Bhoomika 

3. . Soamiji Maharaj had no Guru, nor did He 
receive instructions in Parmarth from anyone. On the 
other hand, He explained Parmarth to His parents 
and a number of Sadhus 1 who came to Him. 

4. For about fifteen years, Soamiji Maharaj used 
to shut Himself up in a room which is within another 
room. He was all the time absorbed in the bliss of 
Surat Shabd Yoga 2 . He would not come out for two 

or three days at a stretch; He would not even feel a 
call of nature. 

5. For more than a year, some Satsangis and 
Satsangins had been imploring His august graciousness 
for the establishment of general Satsang 21 . Soamiji 
Maharaj accepted their prayer. He was pleased to 

start delivering regular discourses on, and giving initiation 
to Parmarthi 4 Jivas into, Sant Mat 5 at His residence, 
on the Basant Panchami day in Samvat 1917 Vikram 
(February 15, 1861 A.D.) This Satsang continued day 
and night for over seventeen years. About three thousand 
persons were initiated into Sant Mat, Radhasoami 
Faith. They were mostly Hindus from different Provinces 
(States). Some Mohammedans, Jains and Christians 
were also initiated. About two or three hundred of 
them were Sadhus and the rest were house-holders. 
Those who devoted themselves of Abhyas 6 with zeal 
and earnestness, came often to Soamiji Maharaj for 
His Darshan 7 and for taking further instructions in 
the performance of Abhyas and understanding its secrets 

1. Recluses, 2. Yoga enjoining Spirit and Sound practice, 

3. Association or meeting or congregation of devotees, 

4. Religious minded, 5. Religion of Sants (Saints). 6. Devotional 
exercises, Spiritual practices. 7. Interview, 



Preface [ 17 

and mysteries. On realizing the immense powers of 
Soamiji Maharaj in their devotional practices and expe- 
riencing His internal grace and mercy, they were deeply 
impressed, and they engendered profound love for 
and faith in His Holy Feet. At present, there are about 
a hundred men and women engaged in the devotional 
practices of the Radhasoami Faith at Agra; about 
forty are Sadhus. These Sadhus had renounced the 
world in search of Parmarth. On hearing of the glory 
and eminence of Soamiji Maharaj, they came to His 
august presence, received initiation from Him, and 
applied themselves to Abhyas. When they experienced 
some bliss in Abhyas and Satsang, they stayed permanently 
at Agra. These Sadhus are now living in Radhasoami 
Bagh (Soami Bagh) which is at a distance of about 
three miles from the city proper. Some Satsangis who 
are householders reside in the house of Soamiji Maharaj 
in the city. They are engaged in devotional practices. 

6. Radhasoami Faith is also known as Sant 
Mat. In the past, the teachings of Sant Mat were imparted 
only to the deserving few; people, in general, remained 
unacquainted with it. Its practices were performed through 
the medium of Pranayam 1 , the restraints which it calls 
for, are too rigid to be observed, and even involve 
the risk of life. Few, therefore, dared to tread that 
path. Now Huzur Radhasoami Saheb (Soamiji Maharaj), 
in His grace and mercy, has introduced such an easy 
method of Surat Shabd Yoga that everybody, man or 
woman, young or old, who has true yearning and zeal, 
can successfully perform it. 



Practice of restraining or suspending breath. 



18] Bhoomika 

7. No one had, in the past, introduced such an 
easy mode of spiritual practices. For this reason, the 
internal practices of all the extant religions of the 
world have lost their importance. Their followers are 
now simply engaged in outward worships, rituals and 
observances. They are wholly ignorant of the true Supreme 
Being, the Abhyas by which He could be attained 

and the secrets of the path and intermediate stages. 

8. Three essentials of the Radhasoami Faith 
are Guru, Nam and Sang (i.e., Satsang), and these 
are the means of salvation. First of all, Guru must 
be true and perfect, that is, He must be Sant Sat 
Guru. Hereditary or family gurus would not serve the 
purpose. Secondly, Nam (Name, Word) must also be 
true and real, and of the highest stage. One must be 
initiated into the secrets of that Nam and its Nami 
(Deity). Conventional names would not be of any help. 
Thirdly, one must get true Satsang. Satsang is of 

two kinds, internal and external. Internal Satsang consists 
in raising the spirit inward and upward and uniting it 
with the Holy Feet of Sat Purush Radhasoami or in 
turning the attention in that direction. External Satsang 
consists in listening to the discourses, getting Darshan 
of true and perfect Sant or Sadh, who is the incarnation 
of Sat Purush, and in rendering whole-hearted service 
to Him. By attending Satsang and performing Abhyas 
for some time, one would clearly observe a change 
and improvement in one's condition and spiritual 
advancement. 



1. Darshan = Seeing, looking, observing; sight, vision, look, 
view; going into the presence of, visiting, an interview. 



Preface [ 19 

9. The other so-called Parmarthi 1 activities, such 
as pilgrimage, fasts, worship of idols, recitation of 
hymns, Japa 2 and Sumiran (repetition) of conventional 
names would not produce the desired elevation of 
spirit. As these activities do not affect Nij Mana (higher 
mind) and Surat (spirit), one's condition will not improve. 
Of course, some outward joy or satisfaction may be 

felt, but ego will get strengthened. 

10. Surat, which is an emanation from Sat Purush 
Radhasoami, is a mighty essence (in this body) through 
the potency of which the whole of our body, mind 

and all the sense organs are performing their respective 
functions. Sants exhort Jivas 3 to be most careful about 
this essence, and turn it towards its true source and 
reservoir. When this is done in right earnest, transformation 
and advancement would come about automatically and 
the world and its objects would begin gradually to 
appear insignificant and worthless. The seat of this 
essence (Surat) is behind the eyes. From there, it 
spreads and permeates the whole body, vitalizing ali 
physical parts and limbs. The source and reservoir 
of this essence is the Adi Shabd (Prime Sound). 

11. The Adi Shabd is "SOAMI", the Creator of 
all. The Adi Surat (Prime Spirit or Current) is His first 
manifestation, and is called '"RADHA". They are also 
known as Shabd and Surat. As these Currents came 
down, other Shabds originated from Adi Shabd and 
other Surats (spirits) emerged from Adi Surat, and Surat 
emanated from Shabd, and Shabd from Surat, and so 
on, taking their location at their respective planes. 

1. Religious, spiritual. 2. Muttering prayer. 3. Human beings. 



20] Bhoomika 

12. The importance of Shabd has been stressed 
in every religion. But a detailed description of Shabds 
is nowhere to be found. For this reason people are 
ignorant of Shabd. Now Radhasoami Saheb (Soamiji 
Maharaj) has given out in clear terms the details and 
secrets of Shabds (sounds) of different heavenly spheres 
in this scripture. 

13. These are explained below : — 

The origin of all is Radhasoami, the Supreme 
Being. In His region, Shabd is infinitely subtle. There 
is nothing in this world which resembles IT. Sat Purush 
originated from this Shabd. 

First is the Shabd of Sat Purush. It is also known 
as Sat Nam or Sat Shabd. By His omnipotence were 
evolved Sohang Purush, Par-Brahm, Brahm and Maya. 

Second is the Shabd of Sohang Purush. 

Third is the Shabd of Par-Brahm, which maintains 
and sustains the creation of the three Loks (worlds). 

Fourth is the Shabd of Brahm. It is also called 
Pranava. This Shabd created subtle or Brahmandi 
Veda and Ishwari Maya. 

Fifth is the Shabd of Maya and Brahm which 
evolved the material for the creation of Triloki (the 
three worlds), and the Akashi Veda. 

Below the Shabd of Maya appeared the Shabds 
of Bairat Purush, Jiva and Mana (mind). 

14. In these times, those who speak of Shabd 



Preface [ 21 

Abhyas, have knowledge of the Shabds of lower regions 
only; they are not at all aware of the Shabds of higher 
regions. Some take the Shabd of Bairat Purush to 
be the creator of all, while others speak of the Shabd 
which is an admixture of the Shabds of Maya and 
Brahm; even then, they are ignorant of its origin and 
efficacy, and of the actual methods by which it can 
be attained. All these Shabds are described in detail 
in "Sar Bachan Radhasoami" (Poetry). 

15. Radhasoami Faith or Sant Mat is the path 
of Bhakti (devotion). It stipulates sincere love for and 
faith in the Holy Feet of the true Supreme Being. It 
is also known as Upasana and Tariqat (worship .and 
devotion). Emphasis is laid on Sant Sat Guru or Sadh 
Guru or Their real Shabd forms. 

Sant Sat Guru is He who has reached Sat Lok 
and Radhasoami Abode. Sadh Guru is He who has 
attained Brahm or Par Brahm stage, and the devotees 
who have not yet reached this stage are called Sadhs 
or Satsangis. 

The real form of Sant Sat Guru and Sadh Guru 
is Their Shabd form. They assume human form for 
the purpose of imparting spiritual training and doing 
good to Jivas, and effecting their salvation. If it is 
believed that a certain personage is a perfect Sant 
or a Sadh, then no difference need be made between 
Him and Sat Purush (or Par-Brahm). Therefore, whenever 
such a personage makes His advent, His devotees 
treat Him as Sat Purush (or Par-Brahm) and worship 
and render service to Him, and perform His Arti the 
same way as they would if they had actually met the 



22] Bhoomika 

Supreme Being. By rendering service to Him, having 
His Darshan, listening to His discourses, engendering 
love for and faith in His Holy Feet, and performing 
the practices taught by Him, Jiva-Atma or Surat (spirit) 
will get detached from the snares of Mana and Maya, 
and will ascend to heavens and beyond, and will merge 
in the internal form or Shabd and will secure true 
and perfect salvation. 

16. A seeker must find out the perfect Sant or 
Sadh; he should continue his efforts till he meets Him. 
If he comes across any of His Satsangis or devotees, 
who has been fully benefited by His Darshan and 
Sewa (service) and, having been initiated in Shabd 
Marg 1 , is performing Abhyas, the seeker should engender 
love for such a devotee. He should learn from him 

the secrets of the path, the stages thereon and the 
method of performing Abhyas (devotional practice). 
He should commence this practice, adopting the Isht 2 
of the Holy Feet of Radhasoami who is the Lord of 
all. Every Parmarthi should have a firm determination 
to reach there. If his love, yearning and faith are sincere 
and firm, the true Supreme Being would, in His grace, 
grant him His Darshan one day, and complete his task. 

17. RADHASOAMI Nam was revealed by the 
Supreme Being Himself. When the humble devotees 
of Soamiji Maharaj, as a result of their successful 
Abhyas (devotional practices) and Satsang, came to 
realize His exalted position and immense spiritual powers, 
and when He too, in His grace and mercy, enabled 
them to recognize Him, they started addressing Him 

1. Surat Shabd Yoga. 2. Goal 



Preface [ 23 

by the appellation of RADHASOAMI, the Name of 
the Original Abode from where He made His advent 
to this world, for showering His grace on Jivas in 
this Kali Yuga. 

18. The principles prevalent among the followers 
of Upasna and Tariqat (worship and devotion) cult, 

are also observed in Sant Mat. No distinction is made 
between the perfect Sat Guru or Preceptor and the 
Supreme Being. Hence Sat Guru is addressed by 
the appellation, which is the true and real name of 
the region, whence He is pleased to come here. 
Radhasoami and Surat Shabd have the same 
connotation. As ocean is to its waves, so is Shabd 
to its Dhun (resonance), and what a beloved is to 
a lover, Shabd is to Surat. 

19. The followers of this Faith, who practise Surat 
Shabd Yoga would, in a short time, come to realize 
what a rare and precious gift they have secured. They 
would see for themselves that their salvation is being 
worked out day by day. The goals, status, source, 
origin, reach and access of all the extant religions of 
the world, will automatically be revealed or unfolded 

to them. 

20. This Faith and its Abhyas are meant specially 
for those who have a longing for meeting the true 
Supreme Being and who are sincerely keen about 

the welfare and salvation of their souls. It is not intended 
for, nor would it appeal to, those who are after the. 
objects of the world, name, fame, and learning, and 
for whom religion is only a means of livelihood. On 
the other hand, they would try their utmost to calumniate 



24] Bhoomika 

and ridicule these teachings, the reason being that 
they are afraid lest, by acting upon them, they be 
deprived of worldly and sensual pleasures and their 
livelihood may be affected. They would make every 
effort to retard the propagation of this Religion, so 
that those whom they have kept under delusions and 
entangled in various kinds of worship and made the 
source of their livelihood, may not leave their fold, 
and their worship and income may not be affected. 



Radhasoami Satsang, 

Soami Bagh, Agra (India), 
January, 1884 A. D. 



TRANSLATION 



OF 



SAR BACHAN 
RADHASOAMI 

(Poetry) 



OF 



SOAMIJI MAHARAJ 



Part I 



MANGLACHARAN 



Benediction; prayer for the success of anything; 
pronouncing a blessing; wishing joy, congratulation 



Manglacharan [ 27 

TTOIWIUT ^TTR, sit 7n^ #£ rft I 
•$& -$&$ ^R ^W, T§5 ^ TER ^1 1& il 1 II 

(1) 

RADHASOAMI Nam whoever recites, 
gets across the ocean of life; 
troubles vanish, bliss abides, 
and gone's complete all strife. 

(2) 

Such is this unfathomable Name 
that to none ITS secrets are known, 
he who comes to know the same 
is no more on the earth born. 

(3) 

By reciting RADHASOAMI Nam 
let thy life most fruitful be; 
this is the true and real Nam 
keep IT innermost within thee. 

(4) 

Wondrous is SOAMI's grandeur; 
except RADHA, the Spirit Prime, 
no one can see the splendour, 
supreme, spiritual, sublime. 

(5) 

In form and state not manifest 
is RADHASOAMI Nam in that place; 
there none can reach and rest 
without His mercy and grace. 



28 ] Manglacharan 

I pay my obeisance before Radhasoami by whose 
grace and mercy, innumerable Jivas are being 
awakened. (6) 

I bow again and again before Sat Guru and before the 
Lotus Region and Satnam. (7) 

He is the beginning of all, but Himself without a beginning. 
He is Anarm since times immemorial. He has 
come here from His august abode as Sant 
Incarnate. (8) 

He has launched a boat in the ocean (of existence) to 
enable Jivas to get across. He mercifully takes us in 
the boat. (9) 

He convinces the Jivas of the efficacy of Shabd and 
discloses to them the secret of Surat. He saves them 
from Karam and Bharam (rites and rituals, illusions 
and delusions) (10) 

/ bow before Him ten million times. I prostrate myself 
before Him thousand million times, and again prostrate 
hundred thousand million times. I have found 
RADHASOAMI. The very Spring and Fountain-head 
of Bhakti (devotion) has been revealed to me. (11) 

He teaches a unique mode of Bhakti (devotion), of which 
the Vedas and other scriptures had no idea. (12) 

Sat Purush abides in the fourth Lok. There, Sants dwell 
in everlasting beatitude. (13) 

The secrets of that abode are revealed by perfect 

Guru. There resounds a wonderful melody of the Bin 
(harp). (14) 



Manglacharan [ 29 

Beyond is the Darbar (sphere) of Alakh Purush, 
which can only be perceived by Surat (or spirit 
entity). (15) 

Above that is Agam Lok which is unique. Only Sant- 
Surats enjoy that bliss. (16) 

From there is visible the eternal terrace of the most 
marvellous mansion of the Supreme Father 
RADHASOAMI DAYAL. (17) 

My Surat is now in an exalted state of ecstasy; it has 
merged in Anami Purush. (18) 



^?T 



BACHAN 1 



SANDESH (MESSAGE) 



ADVENT OF PARAM PURUSH PURAN 

DHANI RADHASOAMI AS SANT 

SAT GURU FOR THE 

SALVATION OF J I VAS 



This is to communicate to the Adhikaris (deserving 
persons) the message that the Supreme Being 
Radhasoami, finding the humanity badly confounded 
and in great distress, manifested Himself as Sant 
Sat Guru. In His unbounded mercy, He revealed the 
mysteries of His own sphere and the mode of attaining 
it by means of Surat Shabd practice. It behoves Jivas 
to develop love for His Holy Feet. 

By the performance of this practice, the mind 
will get subdued. There is no other way in this Kali 
Yuga for purifying and quieting the mind and raising 
it to higher regions. The goals of all the religions 
prevalent in this world reach up to the first or, at the 
most, the second stage of Sants. If the Abhyas of 
Surat Shabd Yoga is performed methodically, the mind 
and spirit will be purified, and, catching hold of Shabd, 
will ascend to celestial regions represented in the 
human microcosm. Leaving Pind, the region of nine 



Bachan 1 ] Message [ 31 

orifices, they will reach Brahmand, i.e., Trikuti. There 
the spirit will part company with the mind, and proceed 
further. Experiencing the bliss of Sunn and Maha-Sunn, 
the spirit will have Darshan of Sat Purush in Sat 
Lok, of Alakh Purush in Alakh Lok, and of Agam 
Purush in Agam Lok. Finally, it will reach the Nij Dham 
of RADHASOAMI. It was from this place that the spirit 
originally descended. It got entangled in the snares 
of Kal, laid out in Triloki (three worlds or Loks). It 
will get back to its original abode. 

A practitioner of Surat Shabd Yoga will pass 
through Vishnu Lok, Shiv Lok, Brahma ka Lok, Shakti 
Lok, Krishna Lok, Ram Lok, Brahm and Par-brahm 
Pad, Nirvan Pad of Jains, the region of Lord God of 
the Bible, the region of the Christ and the regions of 
Malkoot, Jabroot and Lahoot of Mohammedans, all 
situated below Sunn. Experiencing the bliss of these 
regions, the spirit will enter into its Nij Desh (Original 
Home) by the grace of Sants. 



32 ] Arti [ Bachan 

Shabd 1 

*r&t ft wst faw 3Tpm ^r i 

WcJ 3RTtT 3TT^ T£PJ ^T% il S tl 

Come my dear companions, let us sing Arti. In this 
seasion of Basant (Spring), the Purush (Supreme 
Being), the Ancient of ancients, has graciously 
made His advent here. (1) 

He reveals the secrets of Alakh and Agam. He declares 
His Name RADHASOAMI. (2) 

He has opened the rail track of Surat Shabd Yoga. 
He takes Jivas to Agam Lok, the inaccessible 
region. (3) 

He daily holds Satsang, where the praises of RADHASOAMI 
are sung every moment. (4) 

Let us offer our hearts to Him in perfect devotion. 
He cuts away the snares of Kal and drives away 
the afflictions caused by him.. (5) 

He is the infinite and omnipotent Being. May I fix my 
eyes and continue gazing at Him. (6) 



am suffering from intense Virah (pangs of yearning), 
as if my heart has been pierced with a dagger. 



(7) 



I cannot be at rest until I get His Darshan face to 
face. The whole world and all that pertains to it 
appear like poison to me. (8) 

Radhasoami is a reservoir of Amrit (nectar). I will be 



1 ] Arti [ 33 

satisfied only if I am allowed to drink it to my 

heart's content. (9) 

Nothing pleases me except Radhasoami. The four 

Loks (regions) are of little avail to me. (10) 

I have discarded all Gyan (knowledge), Dhyan (contem- 
plation), Jog (meditation) and Vairag (renunciation) 
as worthless devices. (11) 

I am like a Chakor 1 and Radhasoami is like the moon 
to me. Satnam Anami does not attract me. (12) 

A fish cannot live without water. A black-bee cannot 

stay in tranquillity without lotus. (13) 

A Papiha 2 remains thirsty without Swanti 3 rain. A mother 
cannot bear separation from her son. (14) 

This exactly has been the state of my restless trepi- 
dation. None understands, whom should I confide 
to ? (15) 

It is Radhasoami alone who can bestow any gift on 
me. There is no other being so omniscient. (16) 

If there is such an exclusive Bhakti (devotion), it shall 
cut asunder all sorts of bondages of this multi- 
coloured mind. (17) 

I always sing the praises of Radhasoami in all grateful- 
ness, I sacrifice my heart at His Holy Feet. (18) 

1. A kind of bird said to feed upon moon beams. 2. A 

species of cuckoo. 3. Rain which falls when the moon is 
in the fifteenth lunar mansion. 



34 ] Arti [ Bachan 

How far should I describe His unbounded Mehar (grace)! 
New waves of Daya (mercy) flow from Him every 
day. (19) 

How can worldly people understand His beatitude! It 
is the Hans Jivas (high class spiritual beings) 
who appreciate it and attain peace. (20) 

My luck took such a favourable turn this time that 

I have come under the protection of Radhasoami.(21) 

Vast reservoirs of Bhakti (Devotion) and Prem (Love) 
have opened up. Myriads of Jivas are now being 
redeemed. (22) 

Praises of Radhasoami are resounding in all the four 
directions. It seems as if the region of Kal would 
be depopulated. (23) 

My merciful Soami ( Lord) has, in His Mauj and pleasure, 
ordained that those who become Din (humble) 
will be redeemed. (24) 

I, a worthless slave at His Holy Feet, give assurance 
of redemption to all the Jivas. (25) 

Withdraw your Surat (spirit current) from all directions, 
fix it at the Holy Feet and enjoy the infinite bliss 
of Ami (ambrosia). (26) 

How should I describe the grandeur of the Sabha 
(congregation) of Hansas? There raineth showers 
of Shabds. (27) 

There are flashes of lightning and the resounding of 
thunder. What more should I say about that wondrous 
glory ? ' (28) 



1 ] Arti [ 35 

The streams of Banknal are gushing forth. Rivers of 
Sukhmana have washed away the bridge of 
delusions. (29) 

At Trikuti I cleanse myself of all impurities, and at 

Man-Sarovar I am rid of all perversity. (30) 

My Surat (spirit) attaining the status of a Hansa, merges 
in the inaccessible Shabd of the region of Sunn 
and penetrates further. (31) 

I reach the top of Maha-Sunn. Radhasoami is pleased 
with me. (32) 

I open" the window of Bhanwargupha and hear the 

voice of Sat Purush. (33) 

Hansas come forward to receive the new entrant (Surat). 
They have come to take me to Alakh Lok. (34) 

The paragon Surat goes in and gets Darshan of Alakh 
Purush. (35) 

Songs of congratulations are being sung there. All 
Hansas (denizens of Alakh Lok) jointly perform 
Arti. (36) 

I effect my ingress into Agam Lok. Secrets of Agam 

Purush are revealed to me. (37) 

No one has revealed the secrets of that region. Rare 
Sants have spoken about it in a Gupt (hidden) 
way. (38) 

Taking pity on Jivas, Radhasoami has now revealed 
the secrets openly. (39) 



36 ] Arti [ Bachan 

O unfortunate Jivas! Listen to me. Radhasoami will 

augment your fortune. (40) 

Hurry up, run up, hold fast to His Holy Feet. Accept 

His Saran in the way you can. (41) 

You will not get such an opportunity again. Somehow 
or other accomplish your task right now. (42) 

Give up all rituals, observances and hypocritical 
activities. Elevate your Surat and penetrate into 
Brahmand. (43) 

When your Surat attains full concentration and with- 
drawal, you will reach Sat Lok, the eternal 
region. (44) 

From there you will run to Alakh Lok, and then penetrate 
into Agam Lok. (45) 

You will get Darshan of Agam Purush, and your Surat 
will assume a wonderful form. (46) 

There are rows and multitudes of Hansas (celestial 

beings) living in perfect harmony. (47) 

The whole region is dazzling with the light of millions 
and billions of suns and moons. How should I describe 
the infinite refulgence of that region? (48) 

There are beds of lotuses and fringes of dazzling 

pearls all round. (49) 

Music of merriment is resounding everywhere, and 
innumerable pools ot Amrit (nectar) are overflowing 
there. (50) 



1 ] Arti [37 

The ground (if it can be called a ground at all) is 

studded with emeralds, diamonds and rubies. Suns 
and moons form a canopy there. (51) 

Where lies the throne of Radhasoami, Hansas congregate 
in all majesty. (52) 

The whole region abounds in fascinating grandeur. 
The songs of blissful rejoicings are being sung in 
ever-increasing ecstasy and joy. (53) 

Such is the unique region of Radhasoami. He 

grants abode to His Nij Bhakts (special devotees) 
in IT. (54) 



Shabd 2 

7j?r ^fa ^te P^di^ ii i II 

Radhasoami has assumed human form in this world. 
As Guru (Supreme Guide and Preceptor), He 
awakens Jivas. (1) 

Those who understand and follow His teachings, are 
blessed with His company and association. (2} 

By attending Satsang of Radhasoami, they enjoy true 
bliss and become contented. (3) 

They love the Guru as a Chakor loves the moon. (4) 

Without Guru, they have no rest or peace even for a 
moment. Constantly uneasy lie their souls. (5) 



38 ] Arti [ Bachan 

When fortunately they get Darshan of Guru, they are 
supremely exhilarated and feel elated like a tender 
calf in the company of the mother-cow. (6) 

The gurumukhs (special devotees) who have developed 
such an intense love for Guru, are taken in His 
special protection. (7) 

They are rendered forgetful of their attachment to the 
body and of the pleasures of the senses, in a 
moment. (8) 

The form of Guru is enshrined in their hearts. Really, 
they are with Guru all the twenty four hours. (9) 

Those who perform such a devotion, attain the bliss 

of Nam. (10) 

They repeat the Holy Name in the manner a thirst- 
maddened Papiha cries for Swanti rain. (11) 

[The thirst of the bird Papiha is allayed only by the 
drops of Swanti rain - the rain which falls when the 
moon is in the fifteenth lunar mansion. If it does not 
rain, the bird goes without water the whole year. It will 
not drink from pools, lakes, rivers, etc. Thus the Swanti 
rain is the very life and breath of the bird. So it constantly 
calls out in very sweet and pathetic notes "Pee kahan, 

Pee kahan where is the beloved? Where is the beloved ? ) 

Another peculiarity about this bird is that it does not 
come down to the ground, always remains on trees. In 
this couplet stress is laid on constant Sumiran (repetition) 
of the Holy Name with an ardent longing at a higher 
centre., viz., the third Til, which is at the top of Pind.] 

When, by constant repetition of Nam, their Surat is 

awakened, they hear Shabd internally. (12) 



1 ] Arti [39 

They attain Guru's Shabd (access to Trikuti), penetrate 
the Shabds of Sunn, Sat Lok, Alakh Lok and Agam 
Lok, and finally secure admittance into Nij Pad 
(True Abode), the Radhasoami Dham. (13-14) 

They get Poora Ghar (final abode of rest) and attain 
Poori Gati (perfect salvation). Nothing remains to 
be said now as there is nothing beyond, RADHASOAMI 
being the Highest Region. (15) 



(bachan 2) 



ATTRIBUTES OF RADHASOAMI NAM 



TTS4l*etlM\ TO, fWtt cB^ f*T WQ ^ 1 
TfTT "3TR ^ 3TR, f^T "f*FT ^Pjfa TO II <1 II 

Listen to me. I give out the attributes of RADHASOAMI 
NAM. I describe each attribute separately. 



First Attribute 

The Holy Word RADHASOAMI comprises of five letters 
of Hindi alphabets, and ten of Persian. (1) 

IT discloses the mystery of five holy Shabds or Names, 
and grants ascension to ten regions. (2) 



Bachan 2 ] Attributes of Radhasoami Nam [ 41 

Second Attribute 

I have described the first attribute. I now give in detail 
the second attribute. (3) 

RADHA is the name of the Dhun (Reverberation) and 
SOAMI is the Shabd (Sound). (4) 

Know that Dhun and Shabd are one and the same, 
like water and its wave. Make no distinction between 
the two. (5) 

Third Attribute 

I now speak of the third attribute. Hear me 

attentively. (6) 

RADHA is the lover and SOAMI the beloved. (7) 

RADHASOAMI sings of the union of Surat and Shabd. 
This attribute, too, I have described. (8) 

Fourth Attribute 

RADHA is the Name of the Adi (Primal) Surat and 

SOAM I is the Adi Shabd . (9) 

RADHA and SOAMI form an inseparable pair like 

Surat and Shabd. Know that both Radha and Soami 
are one word RADHASOAMI. (10). 

As Surat dallies with Shabd, so does RADHA abide 

inclose union with SOAMI. (11) 

Know that RADHA and SOAMI are two, viz., Surat and 
Shabd. But they unite as one in Sat Lok. (12) 



BACHAN 3 



IN PRAISE OF 

PARAM PURUSH PURAN DHANI RADHASOAMI 

WHO INCARNATED HIMSELF HERE AS 

SANT SAT GURU 

FOR THE REDEMPTION OF JIVAS. 

IMPORTANCE OF LOVE FOR AND FAITH 

IN HIS AUGUST FEET. 



(1) 

RADHASOAMI Nam whoever recites, 
gets across the ocean of life, 
troubles vanish, bliss abides, 
and gone's complete all strife. 

(2) 

Such is this unfathomable Name 
that to none ITS secrets are known, 
he who comes to know the same 
is no more on the earth born. 



Bachan 3] Radhasoami [43 

Shabd 1 

&&% caw amra 3&mt I 

Indescribable, infinite, unfathomable and Anarmi 

(Nameless) is my beloved RADHASOAMI. (1) 

He is of wondrous form, eternally immersed within 
Himself in rapturous bliss. Such is my beloved 
Radhasoami. (2) 

In Agam Lok He assumed the form of Agam Purush. 
Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (3) 

Then He became Alakh Purush in Alakh Lok. Such 

is my beloved Radhasoami. (4) 

In Sat Lok my beloved Radhasoami assumed the name 
and form of Sat Nam Sat Purush. (5) 

In Bhanwar-gupha, the Antar- Jami (all-knowing) presi- 
ding deity is none else than my beloved 
Radhasoami. (6) 

He halted at Maha-Sunn. Such is my beloved 

Radhasoami. (7) 

In Sunn, He became the Imperishable Deity. Such is 
my beloved Radhasoami. (8) 

In Gagan Mandal (Trikuti), He is Omkar Purush, who 
is without desires. Such is my beloved 
Radhasoami. (9) 

Still lower down, He assumed the dark bluish form of 
Niranjan. Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (10) 



44 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

Descending to the heart centre, He became subject 
to desires. Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (11) 

He, however, reduces the evil propensities associated 
with the plane of senses. Such is my beloved 
Radhasoami. (12) 

Assuming the physical form and body He 

awakens the humanity. Such is my beloved 
Radhasoami. (13) 

He has assumed the form of three Gunas 1 in this 
world. Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (14) 

But like Alalpaksh 2 He flies up. Such is my beloved 

Radhasoami. (15) 

He repairs to His original abode (Anarmi Pad). Such 

is my beloved Radhasoami. (16) 

Then He becomes Anami Purush, as He originally 

was. Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (17) 

How can I describe His eminence? So great is my 

beloved Radhasoami. (18) 

Again and again I pay obeisance to Him. He is my 

beloved Radhasoami. ,(19) 

Yogis 3 and Gyanis 4 did not know His secrets. Such 

is my beloved Radhasoami. (20) 



1. The preservative, the generative and the destructive qualities, called 
Sato-guna, Rajo-gunaand Tamo-guna. 2. Alalpaksh is a fabulous 
bird. It lays eggs in the sky, but the young birdling that comes out in 
the course of descent, flies up without touching the ground. 
3. Ascetics; hermits. 4. Philosophers. 



3] Radhasoami [45 

Brahma 1 , Vishnu 1 and Mahesh 1 remained ignorant as 
they could not know Him. Such is my beloved 
Radhasoami. (21) 

Gaur 2 , Savitri 3 and Lakshmi 4 had no knowledge of His 
exalted status. Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (22) 

Shesh 5 Ganesh 6 and Kurarm 7 were all ignorant about 
Him. Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (23) 

Rishis 8 and Munis 9 like Narad 10 all went astray and 
could not know Him. Praised be my beloved 
Radhasoami! (24) 

Sankadik (the four sons of Brahma) and the deified 
ancestors knew not my beloved Radhasoami. (25) 

Gods and goddesses badly missed my beloved 

Radhasoami. (26) 

Ishwar and Parmeshwar (God and Great God) remained 
in a state of delusion. How great is my beloved 
Radhasoami ! (27) 

The Veda's 11 , Purans 12 and other revealed religious 
books are ignorant of the religion propagated by 
my beloved Radhasoami. (28) 

The sun, the moon, the stars and the heavenly 

1. Three deities of the Hindu Trinity, entrusted with the work of creation, 
preservation and destruction, respectively. 2. A name of the wife of 
Shiva. 3. A name of the wife of Brahma. 4. A name of the wife of 
Vishnu. 5. Deity of Sahas-dal-kanwal. 6. Shiva's son, the deity of 
the Guda chakra, the ganglion at the return. 7. Deity of Trikuti. 8. 
Sages. 9. Ascetics; hermits. 10. Name of a celebrated Deva-rishi 
(deified sage). 11 The sacred scriptures of the Hindus. 12. Books of 
Hindu theology and mythology. 



46 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

beings have no knowledge of my beloved 
Radhasoami. (29) 

Nor Allah 1 , Khuda 2 , Rasool 3 , and Mani 4 , had any 
knowledge of my beloved Radhasoami. (30-31) 

The Ganga 5 and the Jamuna 6 knew not the Truth as 
revealed by my beloved Radhasoami. (32) 

The whole world is lost in pilgrimages and fasts, 
and rituals and observances, O my beloved 
Radhasoami ! (33) 

All the three worlds are being crunched by Kal, O 

my beloved Radhasoami ! (34) 

None can understand Thy words, O my beloved 

Radhasoami ! (35) 

Words are inadequate to express Thy eminence, 

O my beloved Radhasoami ! (36) 

May I remain absorbed in the bliss of Thy Darshan, 

O my beloved Radhasoami ! (37) 

May I ever remain attached to Thy Feet, O my beloved 
Radhasoami ! (38) 

May my eyes be ever absorbed in Thy Darshan, O 

my beloved Radhasoami ! (39) 

1. Name of God. 2. God. 3. An apostle. 4. Founder of the sect of 
Manichaeans. He flourished in Persia in the third century A. D. He 
taught a dualism derived from zoroastrianism, viz., man's body is 
the product of the kingdom of darkness (evil), but that his soul 
springs from the kingdom of light (God). Evil is perpetually striving 
to drag man down, while God (Christ) continually tries to save him 
5. The river Ganges. The Ganges personified as a goddess. 6. 
Name of a river, the twin sister of Jam or the god of death. 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 47 

Praised be my beloved Radhasoami who gives out 
the secrets and mysteries of the inaccessible region 
in His discourses. (40) 

My beloved Radhasoami shows the path of Surat Shabd 
Yoga. (41) 

I remain absorbed within on getting initiated into the 
secrets of the path by my beloved Radhasoami. (42) 

Because of the grace of my beloved Radhasoami, 

no harm can ever come to me. (43) 

I am devoted to my beloved Radhasoami like a faithful 
wife to her husband. (44) 

my beloved Radhasoami ! Look at me, I am lost 

in Thy love. (45) 

Jama or Kal can claim nothing from me because of 

my beloved Radhasoami. (46) 

1 am being cleansed of all stains and impurities, as 

I have come under the protection of my beloved 
Radhasoami. (47) 

For lives together I remained in delusion, till I met 

my beloved Radhasoami. (48) 

The whole world now knows that my luck has been 

awakened. Praised be my beloved Radhasoami! (49) 

Passion, anger and avarice have all been driven away 
by my beloved Radhasoami. (50) 

All the snares of Kal and Maya have been cut asunder 
by my beloved Radhasoami. (51) 



48 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

By the grace of my beloved Radhasoami, I have attained 
the abode where resounds the wondrous resonance 
of Shabd. (52) 

I have now become a slave of Sant Sat Guru who 
is my beloved Radhasoami Himself in human 
form. (53) 

Again and again I bow in obeisance before my beloved 
Radhasoami. (54) 

my beloved Radhasoami ! Thy Dharm (Abode) is 

the most high and exalted. (55) 

Thy exalted position and power is a strange story as 
I have heard, O my beloved Radhasoami! (56) 

Thou art my beloved Radhasoami ! I am mad after 

Thy Nam (Name). (57) 

Thou hast subdued Kal and driven him away, O my 

beloved Radhasoami ! (58) 

1 sacrifice myself at Thy holy feet, O my beloved 

Radhasoami! (59) 

I am filled with immense joy when I sing Thy praises, 
O my beloved Radhasoami ! (60) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! I feel exhilarated on seeing 
Thy glorious form. (61) 

my beloved Radhasoami! I am a Chakor and Thou 

art like the moon. (62) 

1 am madly in love with Thee, O my beloved 

Radhasoami! (63) 



3j Radhasoami [49 

Every moment I yearn for Thy Darshan, O my beloved 
Radhasoami ! (64) 

I am lost in the rapturous bliss of Thy discourses, O 

my beloved Radhasoami! (65) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! Thou art like Swanti rain, 
I am an empty shell, humbly waiting to receive 
the rain drop. (66) 

Inscrutable are Thy ways, O my beloved Radhasoami! (67) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! Thou art the doer and 

dispenser of all. (68) 

As a thirst-maddened Papiha longs for Swanti rain, 

so do I for my beloved Radhasoami. (69) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! Thou art like a 

magnet and I am hard iron, being attracted towards 
Thee. (70) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! I am a Mrigni (female deer) 
and Thou art like the music of the pipe. (71) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! I am a fish and Thou art 
like water to me. (72) 

Neither Ram nor Krishna knew Thee, O my beloved 

Radhasoami! (73) 

Neither Sita 1 nor Rukmin 2 and Pat-rani 3 heard about 
my beloved Radhasoami. (74) 

Christ, Moses, Mary and Mani 4 failed to find out my 

beloved Radhasoami. (75) 



1. Wife of Ram. 2. Wife of Krishna. 3. The principal wife of 
a king. 4. Founder of the sect of Manichaeans. 



50 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

Kulkar and Mura Devi Rani (gods and goddesses of 
the Jains) could not get access to my beloved 
Radhasoami. (76) 

Nor could the divinely and godly Personages like Kutub 1 , 
Paigambar 2 , Gaus 3 and Rabban of Jews meet 
my beloved Radhasoami. (77) 

What could Hindus and Muslims know about my beloved 
Radhasoami ? (78) 

The earnest devotees like Dhruva and Prahlad could 
not know my beloved Radhasoami. (79) 

Neither there is earth nor sky in the abode of my 

beloved Radhasoami. (80) 

Neither there is air nor water or fire in the mansion 

of my beloved Radhasoami. (81) 

Neither there are the three Gunas nor the subtle Tattwas 
in the region of my beloved Radhasoami. (82) 

The abode of my beloved Radhasoami is beyond the 
regions of Atrma (soul) and Parmatrma (God). (83) 

Left far below are Sunn and Maha-Sunn from the region 
of my beloved Radhasoami. (84) 

Bhanwargupha and Sat Lok are below. Higher is the 
Abode of my beloved Radhasoami. (85) 

My beloved Radhasoami is beyond Alakh and Agam 
Loks. (86) 



1. A title or degree of rank among the religion of mendicants. 
2. Prophet, apostle. 3. A title of Mohammedan saints. 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 51 

There is no trace of any thing else in the region of 

my beloved Radhasoami. (87) 

Unfathomed and unfathomable is the glory of the 

sphere of my beloved Radhasoami. (88) 

The six Shastras (sacred books of the Hindus) and 
Adi Puran (scripture of Jains) know nothing of 
the region of my beloved Radhasoami. (89) 

Not only beyond the three Loks (worlds) but also 
beyond the fourth is the Abode of my beloved 
Radhasoami. (90) 

Pandits 1 , Bhekhs 2 and Shekhs 3 could not know my 

beloved Radhasoami. (91) 

I dedicate myself whole-heartedly at the Holy Feet of 
my beloved Radhasoami. (92) 

It is only when I have cast off all passions and desires 
that I met my most beloved and exalted 
Radhasoami. (93) 

Thus purified I ascend to Trikuti and find my beloved 
Radhasoami (94) 

I go on penetrating and reach the highest region where 
I meet my beloved Radhasoami. (95) 

I become happy and get absorbed in the highest bliss 
when I meet my beloved Radhasoami. (96) 

Barriers, wherever they exist, are removed because 
of my beloved Radhasoami. (97) 

1. Learned men. 2. Ascetics 3. Doctors of Muslim religion and Law. 



52 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

The three Yugas (Sat Yuga, Treta and Dwapar) have 
passed. My beloved Radhasoami has made His 
advent in this fourth Yuga (Kali Yuga). (98) 

He gives out His secrets and accepts me in His protection. 
Such is my beloved Radhasoami. (99) 

Like the refulgent sun, my beloved Radhasoami 
has dispelled all darkness and put an end to the 
night. (100) 

By the grace of my beloved Radhasoami, myriads of 
suns rise within me. (101) 

None knew or knows the glory and eminence of my 

beloved Radhasoami. (102) 

My beloved Radhasoami dwells within me. Every part 
of my body is animated with His love. (103) 

Forget I may my whole self, but I will never forget 
the Holy Feet of my beloved Radhasoami. (104) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! May I keep Thee enshrined 
in the innermost corner of my heart. (105) 

O my beloved Radhasoami, bless me so that I may 
never be separated from Thee and may I ever 
enjoy Thy company. (106) 

O my beloved Radhasoami! Thou hast driven the 

malediction of Kali Yuga. (107) 

As the moon is to Kumodini, so is my beloved 

Radhasoami to me. (108) 

[Lotus expands its petals during the day time and closes 
them in the night. While Kumodini (also a variety of lotus) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 53 

expands its petals during the night, when there is moonlight, 
and closes them in the day time.] 

Radhasoami has graciously come to this world in human 
form as Guru (Sant Sat Guru). Praised be my 
beloved Radhasoami! (109) 



Shabd 2 

ip Try '3^FT m II h n 

I am the darling of Radhasoami. I sing praises of 

Radhasoami. (1) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I look 
at His face and keep gazing at His eyes. (2) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I make 
His discourses my life and support. (3) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. With 

great care I perform all His Sewas. (4) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I always 
remain in His august presence. (5) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Having 
a glimpse of His holy feet, I have become His 
humble servant. (6) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

adopted His protection this time. (7) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
showered unbounded grace on me. (8) 



54 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

been rid of all worldly attachments. (9) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
severed all family ties and worldly relations. (10) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I care 

not for the ignominy of the world. (11) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I follow 
His guidance. (12) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. By His 
grace, all my passions and desires have been 
annihilated. (13) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
cleansed me of all impurities. (14) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Jealousy 
and envy have been cast off from my heart. (15) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. All conceit 
and egotism have fled away from my heart. (16) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Purification 
of my inner being has been effected. (17) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
ascended higher, reverting back along the current 
coming from above. (18) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
now left the confines of the nine orifices. (19) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

got across to the other side. (20) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 55 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I 
have subdued the mind, and ascended to 
Chidakash 1 . (21) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I see 
the glory of the third Til, flashes of the dazzling 
flame and the blooming flowers of five colours. I 
enjoy this extraordinary spectacle. (22-25) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I now 

stroll Kanj (Sahas-dal-kanwal). (26) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I grace- 
fully pace higher up. (27) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I ascend 
up and open the gate to Banknal. (28) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I witness 
the glorious scenes and spectacles in Trikuti. (29) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I ascend 
to Sunn and come to Daswan Dwar. (30) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I play 

grand games in Maha-sunn. (31) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I hear 

a melodious tune in Bhanwargupha. (32) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. i 
open the doors and enter Amar Pad (immortal 
region) (33) 



1. Chidakash — The sky which is beyond the sixth centre 
and below Sahas-dal-kanwal. 



56 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I hear 
the incessant reverberation of the Bin (harp). (34) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
left Kal below and got the company of Dayal. (35) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I am 

intoxicated with the ecstasy of Shabd. (36) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. By catching 
hold of the Shabd current I reach Alakh Lok. (37) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I secure 
the treasure of Agam Lok. (38) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
got the glorious Darshan of Radhasoami. (39) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. All sourness 
of my heart has disappeared. (40) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My boat 
has safely come ashore. (41) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
been relieved of the heavy burden of sins of innumerable 
lives. (42) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

subdued Maya and all her allurements. (43) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
effaced the dark clouds of Karams and 
Bharams. (44) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I 
have now found my fVsi f^KRNij Dildar (true 
Beloved). (45) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 57 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

become a garland round His neck. (46) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. All my 

opponents have given up in despair. (47) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
now taken a strong vow not to drift with worldly 
currents. I remain vigilant day and night. (48-50) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Darkness 
has disappeard, and light has dawned on me. (51) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I am 

thankful to Him again and again. (52) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I sacrifice 
my body and mind to Him. (53) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
taken me across by the internal path (of Surat 
Shabd). (54) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
adorned me in this manner. (55) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. The Name 
RADHASOAMI is now my life and sustenance. (56) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
repaired to my 1^R "SR^R Nij Gharbar (Original 
Abode). (57) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I keep 

on gazing at His face. (58) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I now 

love His Sewa with heart and soul. (59) 



58 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I find abode 
in the frsr «recft Nij Basti (the true habitation). I 
have left the wilderness (this desolate world). (60) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I hear 
Shabd attentively and play in Sunn. (61) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I now 
hear the melodious sounds of f^frnft Kingri and 
ipt Sarangi (the fiddle and the violin). (62) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
annihilated all snares of Kal. (63) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My 
entanglement in the world has diminished. (64) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Giving 
up egotism, my Surat has now begun to soar 
high. (65) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
killed ?ri*T Lobh (avarice) which is a notorious 
liar. (66) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. ^Moh 
(attachment to worldly objects) which does not see 
beyond the skin, has also run away. (67) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. ^TfTKarm 
(passion) has been put to utter shame. (68) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
conquered the forces of Kal and Maya. (69) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I now 
see beautiful flower gardens within. (70) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 59 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have cut 
asunder all snares and traps of Kal and Maya. (71) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I hear 

an impressive symphony within me. (72) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My Surat 
now feels highly exhilarated. (73) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I 
have attained the source, and given up the 
branches. (74) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I am 

now ready to ascend upwards. (75) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. The lion 
(Kal) ran away on seeing the jackal (Jiva). (76) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
now fastened the dagger of Shabd to my belt. (77) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. 
Guru has equipped me with such a sword of 
Shabd. (78) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My brave 
Surat throws an open challenge and marches 
on. (79) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. On hearing 
the war cry, the forces of W? Karam take to 
their heels. (80) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. *-K% 
Bharam (delusion) also flees, when Shabd begins 
to resound. (81) 



60 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Fear of 
Jama has disappeared from my mind. (82) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My Surat 
now reaches Gagan. (83) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My inner 
being is flooded with immensely bright moon 
light. (84) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My Surat 
ascends higher and higher up. (85) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I remove 
the massive barrier of Sunn. (86) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Shorn 
off the burden of covers, I am now in high 
spirits. (87) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I hear 
the Dhun (sound) of Rarankar within me. (88) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I fill my 
jars with snft "st^t Ami-jal (nectar-like water), and 
thus become a celestial water-carrier. (89) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. All worldly 
bondages and ties have been cut asunder. (90) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I enjoy 
a season of eternal spring. (91) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. There 
is now no fear of autumn visiting me. (92) 

am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Guru 

has graciously taken me in His lap. (93) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 61 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
enabled me to hear the *p Dhun (sound) of srfeJR 
Omkar. (94) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I perform 
various kinds of^TSewa (services). (95) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
relieved me from the drudgeries of the world. (96) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
now been equipped with the weapon of love and 
devotion. (97) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. All rubbish 
which lay stored within me has been removed. (98) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. My Surat 
now proceeds along the current of Shabd. (99) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

sacrificed my body and mind to Him. (100) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I ascend 
to^RW^PT Bhanwargupha and hear the melodious 
music of the Bin (harp) of Udcrt+Sat Lok. (101) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I cross 
the regions of Alakh and Agam. (102) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Radhasoami 
has taken me ashore. (103) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I now 

wholly dedicate myself to Him. (104) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I 



62 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

have secured the bliss of Nam which is now my 
sustenance. (105) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
now discarded all formal rites and rituals. (106) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. All worldly 
objects and pleasures have become morbid for 
me. I now no longer care for them. (107-108) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. On hearing 
the resonance of Shabd, my mind has become 
steady. (109) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
attained unbounded bliss. I have adopted"^ 'Maun' 
(observance of keeping silence), and do not utter 
a word. (110-111) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
today attained the Essence of essences. (112) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami, who is 
the Creator of all. (113) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I always 
remember Him. (114) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami, around 
whom Hansas, in rows, sit in a spirit of 
adoration. (115) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

now attained unbounded bliss. (116) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
today severed all connections with others. (117) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 63 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I love 

my Guru intensely. (118) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have met 
Radhasoami, who is the greatest benefactor. (119) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
today adopted and accepted His gracious protection 
and care. (120) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

cast off all burdens. (121) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. Leaving 
three regions below, I have attained the fourth. (122) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. He has 
made me give up all useless dealings. (123) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 

completely subdued my mind. (124) 

I am the darling of my beloved Radhasoami. I have 
entered the ^WR Darbar (court) of Merciful 
Radhasoami. (125) 



Shabd 3 

TTW^TRt ^T 1^3RT TTSJIWltfl II S II 

Radhasoami has revealed the Name RADHASOAMI. 
Radhasoami has showed the form of Radhasoami. (1) 

(When the Supreme Father Radhasoami Dayal incarnated Himself 
as Sant Sat Guru, He disclosed that His name is RADHASOAMI. 



64 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

To those who followed Him and practised His Abhyas, He 
showed the form of the Supreme Father Radhasoami Dayal.] 

Radhasoami has imparted the knowledge of Radhasoami 
Dham. Radhasoami has introduced the game of 
Radhasoami. (2) 

Radhasoami has united us with Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami has promulgated the religion of 
Radhasoami. (3) 

Radhasoami has enabled us to serve Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami has given us the secrets of 
Radhasoami. (4) 

Radhasoami has caused the overflow of the "R^ 
Mauj of Radhasoami. Radhasoami has described 
the attributes of Radhasoami. (5) 

Radhasoami's praises I sing by uttering RADHASOAMI 
RADHASOAMI. I proclaim the greatness of Radhasoami 
by singing RADHASOAMI RADHASOAMI. (6) 

Radhasoami has composed the ^trtTT Arti song of 
Radhasoami. Radhasoami has lighted the flame 
of RADHASOAMI Nam. (7) 

Radhasoami has revealed the secrets of Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami has given out a clue to 
Radhasoami. (8) 

Radhasoami is Surat, and Radhasoami is Shabd. 
Radhasoami has made audible the sound of 
RADHASOAMI. (9) 

Radhasoami has made us associate with Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami has dyed us in the colour (love) of 
Radhasoami. (10) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 65 

Radhasoami has enabled us to understand Radhasoami. 
Through Radhasoami we have come to know 
Radhasoami. (11) 

Radhasoami is the sun, as well as a ray of the sun. 
Radhasoami is the ocean, as well as a drop of 
the ocean. (12) 

Radhasoami is the moon, as well as the phases of 

the moon. Radhasoami is the WTGagan (firmament), 
as well as thef^RiGira (Shabd, sound) resounding 
there. (13) 

Radhasoami is the earth and Radhasoami is water. 
Radhasoami is fire and Radhasoami is air. (14) 

Radhasoami is three (i.e., three Gunas) and Radhasoami 
is four (i.e., four Antah-karans). Radhasoami is one 
(i.e., Sat Purush Radhasoami). Radhasoami is two 
(i.e., Radhasoami is Brahm and Maya). (15) 

Radhasoami is seven (two eyes, two ears, two nostrils 
and one mouth), Radhasoami is twenty (ten senses 
and their ten deities). Radhasoami is one thousand 
(Sahas-dal-Kanwal of one thousand petals). 
Radhasoami is ten (Daswan Dwar) (16) 

Radhasoami is in the eyes and Radhasoami is at 
the third Til. Radhasoami is in Sahas-dal-kanwal 
and Radhasoami is in Sunn (pertaining to Sahas- 
dal-kanwal). (17) 

Radhasoami is Ormkar and Radhasoami is Rarankar. 
Radhasoami is Sohang and Radhasoami is Satt 
Purush. (18) 



66 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

Radhasoami is Alakh Purush, and Radhasoami is 
Agam Purush. Radhasoami is Param Purush 
Radhasoami. (19) 

Radhasoami speaks about the glory of Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami sings the praises of Radhasoami. (20) 

Radhasoami shows the true essence of Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami enables us to engender love for 
Radhasoami. (21) 

Radhasoami enables us to worship the Feet of 
Radhasoami. Radhasoami removes the barriers 
and opens the door to Radhasoami. (22) 

Radhasoami reveals the Shabd of Radhasoami. 

Radhasoami shows us the region of Radhasoami. (23) 

Radhasoami makes Radhasoami manifest Himself. 
Radhasoami beholds the refulgence of 
Radhasoami. (24) 

Radhasoami alone can recognise Radhasoami. Radha- 
soami opens the secrets of Radhasoami. (25) 

Radhasoami is Purush (the presiding deity) and 
Radhasoami is also the region (abode). I recite 
the Name RADHASOAMI. I contemplate the form 
of Radhasoami. (26) 

Radhasoami is the song. Radhasoami is the sound. 
Radhasoami has made us sing the song of 
Radhasoami. (27) 

Radhasoami has established the supremacy of 
Radhasoami. Radhasoami has enabled us to 
develop love for Radhasoami. (28) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 67 

Radhasoami has churned milk, and made butter. 

Radhasoami is also the churning stick. Radhasoami 
is the beginning as well as the end. (29) 

Radhasoami is also the middle or intermediate. Radhasoami 
pervades and permeates all. Radhasoami is^f^RT 
Jugti and ^icR Jatan (Surat Shabd Yoga). (30) 

Radhasoami is TcH Ratan (jewel). Radhasoami is 
cflH Lai (ruby). Radhasoami is ^ffeTDaya/ (merciful). 
Radhasoami is <j>4nn Kripal (compassionate). (31) 

Radhasoami has made us obey the orders of 

Radhasoami. Radhasoami has awakened in us, 
love for Radhasoami. (32) 

Radhasoami is the husband. Radhasoami is the father. 
Radhasoami is the Guru. Radhasoami is the 
Sant. (33) 

Radhasoami is stwiAjar (undecaying). Radhasoami 
is zuKAmar (undying). Radhasoami is Par-Brahm. 
Radhasoami is Brahm. (34) 

Radhasoami has awakened us. Let us meet Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami, by His grace, has enabled us to 
gain access to the region of Radhasoami. (35) 

Radhasoami has taught us the Bhakti (devotion) of 
Radhasoami. Radhasoami has enhanced love in 
us for Radhasoami. (36) 

Radhasoami has granted love in our hearts for Radhasoami. 
Let us utter Radhasoami again and again. (37) 

Radhasoami has enabled us to understand Radhasoami. 



68 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

The eminence of Radhasoami is too exalted to 

be estimated. (38) 

All fwi Niyams (modes and methods) are included 
in devotion to Radhasoami. Radhasoami is religion. 
All religious activities are covered by the practices 
taught by Radhasoami. (39) 

Radhasoami is food and Radhasoami is partaker. Union 
with Radhasoami can be attained by following the 
spiritual practices promulgated by Radhasoami. (40) 

Radhasoami is night and Radhasoami is day. 

Radhasoami is to be remembered every hour, every 
moment. (41) 

Radhasoami is sun-shine, Radhasoami is shade. Radhasoami 
is the sun, Radhasoami is the moon. (42) 

Radhasoami is the object of recitation of repetition. 
Radhasoami is the object of meditation and 
contemplation. Radhasoami is the light of the eyes. 
Radhasoami is the heart. (43) 

Radhasoami is within, Radhasoami is without. Radha- 
soami is unmanifest, Radhasoami is manifest. (44) 

Radhasoami is in the firmament above. Radhasoami 
is on the ground. Radhasoami pervades all. Radhasoami 
permeates all. (45) 

Radhasoami is the gift, Radhasoami is the giver. 
Radhasoami is the cause and Radhasoami is the 
doer of all. (46) 

Radhasoami is the boat and Radhasoami is the boatman. 
Radhasoami is the Creation, Radhasoami is the 
Creator. (47) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 69 

Radhasoami is the sight, Radhasoami is the object 
of sight. Radhasoami is the fast and Radhasoami 
is the pilgrimage. (48) 

Radhasoami is the Veda, Radhasoami is the holy 
scripture. Sing Radhasoami, and let others sing 
Radhasoami. (49) 

Radhasoami is supreme, above all. Radhasoami is 
infinite. Worship Radhasoami, and let others worship 
Radhasoami. (50) 

Radhasoami is without any support. Radhasoami is 
the support of all. Radhasoami is arrs Agam 
(inaccessible). Radhasoami is anrm Agadh 
(unfathomable). (51) 

Radhasoami is supreme, Radhasoami is infinitely 
supreme. Radhasoami is the lotus. Radhasoami 
is the^TiT Bhonra (the humble black-bee). (52) 

Radhasoami is there, Radhasoami is here. Radhasoami 
is uncreated, Radhasoami is prestine beauty. (53) 

Radhasoami is the source, Radhasoami is the 
branch. I sing Radhasoami. Let us all sing 
Radhasoami. (54) 



Shabd 4 

Traiwwi tr ^rra' m # ii s ii 

Ever since the advent of Radhasoami into this 
world, He has been preaching the Holy Word 
RADHASOAMI. (1) 



70 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

I repeat the Holy Name RADHASOAMI whole-heartedly. 
I am blessed with the Darshan of Radhasoami in 
human form. (2) 

I behold Radhasoami with my eyes. I hear Radhasoami 
with my ears. (3) 

I keep on uttering Radhasoami with all my heart. I 
keep on hearing Radhasoami with my soul. (4) 

I adopt RADHASOAMI Nam with my life and breath. I 
accept RADHASOAMI Nam with all my senses. (5) 

I use my feet to walk to Radhasoami and my hand 

to serve Radhasoami. (6) 

With all my body, I keep company of Radhasoami, I 
sit near Radhasoami with awe and reverence. (7) 

I have adopted the v^ Isht of Radhasoami. I keep 

singing Radhasoami with enthusiasm. (8) 

I utter Radhasoami Name with every breath. My 
remembrance of Radhasoami is increasing every 
moment. (9) 

I do not forget Radhasoami from the heart of my 
hearts. I cannot separate myself from Radhasoami 
even for a moment. (10) 

I behold the Form of Radhasoami with both my eyes. 
Love of Radhasoami has taken deeper root in 
my heart. (11) 

Radhasoami spoke to me one day. I have dedicated 
myself to Him from that day. (12) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 71 

Radhasoami saves us from "3PT Jam (the angel of 
death). How and to whom should I speak of the 
eminence and glory of Radhasoami? (13) 

Radhasoami has saved me from all illusions and wande- 
rings. Radhasoami has relieved me from observance 
of rites and rituals. (14) 

Radhasoami has made me abide in His Holy Feet. 
Radhasoami has made His advent from the 
inaccessible region. (15) 

Radhasoami has converted me into a Hansa from a 
human being. Radhasoami has showered 
blessings on me from His ft^f "er; Nij Ghar (Original 
Abode). (16) 

Radhasoami has disclosed the inner secrets right 
from the highest region. Radhasoami has rid me 
of all egotism. (17) 

Radhasoami has extricated me from the world, and 
made me His own. Radhasoami has saved me 
from the snares of the world. (18) 

Radhasoami has steered me across this ocean of 
life. I have developed intense love for my Guru, 
the Supreme Being Radhasoami. (19) 

I am a Chakor to Radhasoami, the moon. I am a 

lotus to Radhasoami, the sun. (20) 

[Chakor is a bird possessing very conspicuous eyes, fabled 
to subsist upon moon beams, Lotus is always eager for 
the sun. It expands its petals when the day breaks and 
closes them when the sun sets.] 



72 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

I am a Kokil to Radhasoami, the mango. I am a 

Bhonra to Radhasoami, the lotus. (21) 

[Kokil is an Indian cuckoo, frequently alluded to in Hindi 
poetry. Its musical cry inspires tender emotions in the 
heart of lovers. It is enamoured of mango.] 

Bhonra (black-bee) is so enamoured of lotus, that it turns 
round and round over it, shortening its circle all the time, 
till, at last, towards evening, it sits on the lotus, and 
when the sun sets, the flower closes its petals, and the 
Bhonra remains imprisoned within the petals the whole 
night.] 

I am the sun, Radhasoami is the sky. I am a snake, 

Radhasoami is the gem on my head. (22) 

[Certain snakes are said to be endowed with a glittering 
gem on their heads. To enjoy the refulgence of the gem 
on its head, the snake takes it out and places it in a 
secluded place. It moves about merrily, all the time gazing 
at the gem. If, by any device, the gem is removed, the 
snake collapses instantly, in restless trepidation. The gem 
is the life of the snake. Similarly, Radhasoami Dayal is 
my life and support. I cannot live even for a moment 
without Him.] 

I am a child, Radhasoami is my mother. I am a son, 

Radhasoami is my father. (23) 

I am an afflicted person. Radhasoami is my sole 
consolation. I am a Chakvi, Radhasoami is the 
refulgent sun. (24) 

[Chakvi, the female bird is separated from its mate, Chakva, 
the male bird, at sun set each evening. They meet again 
the next morning at sun rise. So, the Chakvi passes the 
whole night in yearning for sun-light.] 

I am afflicted with the pangs of separation from 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 73 

Radhasoami. I am enamoured of the gracefulness 
of Radhasoami. (25) 

Radhasoami has enabled me to perceive Shabd by 
means of the practices taught by Him. I have 
attained Radhasoami Nam by devout devotion. (26) 

I am the lover. Radhasoami is the Beloved. I am 
fish, Radhasoami is the current of water. (27) 

I am an egg, Radhasoami is the tortoise. I am just 

a wave, Radhasoami is the ocean. (28) 

[Usually, eggs are hatched by the mother sitting over 
them. But, in the case of a tortoise, the process is quite 
different. The mother tortoise lays eggs on the ground 
and goes back to water. She does not come out to hatch 
them. She, however, keeps an eye on them. Her attention 
does the work of hatching. Similarly, although, being engrossed 
in the world I am far away, yet, the most merciful Radhasoami 
is taking proper care of me.] 

I am an empty Tift Gagri (pitcher), Radhasoami is 
water. I am a bow. Radhasoami is the arrow. (29) 

[An empty pitcher is an ill omen. But when filled with 
water, it is considered a good omen. I am useless and 
insignificant. When I joined Radhasoami's fold, I attained 
my true embellishment.] 

I am a forest, Radhasoami is the lion, the king of 
the forest. I am a mere body, Radhasoami is the 
soul, imparting life to the body. (30) 

I am a tree, Radhasoami is the fruit on it. I am a branch, 
Radhasoami is the flower blooming on it. (31) 

I am a <{h<*> Deepak (an earthen bowl containing oil 
and wick), Radhasoami is the flame. I am a sea, 
Radhasoami is its source. (32) 



74 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

I am the earth, Radhasoami is the rain falling on it. I 
am a warrior, RADHASOAMI Name is my 
sword. (33) 

I am a body, Radhasoami is its eyes. I am a tongue, 
Radhasoami is speech. (34) 

I am heavy iron, Radhasoami is a light boat. I am a 
beggar, and Radhasoami is a wealthy ifeSeth. (35) 

I am a"?fNtSipi (an empty shell), Radhasoami is the 
^penfcT Swanti rain. I am enthralled by the gracefulness 
of Radhasoami. (36) 

[Rain, falling into a shell, when the moon is in the fifteenth 
lunar mansion, turns into a pearl.] 

I have won the battle (against Kal and Maya) with 
the line of action taught by Radhasoami. I am 
fully satisfied with Radhasoami. (37) 

I am a food article and, Radhasoami is salt, making 
it tasteful. I am a seed bud, Radhasoami is air, 
vital to its germination. (38) 

I am a star, Radhasoami is the firmament. I am a 
Kumodini, Radhasoami is like the moon. (39) 

By the grace of Radhasoami, I began to rise up from 
the^ Ghat (Pind). I cling fast to the Holy Feet 
of Radhasoami. (40) 

Radhasoami has rid me of hypocrisy. Radhasoami 

has enabled me to cross the third Til. (41) 

Radhasoami helped me ascend to Banknal quickly. I 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 75 

entersrtersAughat (internal path to higher regions) 
and secure the gateway to Radhasoami Dham. (42) 

[The human body excluding the limbs, has been likened 
to two Ghats or jars, meeting at the neck. The torso, 
portion below the neck, is called ^TZGhat, and the caput, 
portion above the neck, is sftt^ZAughat, ajar or vessel 
put upside down. It is called fa^T tjz Nij Ghat, the real 
vessel, as spiritual centres are located therein.] 

Radhasoami enables me to open the door to Trikuti. 
At Man-sarovar lake, Radhasoami transformed me 
into a Hansa. (43) 

I ascend to Maha-sunn with the help of Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami has cleansed me of all evil 
propensities. (44) 

Radhasoami unites me with Sohang Purush. I reach 
Sat Lok in the company of Radhasoami. (45) 

By HisTfraMauj (grace), Radhasoami shows me Alakh 
Lok. By His sheer^fNi Chauj (mercy), Radhasoami 
shows me Agam Lok. (46) 

My Surat sees the graceful form of Radhasoami. I 

am now in love with the human form of Radhasoami, 
viz., the Sant Sat Guru. (47) 

I merge myself in the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. I 
attain salvation by adopting the protection of 
Radhasoami. (48) 

I enter Radhasoami Dham majestically. Radhasoami 
has embellished me. (49) 

Radhasoami has embraced me lovingiy. I have come 



76 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

to know the secrets of Radhasoami in the Satsang 
of Sant Sat Guru. (50) 

I have got across because of my love for, and attachement 
with, Radhasoami. Radhasoami has now washed 
away all my evil propensities. (51) 

With whom shall I compare Radhasoami? He has liberated 
me from all forms of life. (52) 

I have found Radhasoami with great hardship. I have 
met Radhasoami after great efforts. (53) 

I drink nectar of the Dhun of Radhasoami and quietly 
become one with Him. (54) 



Shabd 5 

tt*jiww! irrer s&Rm wit fr i 

my dear companion ! Radhasoami has graciously 

made me His own. By His grace, today I witness 

His majestic grandeur. (1) 

lhear the most sublime discourses of Radhasoami. I 
recite the most adorable Name RADHASOAMI. (2) 

1 behold the inaccessibly exalted Radhasoami Anami 

(Nameless Being). How can words describe the 
high status of Radhasoami ? (3) 

I touch the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. I enshrine 
Radhasoami within the core of my heart. (4) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 77 

In the company of Radhasoami, I cut asunder the 
snares of the world. By my association with Radha- 
soami I curb Kal. (5) 

Radhasoami has extricated me from this world. 
Radhasoami has made me a Hans (swan) from 
an ugly Kag (crow). (6) 

Radhasoami has imparted a unique message. The 
moment I utter the Holy Word RADHASOAMI, ail 
my doubts and misgivings are dispelled. (7) 

Radhasoami has taken me in His lap. Radhasoami 

will also redeem you. (8) 

Repeat the Holy Word RADHASOAMI all the time. Recite 
RADHASOAMI all the twenty four hours. (9) 

Radhasoami dwells in my heart every moment. To 
whom may I speak about the grace and mercy of 
Radhasoami ? (10) 

None can, by himself, associate with Radhasoami. No 
one can imbibe the colour of Radhasoami. (11) 

With whomsoever is Radhasoami pleased, Radhasoami 
blesses him with His company. (12) 

How can one proceed internally without the grace and 
mercy of Radhasoami Dayal and comprehend the 
Radhasoami Faith ? (13) 

Radhasoami speaks about the fourth Lok (Sat Lok) 

Radhasoami discloses Alakh Lok. (14) 

Radhasoami makes the inaccessible accessible. You 
will now attain Radhasoami Dharm. (15) 



78 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

You have this time met Radhasoami by your sheer 
good luck. Hold fast to Him right now, otherwise, 
when will you do so ? (16) 

Enhance your love for Radhasoami every moment. 

Behold the splendour of Radhasoami every day. (17) 

Radhasoami has assumed human form in this world. 
Radhasoami drives away Kal, the cheat. (18) 

Forsake not the protection of Radhasoami. Worship 
always the Feet of Radhasoami. (19) 

Utterance of the Holy Word RADHASOAMI wipes out 
all sins. Radhasoami has churned all the centres 
represented in the human body. (20) 

Believe that the ^TRup (Form) of Radhasoami is 

7T^ Shabd. Listen to Radhasoami Shabd with your 
Surat. (21) 

In the company of Radhasoami, subdue your mind. 
Radhasoami beheads Maya, the serpent. (22) 

Never again will you come across a Guru like Radhasoami. 
Radhasoami does not forsake him whom He has 
taken in His "SRHSaran (shelter). (23) 

Who can describe the grandeur and greatness of 

Radhasoami ? Even the Vedas (books of knowledge) 
and Shesh (the thousand tongued serpent) have 
not been able to do so. (24) 

Radhasoami, who has been so far unknown, has now 
manifested Himself in human form. Radhasoami 
has now imparted all His secrets and mysteries 
to me. (25) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 79 

Radhasoami shows me a flower garden within. Radhasoami 
opens all doors, and removes all barriers. (26) 

Radhasoami enables me to subdue the mind by a 
subtle device. Radhasoami enables me to ascend 
to Gagan in no time. (27) 

In the company of Radhasoami I get to the region of 
Sunn. Turning away from the world, I have adopted 
the colour of Radhasoami. (28) 

Radhasoami today fills the pitcher of my Surat. Radhasoami 
shows me a wondrous city. (29) 

I am mad in love with Radhasoami. I have seen all the 
grandeur and refulgence of Radhasoami. (30) 

My good fortune has awakened. I have come in contact 
with Radhasoami. By associating with Radhasoami, 
I have become immortal, immune from the cycle 
of births and deaths. (31) 

By adopting the Saran of Radhasoami, my love has 
grown intense. Radhasoami has enabled me to 
listen to the unique Kingri (fiddle). (32) 

Radhasoami has made me His own. Radhasoami has 
saved me from the entanglements of the world. (33) 

Radhasoami has enabled me to realize that this world 
is unreal like a dream. I no longer toil and moil 
for worldly prosperity. (34) 

Always utter the Name RADHASOAMI. Keep your 
eyes steadfastly fixed on Radhasoami, for His 
Darshan. (35) 



80 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

Do not divulge to anybody the secrets, given out by 
Radhasoami. Without Radhasoami, you will get 
lost in the world. (36) 

Radhasoami has given me the ornament of Shabd. 
Radhasoami is the moon which will not be 
eclipsed. (37) 

In the company of Radhasoami, you will not suffer 
pain, you will always be happy and gay. (38) 

Radhasoami has bestowed supreme bliss on me. 
Radhasoami has helped me cross the ocean of 
life. (39) 

Radhasoami has freed me from rituals and observances. 
I lick the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (40) 

I perform Arti of Radhasoami every day. I always cherish 
instructions of Radhasoami at heart. (41) 

I keep my love for Radhasoami alive and fresh. I 

always recite Radhasoami Nam. (42) 

I follow the behest of Radhasoami. Now I meet 

Radhasoami in Dhyan. (43) 

Ever since I received the ?tik Prashad (holy food) 
of Radhasoami, I have been cleansed of all 
impurities. (44) 

Tell me, O dear ! How can I sing the praises of 

Radhasoami ? Radhasoami has shown me the alley 
in the sky (the path leading to higher regions). (45) 

Radhasoami has stirred me to gird up my loins. 
Radhasoami has made me cling to the Dhun of 
Radhasoami. (46) 



3] Radhasoami [ 81 

Radhasoami has accomplished my task in every way. 
Radhasoami has given me a unique equipment. (47) 

The Abode of Radhasoami is very high. I have repaired 
to that Region and got Darshan of Radhasoami 
there. (48) 

The glory and grandeur of Radhasoami is unique. 
My eyes remain fixed on Radhasoami's lovely 
Form. (49) 

Radhasoami effects redemption of Jivas. Radhasoami 
has incarnated Himself here as Sant Sat Guru. (50) 

Radhasoami Mat (Faith) is a unique religion. Radhasoami 
has now revealed the most sublime mysteries and 
secrets. (51) 

Radhasoami does not count upon Brahm Gyan (know- 
ledge of Brahm) as a thing of any value. Radhasoami 
attaches no importance to Yoga and Dhyan 
(practices of olden times by which the knowledge 
of Brahm was attainable). (52) 

Radhasoami does not prescribe the worship of Ram 1 , 
Krishan 2 , Brahma 3 , Vishnu 4 , Shiva 5 , Ganesh 6 , Gaur 7 
and Shesh 8 . (53-54) 



1. Seventh incarnation of the Hindus. 2. Eighth incarnation 
of the Hindus. 3. One of the three deities of the Hindu 
Trinity, entrusted with the work of creating the world. 4. 
Name of one of the principal Hindu deities regarded as 
the Preserver. 5. Name of one of the gods of the Hindu 
Triad, the deity of destruction. 6. Son of Shiva, the deity 
of the lowest centre, at the rectum. 7. Name of the wife 
of Shiva. 8. Name of a celebrated mythological thousand 
headed serpent. 



82 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

Radhasoami does not approve of ^TT Karam and 
WM Dharam (acts and duties as prescribed by 
old scriptures). Radhasoami considers ^rc Japa 1 
and ?rq Tapa 2 illusory. (55) 

Radhasoami does not attach any spiritual value to 
pilgrimages or fasts. Radhasoami does not attach 
importance to Shastras and Smritis. (56) 

Radhasoami attaches no sanctity to the sun or the 
moon. Radhasoami does not believe in the sanctity 
of the Ganga 3 or the Yamuna 4 . (57) 

Radhasoami saves Jivas from adherence to traditions 
and observances. Radhasoami does not admit of 
any type of superstitious beliefs. (58) 

Radhasoami does not approve of idol worship. 
Radhasoami denounces the worship of the fT>T 
Pitras (ancestors). (59) 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you to perform Guru Bhakti 
(devotion to Guru). Radhasoami prescribes Bhajan 
of Nad (sound practice). (60) 

Radhasoami exhorts you to attend Satsang. Radhasoami 
attaches importance to the Guru of the time. (61) 

Radhasoami makes no distinction of caste and creed. 
Radhasoami treats a Hindu and a Mohammedan 
alike. (62) 



1. Old method of repeating holy names and Mantras. 2. Old 
method of practising penances. 3. The river Ganges, 
4. Name of a river. 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 83 

Radhasoami does not approve of caste sysem. 

Radhasoami says all this is false. (63) 

Radhasoami has promulgated the mode of Bhakti. 
Radhasoami lays emphasis on sincere devotion 
to Guru. (64) 

Radhasoami does away with the Vedas and other 
revealed books. Radhasoami lays stress on the 
words of Guru. (65) 

Radhasoami shows the Supreme Father Himself in 
the person of Murshid or Guru. Radhasoami teaches 
the worship of Guru. (66) 

Radhasoami does away with Roza 1 and Narmaz 2 . 
Radhasoami discards Masjid 3 and Baang 4 . (67) 



5 



Radhasoami does not approve of pilgrimage to Kaba 
Radhasoami does not prescribe the Quran 6 and 
Wazifa 7 . (68) 

Radhasoami enables a devotee to hold his mind 
steady. Radhasoami enables him to control his 
passions. (69) 

Radhasoami elevates Surat (spirit entity) to heavenly 
regions. Radhasoami shows us the Arsh (Chaitanya 
Akash, spiritualized sky) within ourselves. (70) 

Radhasoami raises Rooh (spirit entity) to higher 
regions. Radhasoami enables us to meet Khuda 
within us. (71) 

1. Fasting. 2. Prayers. 3. Mosque. 4. Call to prayer prevalent 
among Mohammedans. 5. The mosque of Mecca. 6. The 
sacred book of the Mohammedans. 7. Daily prayers. 



84 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

Radhasoami assigns a high status to a^F^^iFaqir 

(Sant). Radhasoami says that prophets cannot attain 
that position. (72) 

Radhasoami shows us the seven heavens or regions. 
Radhasoami gives out the details of the stages 
through which a Faqir (Sant) passes. (73) 

Radhasoami prescribes the practice of Surat Shabd 
Yoga. Radhasoami enables Rooh (spirit) to hear 
Shabd (sound coming from heavenly spheres 
above). (74) 

Radhasoami churns Surat and Shabd. Radhasoami 

speaks of Surat and Shabd. (75) 

Radhasoami speaks ofsp^ u^Anhad Shabd. 
Radhasoami enables a devotee to catch hold of 
the eternal sound. (76) 

Radhasoami has come from Prime and Original Abode. 
Radhasoami reaches the Highest Abode. (77) 

Know that the very starting point of Radhasoami Faith 
is the final goal of all other religions. (78) 

What Radhasoami calls the first stage on the journey 
homeward, is the f&^rra T^Siddhant Pad (goal) 
of all other religions. (79) 

Radhasoami Faith is the highest and most exalted. I 
have now come to realize this about Radhasoami 
Religion. ' (80) 

Radhasoami describes the seven stages or regions. 
Radhasoami gives out the details of each stage. (81) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ 85 

The status of Radhasoami is the highest and the most 
exalted in every respect. My Surat is tenaciously 
attached to the Holy, Feet of Radhasoami. (82) 

Radhasoami abides in Hairat 1 Dharm. Radhasoami 

gives out unique Nam. (83) 

Radhasoami is magnet, I am iron. The moment I saw 
the Rup (Form) of Radhasoami I was attracted to 
and became enamoured of Him. (84) 

Radhasoami is the *fft Bhringi. I am an insect. Radha- 
soami has relieved me of all pain and suffering. (85) 

[When an insect is caught by a Bhringi (a large black- 
bee), the latter stings it. The insect, giving up all struggle, 
becomes passive though not dead. The Bhringi then makes 
the insect hear its humming sound. The result is that 
the insect is converted into a Bhringi in course of time.] 

Radhasoami reaches the highest and farthest region. 
Radhasoami has Himself given out the secrets of 
His own region. (86) 

Radhasoami is lotus, I am a ^rrrjBhonra (black-bee), 
mad after Him, Darshan of Radhasoami has made 
me bloom. (87) 

Do what Radhasoami ordains. Place your head at 

the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (88) 

There is none who can be compared with Radhasoami. 
By adopting the Saran of Radhasoami, Jivas secure 
redemption. (89) 

I live on by gazing at the Form of Radhasoami. I drink 
the nectar of the Holy Name RADHASOAMI. (90) 

1. Astonishing, amazing. 



86 ] In Praise of [ Bachan 

In the company of Radhasoami, I explore heavenly 
regions within me. In the company of Radhasoami 
I get a glimpse of His Mauj. (91) 

In the company of Radhasoami, I now concentrate 
my spirit at the third Til. In the company of Radha- 
soami, I hear the reverberations of Shabd. (92) 

In the company of Radhasoami, I pierce through the 
third Til, and proceed further. In the company of 
Radhasoami, I penetrate heavenly regions and meet 
Him. (93) 

In the company of Radhasoami, I see Jyoti (of Sahas- 
dal-kanwal). In the company of Radhasoami, I learn 
the secrets of Sunn (below Sahas-dal-kanwal). (94) 

In the comapny of Radhasoami, I enter Banknal. In 
the company of Radhasoami, I ascend to Gagan 
(Trikuti) and feel elated. (95) 

In the company of Radhasoami, I attain Daswan Dwar 
(the tenth door). In the company of Radhasoami, 
I ascend to Maha-sunn. (96) 

In the company of Radhasoami, I dwell in Bhanwar- 
gupha. In the company of Radhasoami, I become 
attached to Sat Nam. (97) 

In the comapny of Radhasoami, I perceive Alakh. In the 
company of Radhasoami, I speak of Agam. (98) 

I am inbued with the colour (love) of Radhasoami. I 

find abode in Radhasoami Dharm. (99) 

I do what Radhasoami ordains. I hold fast to 

Radhasoami. (100) 



3 ] Radhasoami [ '87 

I dearly observe the graceful activities of Radhasoami. 
I have gained admittance into Radhasoami's 
mansion. (101) 

The splendour and grandeur of Radhasoami is unique. 
I remain standing humbly in the august presence 
of Radhasoami. (102) 

Radhasoami is seated majestically on the throne. Radha- 
soami burns away hardest of sins and evils. (103) 

Radhasoami is now granting pardon to Jivas. Radhasoami 
has now become my beloved spouse. (104) 

Radhasoami has become exceedingly compassionate 
and merciful. By Radhasoami's grace Jama and 
Kal have been annihilated. (105) 

Radhasoami has now made mearc^Amar (immortal). 
Radhasoami has granted me abode in His eternal 
region. (106) 

I sing in gratefulness the praises of Radhasoami all 
the time. Radhasoami is my father, Radhasoami 
is my mother. (107) 

Radhasoami has detached me from all. Radhasoami 
has shattered my reliance and dependence on the 
world and its objects. (108) 



BACHAN 4 



THE GLORY AND IMPORTANCE 

OF DARSHAN OF PARAM PURUSH PURAN 

DHANI RADHASOAMIAND THE 

EXALTED STATE OF LOVE AND 

BLISS WHICH HIS DARSHAN BRINGS IN. 



Shabd 1 

3art j\ w$t tftfF wr *rarrf i 
am -^ 3TPF3 it ^ wnrf n s u 

Sakhi (friend)! Congratulate me heartily. My heart 

is now overflowing with joy. (1) 

Again and again I gaze at Radhasoami and feel exhi- 
larated. The elegance and beauty of His counte- 
nance is not possible for me to describe. (2) 

1 have prepared a Thali (platter) for performing Arti. 

Saturated with love, I am singing His praises. (3) 

My attachment to the Holy Feet of Guru has grown 

intense. I am filled with great joy. (4) 



Bachan4] Radhasoami [89 

I fail to describe how pleasant this auspicious occasion 
is! The Surat - Hansani 1 has been completely 
enamoured. (5) 

The Shabd Guru has enabled me to hear the Dhun 
(sound) of Gagan (Trikuti). The current of Ami (Amrit, 
nectar) is coming from the highest region. (6) 

My brother! How am I to describe this merrymaking? 
Every part and pore of my body is drenched in 
bliss. (7) 

However, I have given some idea in writing, which the 
disciples of my Guru alone will appreciate. (8) 

Radhasoami announces that His sway prevails in all 
the four Loks (regions). (9) 

The Bin (harp) of Satnarm is resounding and the 

mighty Kal falls into a state of swoon. (10) 

Alakh and Agam shower grace and mercy on me. 
Radhasoami has graciously granted me His 
Darshan. (11) 



Shabd 2 

arnr simm Tnuwi*fl m^ i 

"ETT^r <£cM "ipn ^q 3TCTS it q II 

Today I sing the praises of Radhasoami in profound 
thankfulness. I enhance my love for the Lotus Feet 
of Guru. (1) 

1. Feminine gender of Hansa. 



90 ] Darshan of [ Bachan 

I am now filled with immense happiness. I have fixed 
the Rup (Form) of Radhasoami in my heart. (2) 

I am today favoured with a unique fortune. The Darshan 
of Radhasoami has nursed my mind. (3) 

The perfect Sat Guru has embraced me. Radhasoami 
has showed me a unique spectacle. (4) 

Anhad Shabd resounds within me. The glory of 

Radhasoami has dawned upon me. (5) 

My most profound and sublime luck has awakened. 
My mind now feels elated on uttering RADHASOAMI 
Nam. (6) 

The massive doors to ^Nfs 34i=hi?iChaitanya Akash 
(P=Ki<*m Chidakash) have opened for me. I have 
got Darshan of Radhasoami. (7) 

How should I describe His majestic grandeur? I gaze 
at Radhasoami with my eyes wide open. (8) 

I am sustained by Darshan all the time. I sing praises 
of Radhasoami every moment. (9) 

Singing His praises, my mind is highly exhilarated. I 
now fondly cherish the hope of attaining the Holy 
Feet of Radhasoami. (10) 

I am as happy in the company of Radhasoami as a 
fish is in water. I cannot leave His refuge. (11) 

I always play with Radhasoami. He has removed all 
delusions and illusions. (12) 

Purified, I stick fast to the Holy Feet of Radhasoami, 
who is inaccessible and unapproachable. (13) 



4] Radhasoami [91 

Festivity and rejoicing are going on all round. I merrily 
sing songs of thanksgiving before Radhasoami. (14) 

This is a unique song of thanksgiving, I have sung 
before Radhasoami. By withdrawing within from 
without I have won the pleasure of my Lord, 
Radhasoami. (15) 



Shabd 3 

3TFJT "^ S£T ^ f ?mi I 

Today I am in a state of supreme exhilaration. How 
should I describe the "F^Rup (Form) of Radhasoami 
I have seen? (1) 

The 'g^sriPTSukhman (middle) current has begun to 

function. I perform Arti of Radhasoami. (2) 

My Surat is drenched in the colour of love. In the 
company of Nirat (the faculty of discernment), I 
now recite the Name RADHASOAMI. (3) 

I go to Sunn and imbibe the Shabd resounding 
there. I place my forehead at the Holy Feet of 
Radhasoami. (4) 

What a rare Arti (prayer) am I singing ! The rever- 
berations of Radhasoami Nam have now become 
dear to me. (5) 

How can one know of the most exalted status of 

Radhasoami? Inscrutable are His ways! (6) 



92 ] Darshan of [ Bachan 

Freeing myself from the bondages of body and mind, 
I ascend to the eternal terrace of the most marvellous 
mansion of the Supreme Father Radhasoami Dayal, 
where lies His throne. (7) 

I wait upon Him day and night. Radhasoami has given 
me3T*ftTSTArmi-ras (nectar) for my sustenance. (8) 

My most exalted fortune has now awakened. I have 
been enabled to see the majestic splendour of 
Radhasoami. (9) 

Who is lucky enough to get inner light? Radhasoami 

has bestowed a great boon upon me. (10) 

Shabds of heavenly regions are constantly resounding 
within me. Radhasoami has made me His own. (11) 

I discard the Shabd coming from^?T!ra (left side) and 
search for the Shabd coming from fr'MiPingla (right 
side). I ascend tofrrercShikhar (top) and hear the 
reverberation of Radhasoami Nam. (12) 

I come to the region of Sohang (Bhanwargupha) and 
hear the Bansi (flute). I get a clue to the unique 
status of Radhasoami. (13) 

The Holy word RADHASOAMI is such an effective 
dagger that Kal is vanquished and Karams are 
destroyed. (14) 

The Surat-Panihari reaches Satt Sar (the lake of Sat, 
Truth, Spirituality). Radhasoami fills my Gagri 
(pitcher) to the full. (15) 

[Panihari or Paniharin is a poetic expression for spirit 
entity. It suggests a village woman, usually newly married 



4] Radhasoami [93 

or a virgin carrying a pitcher or pitchers of water on her 
head at the crack of dawn. To keep balance, she walks 
with slow regular steps in a perfect rythmic gait, looking 
extraordinarily beautiful and charming, while stepping on 
zigzag footpaths in green fields studded with pearls of 
dew amidst the twilight of the rising sun. The sight of a 
Paniharin feasts poetic eyes and is considered very auspicious. 
Paniharin stands for a true and perfect natural beauty. 
The spirit entity on reaching spiritual regions, begins to 
attain its true Rup (form), uncontaminated with mind and 
matter. 

[ForGagri, pitcher, see couplet 29, Shabd 4, 
Bachan 3, supra]. 

My Surat becomes a Hansani, beloved of the Hansas 
(denizens of Sat Lok). She drinks nectar of Radha- 
soami Nam. (16) 

I fail to describe the greatnesss of Radhasoami. I 

have performed Arti of Radhasoami. (17) 



Shabd 4 

The seeker-Surat ascended beyond Gagan (Trikuti) 
and heard the constant resonance of RADHASOAMI 
Nam. (1) 

The loving Surat, on reaching Daswan Dwar, experienced 
happiness. Radhasoami vanquished Maya, the 
cheat. (2) 

The keen-nosed Surat observed the'H<n<(iPiRMalya-giri, 



94 ] Darshan of [ Bachan 

the mountain abounding in sandal trees, and inhaled 
sweet fragrance emanating from there. She obtained 
RADHASOAMI Nam, the essence of all. (3) 

The wise Surat saw the current of Shabd. Radhasoami 
sang the Mallar 1 Rag. (4) 

My Surat has become Bairagin, i.e., indifferent and 
disinclined to worldly desires and passions. She 
has made the Holy Feet of Radhasoami her support 
and sustenance. (5) 

The beloved Surat went on, following the Holy Name. 
She majestically attained the nuptial bed prepared 
by Radhasoami. (6) 

By Mauj, she arrived at the Abode of my Lord, Radha- 
soami. She offered her entire self to Him. (7) 

There I witnessed His true glory and grandeur. She 
adored the Holy Feet of Radhasoami again and 
again. (8) 

She went on, peeped through the window, and got 
Darshan of the beatific form of Radhasoami. (9) 

She reversed the direction of the current flowing from 
eyes. She touched the Feet of Radhasoami. She 
gave up Ahankar (egotism). (10) 

Radhasoami has cast such a benign look on her that 
all the evils of her mind have departed. (11) 

She has now no worldly desire left in her. Radhasoami 



1. Mallar = Name of a musical mode, sung during the rains. Idiom 
to sing a mallar means to be merry. 



4] Radhasoami [95 

has removed all doubts and misgivings from her 
mind. (12) 

Radhasoami has struck with such a sharp-edged sword 
and has used such a strategem that the mind 
has been killed. (13) 

Radhasoami has carefully shot an arrow at the hind 
(Maya); she ran away from the field, vanquished. (14) 

What a wondrous spectacle I behold! Radhasoami 

showed me a garden of flowers. (15) 

Here, there and everywhere, flowers of Shabd have 
blossomed. I am now enamoured of Radhasoami. (16) 

In His region, Shabd is resounding incessantly. 

Radhasoami has adorned my Surat. (17) 



Shabd 5 

■qcT TJrT "f^T "f^T tnr 7ff?ft II S II 

Today I will have Darshan of Radhasoami. All the 
time I will keep myself on the other side (beyond 
the region of Pind). (1) 

I will keep away from the snares of the world. I will knock 
down Kal and Karam and kick them away. (2) 

I will elevate my Surat, and station it in higher regions, 
where I will take stroll. (3) 

I will hear an endless melody there, and enjoy the 

bliss of Shabd. ' (4) 



96 ] Darshan of [Bachan 

Thus getting strength, I will catch hold of the Feet of 
Guru with a firm resolve. I will play in Sukhmana 
(the middle current). (5) 

I will easily enter into Banknal (the crooked tunnel). 
I will then go to Tirikuti and hear the sound of 
Om. (6) 

I will go to Bhanwargupha beyond Sunn and Maha- 

sunn. I will stay in Sat Lok. (7) 

I will daily hear Shabds of Alakh and Agam. I will 

touch the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (8) 



Shabd 6 

^p3tt TFt Tt im W ~% II 1 II 

I am gazing at the countenance of the perfect Guru 

and enjoying the bliss of love. (1) 

The majestic grandeur of Sat Guru is indescribable. 

The Anhad Shabd is resounding within. (2) 

The drop (spirit entity) leaves Pind, the unreal world, 
and ascends higher, and reaches the ocean of 
the refulgence of Sat (Truth). (3) 

When I hear thunder in Gagan (Trikuti), my yearning 
is awakened; and coward mind becomes brave 
and courageous. (4) 

I have enshrined the Lotus Feet of Guru in my heart. 



4] Radhasoami [97 

Tamo-guna is being crushed and getting pulverised 
every moment. (5) 

Sat Guru has cast His glance of mercy upon me. 

The wheel of Kal is now broken. (6) 

My Surat merges into^"^ ^tfcr Samund Sot (region 
of Sunn). I see beautiful nymphs in the Mansarovar 
lake. (7) 

I elevate my Surat and get to Sat Nam (Sat Lok), and 
then I attain the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (8) 



Shabd 7 

ipr ^ -sttf ITT t •ifclgKl i 

I sacrifice myself at the Darshan of Guru. The Holy 

Feet of Guru are my life and breath. (1) 

His Bachans (discourses) are the embellishment of 
my heart. The countenance of Guru I keep on 
remembering day and night. (2) 

O my darling! Associate with Guru every moment. 
Behold Him with your eyes and merge in Him. (3) 

Fix your Surat in Guru's Dharm. Ascend to Neel Shikhar 
and look at Shyarm (Kal). (4) 

You will see the white resplendent sun and hear Anhad 
Shabd. (5) 



98 ] Darshan of [ Bachan 

You will hear the melodious Murli and Bin (flute and harp); 
you will receive unique bliss and happiness. (6) 

Rare Sants have disclosed these secrets. You also go 
to and accept the Saran (refuge) of a Sant. (7) 

A fish becomes one with water, and a Chakor (bird) 

fixes its gaze constantly at the moon. (8) 

Should you love Sat Guru the same way, by engendering 
faith in Him, your inner self will be illuminated. (9) 

But what can you do without the requisite Bhag (fitness)? 
This requisite fitness, too, will be gained by the 
grace of Guru. (10) 

Radhasoami has indicated the true method of awake- 
ning the Bhag (fitness). Cultivate love for His 
Holy Feet. (11) 



Shabd 8 

_____ __ *. _£_ 

fm 3TTCPT ^TT II <1 II 

Take your seat at the third Til and have Guru's Darshan 
there. (1) 

Always hear Guru's Shabd. By attaching yourself to 
Him, you will be able to annihilate all desires. (2) 

The Swarup (Form, Countenance) of Guru is highly 
pleasing and supremely refulgent like the sun. On 
seeing the sun, lotus expands its petals. And on 



4] Radhasoami [ 99 

seeing the lotus with petals expanded, the Bhonra 
(blackbee) becomes enamoured of it. You should 
love your Guru just as Bhonra (black-bee) loves 
the lotus and the lotus loves the sun. (3-4) 

The hearts of those who have not been fortunate enough 
to receive Gyan (knowledge) from Guru, remain 
shrouded in darkness. (5) 

They have not met a perfect Sat Guru. They remain 

wandering in the snares of the world. (6) 

Luckily I have met the Sat Guru. I sacrifice myself at 
Him. (7) 

I gaze at the Swarup (Form) of Guru the way a Chakor 
gazes at the moon. (8) 

Sat Guru is Shabd-swarup, that is, Shabd incarnate. 
His abode is in higher regions. (9) 

You are also Surat-swarup, that is, your real form is 
also Surat, (not body or mind); follow Guru. (10) 

Guru's Rup (Form) is in the eyes. Open your eyes. (11) 

Guru's Shabd is in the inner ears. Listen to the 

Shabd (sound) coming from Gagan. (12) 

Radhasoami is revealing the secrets of the real path. (13) 

Those who are fortunate enough to follow it shall cross 
the ocean of existence. (14) 



BACHAN 5 



SECRETS OF THE PATH. THE GLORY 

OF SAT LOK. THE MAJESTIC GRANDEUR 

OF THE TRUE FORM AND TRUE ABODE 

OF PARAM PURUSH PURAN DHANI 

RADHASOAMI 



Shabd 1 

#i *rc*c % ffer?r ^ %r n s ii 

This Sewak (servant) of Thy Holy Feet sings Arti 
(prayer). Doubts and delusions have confused his 
mind. (1) 

O Soami! Now shower such grace that my doubts 

are removed, root and branch. (2) 

Thus cleansed, may I apply myself to Shabd and rest 
in Daswan Dwar (Sunn). (3) 

Beyond is the vast expanse of Maha-sunn. If it be 

Thy Mauj, I proceed thither. (4) 

Ahead is the window to Bhanwargupha, where the 
Dhun of Sohang is resounding day and night. (5) 



Bachan 5 ] Glory of Sat Lok [ 101 

Reaching there, I partake of the bliss of that region, 

and elevate my Surat further. (6) 

Next is the region of Sat Nam and Sat Shabd, termed 
the fourth Pad (Region) by Sants. (7) 

The beauty and elegance of Hansas (denizens) cannot 
be adequately described. Each has a lustre of 
sixteen suns and moons. (8) 

How am I to describe the wondrous Form of the Deity 
of the region? Each hair has the resplendence of 
ten million suns and moons. (9) 

Gracefully designed and decorated are the Dweeps 
(islands) in each of which lives a Hans. (10) 

Huge reservoirs of Ami (Amrit, nectar) are overflowing 
there. The Darshan (vision) of Sat Purush is the 
sustenance of the Hansas. (11) 

Every day new spectacles are witnessed there. How 
should I describe the glory of that region! (12) 

Beyond is Alakh Lok. Giving up subtle l-ness, my 

Surat goes there. (13) 

How can the brilliance of Alakh Purush be described? 
Thousand million suns and moons look dull in 
comparison. (14) 

Each Surat has a lustre of ten million suns. Such is 

the form of Surats there. (15) 

My Surat gracefully steps forward and reaches Agam 
Lok. I observe the grandeur of that region. (16) 



102 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 

Unique is the majesty of Agam Purush. The resplendence 
exceeds a hundred thousand million suns. (17) 

Beyond it, is Anarmi Purush who is Akah (indescribable) 
and Apar (infinite). (18) 

Save Sants, no one has access there. Sants call itf^T 
^R Nij Ghar (the True and Original abode). (19) 

O Soami! You have given out the most sublime secret. (20) 

Now, also be pleased to indicate how I can reach 
there. Do awaken deep longing and yearning in 
my heart. (21) 

Soami has pointed out the method of Surat Shabd 
Yoga, and cautioned that it is not possible to reach 
there without Daya (grace and mercy). (22) 

Have no doubt about the efficacy of Surat Shabd 
Yoga. Merge your Surat in Shabd slowly and 
gradually. (23) 

Soami has repeatedly enjoined upon all to practise 

Surat Shabd Yoga regularly. (24) 

The Arti (hymn of prayer) is now over. Sant Mat has 

been fully explained. (25) 



Shabd 2 

3TF3T 3TFT?fr J^R "2fZ^ STTCt I 

Today, I am performing a grand Arti; my support is 

Sumiran (repetition) of RADHASOAMI. (1) 



5 ] Glory of Sat Lok [ 103 

The pupil of the eye is the Thaii (platter) for Arti, 
and Jyoti the lamp. Overflowing with love, I come 
before Soami. (2) 

I am having Darshan of Radhasoami with my eyes. I 
enshrine His Rup (Form) in my heart. (3) 

I was Chakvi and Sat Guru was the Chakva. When 
the night (of ignorance) fell, I was separated from 
Him. (4) 

[See note to couplet 24, Shabd 4, Bachan 3 above.] 

I was plunged into darkness. I remained restless on 
this end. My Sat Guru, my Lord, is on the other 
end. How could I join Him? I did not find the 
way. (5-6) 

Separated from my Beloved I was writhing in 

agony every moment. How am I to unite with my 
Lord? (7) 

Extremely restless and impatient, I called out Soami. 
He took me in His care. (8) 

By His grace, the night was soon over, the day broke 
and the sun rose within me. (9) 

I was lying void below the region of the eyes, namely, 
Pind. Guru revealed to me the book telling of the 
other side, namely, Brahmand and Dayal Desh. (10) 

I removed the barrier and met the Guru, who enabled me 
to embark on the internal path of Parmarth. (11) 

My Surat went in and mingled with Shabd like iron 
filings attracted to and joined with a magnet. (12) 



104 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 

Concentrating my Surat, I peeped through the door 

and penetrated the eye of the needle. (13) 

How can I describe the spectacle I witnessed on 
penetrating within? It concerned the region 
unapproachable. (14) 

The omniscient Sat Guru knows it. Or, one to whom the 
Sat Guru reveals these secrets, will know it. (15) 

I penetrated beyond the third Til and heard the Dhun 
(sounds) of the bell and the conch. (16) 

I saw the sun and the moon on either side. I also saw 
Sukhman in the middle, and sky and stars. (17) 

I penetrated further, and reached Banknal (the 

crooked tunnel) where Kal has spread his extensive 
net. (18) 

Proceeding onward, I arrived at Trikuti. I beheld the 

red sky and heard the Dhun of Omkar. (19) 

Then, I went to Sunn, Daswan Dwar, and bathed in 

Mansarovar with Hansas. (20) 

That region is Sait (white), full of bright moon light. (21) 

I ascended to Shikhar (top) and got across Mahasunn. (22) 

I opened the niche of Bhanwargupha, and heard the 
sound of Sohang and Murli (flute). (23) 

Beyond the square, I entered Sat Lok. I got Darshan 
of Sat Purush and heard the Bin (harp). (24) 

Each hair of Sat Purush has the brilliance of ten 

million suns and moons. (25) 



5] Glory of Sat Lok [105 

With the permission of Sat Purush, I went quickly to 

Alakh Lok. (26) 

Thousand million suns and moons look pale before 

the refulgence of this region. (27) 

With the permission of Alakh Purush I proceeded further 
and met Agam Purush. (28) 

The resplendence of each hair of Agam Purush exceeds 
the light of a hundred thousand million suns and 
moons. What more can be said of the infinitely 
vast region of Agam Lok? (29) 

I went further. Both Surat and Nirat merged in the 

fra ^ Nij Pad. (30) 

[That faculty of spirit which is ever ready to be absorbed 
in the bliss and joy of any centre or region is called 
"Surat". While "Nirat" is that which awakens the desire to 
leave that bliss and joy, and yearns for that of the higher 
centre or the region. At each and every centre, Surat 
and Nirat faculties go on asserting themselves, till the 
spirit of the devotee finally reaches Radhasoami Dham, 
the Nij Pad and the Highest Region. There, Surat and 
Nirat become one.] 

That Nij Pad is Radhasoami Dham. Again and again 
I utter Radhasoami. (31) 

How should I describe the grandeur of that Dham 

(Region)? Each cordon of the palace is ornamented 
with hundred million suns and moons. (32) 

Palaces are bedecked with billions and billions of 

jewels. I cannot adequately express the magnificence 
of that Dham. (33) 



106 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 

I saw billions and trillions of suns and moons round 

the throne. (34) 

The Swarup (Form) of Supreme Father Radhasoami 
is indescribable, unsurpassed and unrivalled. (35) 

What illustration should I give about the glory and 
majesty of Radhasoami? Digits have all been 
exhausted. (36) 

I have dwelt on this most excellent Arti. I can say no 
more. I am now the foremost. (37) 



Shabd 3 

I look at a wonderful city. Guru has equipped me 

with a master key. (1) 

I have heard Anhad Shabd and seen the most 
wondrous form. (2) 

What is to be said of the great favour Guru has done to 
me! I have become the darling of Radhasoami. (3) 

I have left the alien region, and have found abode in 
the mansion of Radhasoami. (4) 

my brother! How can I dwell upon the glory of 

Guru who gave out these secrets to me. (5) 

1 have now devoutly taken Saran of Radhasoami. 

Insignificant that I am, how can I describe His all 
round exalted position? (6) 



5 ] Glory of Sat Lok [ 107 

I am fortunate that Shabd appeals to me. I have enjoyed 
the bliss of Nam and am engaged in working out 
my salvation. (7) 

On coming in contact with the Sukhman (middle current), 
my Surat was purified. It went on proceeding further 
and ascended to ^*TNabha (sky). (8) 

I withdrew the spirit current from the two eyes and saw 
Jyoti. My Surat entered Sahas-dal-Kanwal. (9) 

I left Shyarm (black spots or pupils of the eyes) and 
beheld the Sait 1 Rup 2 . I passed through Banknal 
and came to Trikuti. (10) 

I heard the melodious sounds of Ong and thunder, 

and saw the red morning sun. (11) 

I reached Sunn and bathed in the Mansarovar lake. 
I heard the melodious sounds of Rarang and Kingri 
(fiddle). (12) 

I became a Hans and went ahead. On passing through 
Maha-sunn, my Surat was highly embellished. (13) 

I heard the sound coming from Bhanwargupha, and 
soon reached there. The sweet notes of the Bansri 
(flute) and the sound of Sohang are resounding 
all round. (14) 

From there I rushed up and reached Sach Khand. I beheld 
the marvellous Rup (Form) of Sat Purush. (15) 

1. White, illumined. 2. Form. 



1Q8 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 

My Surat was highly enraptured on hearing the Bin 
(harp). The great kindness shown to me, cannot 
be described. (16) 

Guru showed me Aiakh Lok. I lifted the curtain and 

entered Agam Lok. (17) 

From there was visible the Dham of Radhasoami. I went 
higher up and got merged in His Holy Feet. (18) 

I prepared a wonderful Arti. Gracefully decorated is 

the mansion of my beloved Lord. (19) 

I took my seat there and got Darshan of Radhasoami 
in full splendour. I am filled with love and 
ecstasy. (20) 

All my companions congratulate me jointly. Today my 
life has become truly fruitful. (21) 

Both Brahm and Maya are put to shame. Kal is crestfallen 
and Karam has withered. (22) 

Yoga practices and Gyan Marg (the religion of Vedant) 
are miserably exhausted. None got even an iota 
of the sublime secrets described above. (23) 

Sant Mat, which teaches Surat Shabd Yoga is the 

only true religion or path. (24) 

The Vedas cannot attain the glory and supremacy of 
Sants. Radhasoami has now disclosed the real 
position. (25) 



5 ] Glory of Sat Lok [ 109 

Shabd 4 

TH ^HT 7F^ -3fR "CRW II ^ II 

Unique is the path shown by the Guru. My mind and 
Surat have come in contact with Shabd. (1) 

I have seen great scenes and spectacles within. My 
Surat has become a celestial water carrier. (2) 

I have drunk Amrit (nectar) to my heart's content. My 
body and mind have become YftcT5T Shital (cool, 
happy and contented). (3) 

Thieves (the five evils, viz., Kam, Krodh, Lobh, Moh 
and Ahankar) have given up robbery. Their dwellings 
have been burnt. (4) 

Sahus (faculties of piety, patience and forgiveness, 
contentment, discrimination, humility and subrmis- 
siveness) which command respect, have awakened 
within me, and are vigilant and watchful. My love 
for Shabd has increased. (5) 

I feel pleasure in singing the praises of Shabd. Following 
the Dhun (sound), I elevate my Surat to higher 
regions. (6) 

A dazzling flame has burst out and lotuses have 

blossomed forth within me. (7) 

I have opened the window to celestial regions. I now 
hear the sound coming from Sukhmana or the middle 
current. (8) 

I went up to Banknal (crooked tunnel), opened the 



110 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 

door and reached. Trikuti. My Surat became srqfo 
Amol (priceless). (9) 

Like a Tamoli, my Surat now sorts out the Shabd 
coming from the middle or the right side, and 
discards those coming from the left. (10) 

[A Tamoli is he whose business it is to sell Pan (betel 
leaves). He keeps on sorting out the fresh bands from the 
rotten ones.] 

What should I sing of the glory of the Guru Pad (Trikuti)! 
Every moment I am enhancing my enthusiasm. (11) 

^7 Sur (gods), u Nar (human beings) and^t^Muni 
(sages) could not fathom the status of my Guru. 
This is an indescribably wonderful story. (12) 

I went to Sunn and merged in the Shabd. I heard the 
wonderful Kingri (fiddle). (13) 

I then reached Maha-sunn. By the Daya (grace) of 
Guru, I witnessed a wonderful spectacle there. (14) 

I proceeded to Bhanwargupha and united my Surat 
with Sohang Purush. (15) 

Entering Sat Lok, I realized that Sat Guru Pad alone 
is true. What should I say about its status, glory 
and eminence? (16) 

There are rows and rows of suns and moons. I beheld 
all these and went onwards. (17) 

I got Darshan of Alakh and Agam, and then I met 

Radhasoami, my goal. (18) 



5 ] Glory of Sat Lok [ 111 

This is the Param pad (the highest and most exalted 
stage). None had spoken of IT. (19) 

Neither the Vedas nor other religious books had des- 
cribed IT. Nor Yogis and Gyanis reached IT. (20) 

I have been a recipient of this priceless boon. Even 
among Sants, it has been the privilege of only 
some rare Sants to hint about IT. (21) 

My beloved Radhasoami is Param Dayal (Supremely 
Merciful). He has made me enriched. (22) 

I perform His Arti and offer both my body and mind 

at His Feet. (23) 

This is my prayer that I may ever remain in the fold 

of this most sublime Faith. (24) 

I am fortunate that I am devoted to the Holy Feet of 

Radhasoami. (25) 

When I learnt to recite and utter RADHASOAMI Nam, 
all pleasures of the world began to appear tasteless 
and insipid. (26) 

Guru has reversed the downward flow of my mind. He 
has directed my Surat upwards, and put it on the 
straight path to Param Pad. (27) 

My task has been fully completed. I have become the 
dust of the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (28) 



112 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 

Shabd 5 

Tg§ Tfl$ 3T?TT S& im\ I 
3mH WTT 3TR «*(WI II 1 II 

It is all happiness within me. I have made preparations 
for the Arti ceremony. (1) 

Immense joy and bliss have filled my heart. My attention 
is riveted to the Holy Feet of the Guru. (2) 

I got Darshan of Guru, and sang His glory. His peerless 
countenance has settled in my eyes. (3) 

The sun of love has arisen within me and has dispelled 
the darkness of illusions and delusions. (4) 

My good fortune has awakened that I have contacted 
Anhad Shabd, and have bathed in the current of 
Sukhman and have thus performed pilgrimage 
internally. (5) 

I have turned the pupils of my eyes towards Sahas- 
dal-kanwal. Giving up the company of mind, I rushed 
upward with Surat. (6) 

I fail to describe the great happiness I experienced 

on beholding Jyoti and Niranjan. (7) 

I heard the sounds of the bell and the conch and 

saw suns, moons and stars. (8) 

I opened the door to Banknal and ascended to Trikuti 
and there came in contact with Guru's Shabd. (9) 

Trikuti is the region of the sun. It is the origin and' 
source of the Vedas. The name of its deity has 



5 ] Glory of Sat Lok [113 

the quantity of half a short syllable, i.e., its deity 

is OM or Ormkar Purush. (10) 

On ascending to Sunn Shikhar, I heard the sound of 
Rarang. Kal and Maya both were subdued. (11) 

Here, I beheld the fully-shining white moon, and drank 
Ami (Amrit, nectar) from Mansarovar lake. (12) 

I developed friendship with Hansas, and heard the 
incessant sounds of the Kingri and the Sarangi 
(fiddle and violin). (13) 

I perceived hidden sounds in Maha-sunn. Maha Kal 
became helpless. (14) 

I enjoyed showers of Amrit (nectar) in Bhanwar- 
gupha, and heard sounds of Sohang and Bansri 
(flute). (15) 

My Surat ascended and addressed Sat Purush. I took 
my seat in Sach-Khand. (16) 

Sat Purush kindly equipped me with a -^wfa Durbeen 
(telescope) and enabled me to see the grandeur 
of Alakh Lok. (17) 

Agam Purush then rained Ami and revealed the 

secrets of Radhasoami. (18) 

This is the Bhakt Dham (the region and goal of 
devotees). I performed Arti of Radhasoami and 
pleased Him. (19) 

I was the recipient of an infinitely great boon. ! am 
rid of pain and suffering. I got absorbed in the 
bliss of Shabd more and more intensely. (20) 



114 ] Secrets of the Path [ Bachan 5 

Karams of innumerable births were eradicated. Kal's 
debt was nicely paid off. (21) 

I bowed my head at the Feet of Radhasoami. I enshrined 
the form of Radhasoami in my heart. (22) 

Giving up evil propensities, I brought my mind round. 
I held fast to Nam (Name, Word), and discarded 
Kam (passion and desires). (23) 

I have firmly imbibed Sil (piety) and Chhirma (patience 
and forgiveness). I made my mind soar high like 
a bird. (24) 

Guru, the Bhringi (large black-bee), has awakened 
this Keet (insect). I am now firmly attached to the 
Feet of Radhasoami. (25) 



BACHAN 6 



ARTI (HYMN OF PRAISE AND SALUTATION) 

AT THE HOLY FEET 

OF 

PARAM PURUSH PURAN DHANI 

RADHASOAMI 



I now sing Arti of Sat Guru. I recite Arti 
full-throated. (1) 

Arat Bani (a chain of Artis) is given 
below. Various kinds of Artis have been 
composed. (2) 

Satsangis should attentively listen to 
what Radhasoami says in these Shabds 
(hymns). (3) 



116 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Shabd 1 

% TTW "grr "TrffT 3TffT STTTl' I 

^m<mft ^ ^ ^ taft ii i ii 

Radha! Your status is most sublime. O Soami! 
Your Dharm (Abode) is Apar (infinite). Radhasoami 
has taken me in His lap. (1) 

1 catch hold of the feet of Radha. I take the Saran of 
Soami. 

I have become the darling of Radhasoami. (2) 

Radha takes pity on me internally. Soami redeems 
me openly. Radhasoami has brought about my 
reformation. (3) 

I utter Radha every moment. I fix my gaze at Soami. 
Radhasoami has graciously made me His own. (4) 

How should I proclaim the attributes of Radha? The 
glory and eminence of Soami are indescribably 
infinite. Radhasoami has now graciously embellished 
me. (5) 

The effect of Darshan of Radha is profoundly deep. 
I am enamoured of Soami on hearing His discourses. 
Radhasoami has now redeemed me. (6) 

By the support of Radha, my mind is subdued. By 
the strength of Soami, I ascend to higher regions. 
Radhasoami has showered immense kindness on 
me. (7) 

I perform Arti of Radha with all decorum. I perform 
Arti of Soami in a dignified manner. I have resolved 
to perform Arti of Radhasoami. (8) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 117 

I adore the feet of Radha. I wash the feet of Soami. 
The feet of Radhasoami are now my prop and 
support. (9) 

Radha casts Her glance of compassion on me. Soami 
showers unique grace upon me. Radhasoami has 
done me favour. (10) 

I put garland round Radha's neck. I apply Shital Tilak 
to Soami's forehead. I have today performed 
Radhasoami's Pooja (worship). (11) 

[Tilak means a mark or marks made with eye-earth, sandal 
wood or unguents, upon the forehead and between the 
eyebrows. Shital means cool. Sandal wood paste, when 
applied to skin, has a soothing effect, Tilak with sandal 
wood paste is called Shital Tilak.] 

I bring victuals before Radha and place the Thai 

(platter) before Soami. Radhasoami has graciously 
accepted my offering of Bhog (food). (12) 

Radha puts on smj ^faAmar Chir, Soami puts on 
sr^rc ^vx Ajar Vastra. The glory of Radhasoami 
is indescribable and incomprehensible. (13) 

[Dress for women is called "^tr "Chir" while that for gents 
is called ^Fsr'Vastra". Amar = undying. Ajar = undecaying.] 

Arti of Radha is in full swing. Soami is now very 
much pleased. I fall prostrate at the feet of 
Radhasoami. (14) 

Radha grants me Prashad of Daya. Soami does me 
special favour. I have sacrificed myself at 
Radhasoami. (15) 



118 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I first perform the Arti of Radha, and then of Soami. 

I have completed Arti of Radhasoami. (16) 

Radha graciously allows me admittance into Her Dharm 
(abode). Soami takes me under the protection of 
His feet. Radhasoami has redeemed me and 
accomplished my task fully. (17) 



Shabd 2 

TTsrrwift "Jft "ftrsT "ff^r i 

My Radhasoami is a profound ocean of serenity, which 
none can fathom. (1) 

It abounds in jewels and invaluable rubies of Shabd. (2) 

My Surat frolics there like a fish. The dark Kal has 

been subdued. (3) 

The current of love is gushing within me. Those who 
associate with me can partake of the bliss. (4) 

Turning the pupils of the eyes and withdrawing the 
spirit current from there, my Surat proceeds and 
sees the dazzling flame. (5) 

I open the gate of Sahas-dal-kanwal and penetrate 
inside. When I cross Banknal (the crooked tunnel), 
Avidya (ignorance, Maya) is paralysed. (6) 

I remove the Chakra (wheel, snare) of Maya and easily 
get Darshan of Brahm. (7) 



6 ] Radhasoami [119 

I hear the incessant resonance and awaken Shabd 

within. (8) 

I now sacrifice my body and mind on Guru. I shall 

never get tired of singing His praises. (9) 

How am I to recount the glory of Guru Pad (Trikuti)? 
I dedicate myself to Guru every day. (10) 

I keep Guru's form or image enshrined in my heart. 

I open the inner gate of the mind. (11) 

Guru takes me in His company and shows me the 

Rup of Sat Purush. (12) 

Guru shows me gardens of lotuses and lets me frolic 
in the company of Hansas. (13) 

I cannot describe the bliss I am experiencing. My 
Surat is drenched in the bliss of Darshan of Sat 
Purush. (14) 

Amrit is raining continuously and its currents are rising 
and flowing every moment. (15) 

The mind has drowned. Surat has awakened. Darkness 
of ignorance has been dispelled. (16) 

Some noble and loving devotees behold these spectacles 
and frolic in the company of the Beloved. (17) 

On hearing the voice of Guru, I laugh in ecstasy. I have 
secured abode in the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (18) 

Every moment my love is enhanced. The image of 

Guru looks wonderful. (19) 

I am so absorbed in bliss that I lose my consciousness 



120 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

of sight and breath and have become oblivious 

of my body and mind. (20) 

The countenance of Guru is very pleasing to me. I am 
enamoured of Him as a Chakor is of the moon. (21) 

Radhasoami has granted me a state of ecstasy. 

Becoming the dust of His Holy Feet, I have ascended 
high. (22) 



Shabd 3 

3TF* fe*m ^fe TPM Wft t 
If TTOTWnft WT 3TRff "3Rt II S II 

Sakhi (friend)! This day is very auspicious. I have 

resolved to perform the Arti of Radhasoami. (1) 

1 make a platter of my body and mind, and a lamp 

of Virah (yearning). I prepare a flower garland of 
Surat, Nirat and Dhun for the Arti ceremony. (2) 

I rise to Gagan (Trikuti) and Shikhar (Sunn), and 

behold wondrous scenes. In the company of Hansas, 
I see Maha-sunn. (3) 

I now cling fast to the Holy Feet of Radhasoami and 
sing His Arti. He is the beloved of my soul. (4) 

Every moment I behold the graceful form of Radhasoami. 
I offer my body and mind to Him. His Name dispels 
pain and suffering. (5) 

Again and again, I behold the beauty and charm of 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 121 

my Beloved. I sacrifice my body and mind at Him. 
He casts away all troubles and miseries. (6) 

How can I express the pangs of separation from the 
Beloved? None can understand the paroxysm I 
am afflicted with. (7) 

Burning in the fire of Virah (yearning), I apply the 

flame to the world and set it on fire. (8) 

Except Radhasoami who is there to support me? All 
the four Loks are of no avail to me. (9) 

I am the body and Thou, the breath. There is no 

hope of life without Thee. (10) 

Thou art the cloud, I am a peacock. On seeing Thee, 
I shout in delight. (11) 

I am a Bulbul, Thou art a garden of roses. I am a 
Qumri, Thou art a tall and graceful tree. (12) 

[Bulbul=(ln Persia and Arabia) the Nightingale; a certain 
melodious bird resembling the Nightingale; (in India) the 
fork-tailed shrike. Qumri — A turtle-dove, a ring-dove.] 

Thou art the moon and I am the night. Light and 

lustre I get from Thee. (13) 

When waves rise from the ocean of love, all Bharams 
(prejudices and adherence to meaningless tradi- 
tions) are washed away. (14) 

The habitation of Kam (passion) and Krodh (anger) 
is demolished. Worldly hopes and ambitions depart 
from my body. (15) 

Lobh and Moh (avarice and attachment) are all cast 



122 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

away. Desires for pleasures are eradicated from 

my heart. (16) 

Great Vivek (true discrimination) now reigns within 
me. All the tenants (parts) of the body have become 
happy. (17) 

I am a Dasi (servant, worshipper) of the Holy Feet of 
Sat Guru. He has fulfilled all my aspirations. (18) 

What should I say of His eminence and glory! I have 
now come to know Anhad Shabd. (19) 

My Surat ascends to Brahmand and leaves behind 

this hollow Pind (body). (20) 

I secure a seat in Gagan-Mandal (Trikuti), and proceed 
to the mansion of Sunn. (21) 

I come to know of the secrets of Dasam Dwar. I 

remove all thorns of Karams. (22) 

Getting rid of Karams, I journey on to Nij Ghar"pR ^R 
(original Home). I drive away Maya, the cheat. (23) 

I witness the wonders of Maha-sunn. How should I 

describe that ancient region? (24) 

Lion and serpent are on guard there like sentinels. 
No one can cross that region without the help of 
Sat Guru. (25) 

Further inside, there is dense darkness. It is only 

49 illumined by the presence of Shabd Guru. (26) 

Beyond Jhanjhri (latticed screen), I see a Jharokha 
(open door or arch), about which Sants have 
spoken. (27) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 123 

On the right is the way to 3fN"'<i fn Achint Dweep, 

on the left isTT^t tN Sahaj Dweep. (28) 

Proceeding in between the two, my Surat ascends 
to Bhanwargupha, the presiding deity of which is 
Sohang Purush. (29) 

I meet Sohang Purush and then perceive the Dhun 

of Sat Nam. (30) 

I hear the Dhun of Alakh Purush. I speed on to Agam 
Purush. (31) 

I take my seat in Agam Lok. This is the real Treasure 
House. (32) 

There is one more stage; and that is the absolute 

and final Anarmi beyond all description. (33) 

My Arti (prayer) is now over. O Soami! Have mercy 
upon me. Thou art my prop and strength. (34) 



Shabd 4 

$IT W "f^T t*F^" f" ^j£Tf II <\ II 

I have today made preparations for Arti. Announcement 
has been made in the city of Prem (Love). (1) 

Pain and agony have vanished altogether. I have met 
my Radhasoami I was separated from. (2) 

My heart is the platter and my Surat, the wick. I light 
the flame of Shabd every day. (3) 



124] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I perform the Arti standing before the Lord. My love 

and enthusiasm increase every moment. (4) 

It is being proclaimed by the beat of drums in the 
domain of my body that the thieves have fled 
helter-skelter and their oppression has been 
diminished. (5) 

Serenity and forbearance have now assumed charge. 
Passion and anger have been vanquished. (6) 

The Lord has now shown great mercy. I also offer 

myself at His Feet. (7) 

I now place myself under the protection of Radhasoami. 
O Omniscient! Keep me with Thee for ever. (8) 

None else have I save Thee. I worship Thee all day 

and night. (9) 

None else do I know except Thee. I adore Thee at 

heart every moment. (10) 

I am a fish, Thou art like an ocean. I am filled with 

ecstasy in Thy company. (11) 

I am a Papiha (bird). Thou art like a cloud of Swanti 
rain. I am a recipient of happiness. Troubles and 
miseries have vanished. (12) 

Thou art the moon. I am an humble water lily absorbed 
in Thy remembrance all day and night. (13) 

I am on the earth; Thou shinest in the heavens above. 
How can I meet Thee? (14) 

I wish I may ascend and rush to Thee, with my Surat 
and Nirat. I shall so attach myself to Thee that I 
may never be separated. (15) 



6] Radhasoami [125 

I am faithful and devoted to the Holy Feet of my 
Guru Radhasoami. O my Lord! Do save me now 
from the treacherous Kal. (16) 

Because of my confidence in Thee, I have become free 
from care. I have no doubts or misgivings in my mind 
now. (17) 

Soami! Thou hast infused courage in me. I have 

knocked down Mana 1 and Maya 2 and have won 

the battle. (18) 

The store house of hypocrisy has been reduced to 
ashes. The forces of Moh 3 which encamped within 
me for long, have now run away. (19) 

! now ascend to the fortress of Trikuti and gain sway 
over Sunn Shikhar. (20) 

The vast expanse of Mahasunn falls on my way. By 
the grace of Sat Guru, I cross it. (21) 

1 majestically enter the palace of Bhanwargupha. 

Ascending to Sat Lok, I announce loudly my arrival 
there. (22) 

In Alakh Lok, my Surat is befittingly adorned. In a 

moment I run to Agam Lok. (23) 

How shall I describe the grandeur of the throne of 
flowers, whereon Radhasoami has placed His holy 
Feet! (24) 

Mind. 2. Unreality, illusion. Matter. The personified will of Brahm 
or Kal in Brahmand and Pind. Personification of riches. 
3. Darkness or delusion preventing the discernment of truth, 
leading men to believe in the reality of worldly objects and to 
addict themselves to sensual enjoyments. 



126 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I move forward and stick fast to His holy feet. How 

should I describe the indescribable? (25) 

I have now completed the Arti. I have said about the 
secrets of the Inaccessible. (26) 

By placing the dust of the Holy Feet of Radhasoami 
on my head, I have repaired to my Nij Ghar (Original 
Abode). (27) 



Shabd 5 

"^ 3TtTtT ^rcfr T^ft, fa trfsi ^ sttt i 

9TTT ~&ffi fa *^, ^ <R "31? ^ TJTT II *» II 

This Arti has been composed by Surat-dasi who is a 
current from the ocean of Prem (Love). The current 
now overflows and it is endless and limitless. (1) 

Standing before Thee, I pray aloud, Why am I deprived 
of attendance at Thy court, O Lord! (2) 

None else is generous like Thee. Thou hast redeemed 
all. But, the turn for redemption of this sinner 
has not yet come. (3) 

/ yearn for Thy Darshan the way a Chakor yearns for the 
moon and an oyster yearns for a drop of Swanti rain 
and a peacock for clouds and thunder. (4) 

Thou art the lamp and I am a moth. Over Thee I 

have burnt myself to ashes. (5) 

Thou art the Bhringi and I am an insect captivated by 
Thee. I have met Radhasoami, the All-wise. (6) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 127 

Thou art the sandal-wood tree and I am a snake 
coiled round it. In association with Thy feet, I have 
attained peace and serenity. (7) 

Thou art the ocean of which I am a wave. From Thee 
I rise and in Thee I merge. (8) 

Thou art the Sun and I am Thy ray. From Thee I 

emanate and in Thee I recede. (9) 

Thou art the pearl and I am the thread. Never do I 

forsake Thy company. (10) 

Radhasoami! Now shower mercy. Thou art all-knowing, 

and present in every heart. (11) 

Thou art the moon and I am its phases. My wax and 
wane depend on Thee. (12) 

1 am a child and Thou art my parent. Day and night 

I play in Thy lap. (13) 

My eyes are the platter for performing the ceremony of 
Arti, my sight is its lamp and my eye-lashes stand 
like the sticks in Arti, i.e., I look intently at Thy 
countenance without letting my eyelids close. (14) 

In the lamp thus formed, I now pour the ghee of tears 
of love, and perform Thy Arti. (15) 

The sounds of the bell and the conch and the wonderful 
melodies of the Bin (harp) and the Bansri (flute) 
are heard. (16) 

The sounds of the Tal (cymbal), the Mridang (double 
drum) and the Kingri (fiddle) become audible and 
those of the Dhol (drum) and the Pakhawaj (tabour) 
resound every moment. (17) 



128 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Rains of ambrosia fall in thousand of torrents. The Gagan 
Mandal 1 revolves like a spinning wheel. (18) 

Again and again I dedicate myself to Thee. The splendour 
of Arti is now very great. (19) 

The grandeur of the scene is beyond description. 

Satsangis sing Arti (Shabd or hymn) in chorus. (20) 

Diamonds and rubies are being flung all round as 
token of devotion. Strings of gems and pearls 
abound. (21) 

Fruits and flowers (of spiritual sounds) abound there 
where Radhasoami has His throne. (22) 

I behold Radhasoami all the time. My body and mind 
feel highly elated. (23) 

Now is my Arti completed. Bless me with the Prashad 
of ambrosia. (24) 

Unfurleth itself now the banner of Love high up in the 
Gagan. Cometh now the resonance of the sound 
from the Inaccessible Region. (25) 



Shabd 6 

SHT^ 1TM 3TT3T TfFH TTO 3JTTTT ^nf I 

TT&IIWIMl IK t ^JT?T ^IcT ^t ^T <t&$ II S II 

Today it is all happiness. All have come to perform the 

1. Gagan Mandal literally means the celestial sphere. Gagan — The 
sky, heavens, the expanse above. Mandal — A circle, sphere. 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 129 

ceremony of Arti. Radhasoami has showered His grace 
and mercy. Fear of Kal has been removed. (1) 

Sukhman is made the Thai (platter) for Arti and the 
door to Banknal is opened. The moon is made 
the bowl and the Sun, the flame. (2) 

Surat and Nirat present the Bhog of Ami (Amrit, ambrosia). 
A white canopy is spread, and the melodious 
Shabd of Sunn is heard. (3) 

Karams are totally effaced. Songs of congratulation 
are sung in Sunn. Soami is graciously pleased to 
show His wonderful form. (4) 

The inaccessible sound of Sat Nam has penetrated 
into my heart. The praises of Sat Purush are being 
sung in each and every pore of my body. (5) 

Renouncing family and breaking off from the world, I 
have attained Param Pad (Highest Abode). Day 
and night I sing RADHASOAMI RADHASOAMI. (6) 

My mind is now absorbed in the bliss of love. I cannot 
express myself. Satsangis sing the Arti in chorus, 
unmindful of their body and mind. (7) 

Soami has shown compassion, and awakened Surat. 
Sat Guru has given out secrets of the inaccessible 
Shabd. (8) 

I sing Arti with redoubled enthusiasm. The Dhun 1 of five 
Shabds has become distinctly audible to me. (9) 



1. Sound. Sub-tone of Shabd or Nam. 



130 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Shabd 7 

"37^ 3TTTrft TraiWTl, 7R TR TgtcT ^M I 
SlIcT ^TT W 715^ ^»T 3&P3 ^T Ub&iW II S II 

I perform Arti of Radhasoami whole-heartedly with my 
body, mind and Surat. True Shabd forms the platter 
wherein unfurls the dazzling flame like a flag. (1) 

All the Hansas are participating in the ceremony. They 
are having Darshan face to face. Radhasoami 
has graciously shown the inaccessible and 
unapproachable. (2) 

The sounds of the bell, the conch and the drum are 

constantly reverberating. The sphere of Omkar Purush 
is echoing with loud thunder of clouds. (3) 

The region of Sunn is echoing with the sounds of 
the wonderful Kingri and Sarangi (fiddle and violin). 
Each hair of Sat Purush has the resplendence of 
crores of suns. (4) 

There are gardens of lotuses with soft humming sound 
of Bhonras all round. I am having Darshan of the 
Purush, sitting majestically on a white throne and 
casting His benign look all round. (5) 

The court of the Purush is resounding with the music 
of the Bin (harp) and the Bansri (flute), hearing 
which, Hansas feel exhilarated. They drink the choicest 
Ami-ras (nectar). (6) 

The glory of the hall of festivity of Sat Purush is wonderful 
and unsurpassed. Hansas are enjoying its pristine 
elegance and beauty. (7) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 131 

The Arti is now complete and I am at rest. I make 
obeisance at the Holy Feet of Radhasoami 
myriads of times. (8) 



Shabd 8 

T£(7T "^EfT 3TT3T ^T?T OTTrfr I 
w ips 1R 3W% tnTffrll 1 It 

The Surat 1 Sakhi 2 today performs Arti. She has enshrined 
the Shabd-Guru within her. (1) 

When I lighted the lamp of Nirat 3 , Maya wept and 

Kal pined away in grief. (2) 

The moment I took the platter of Birat 4 and Bibek 5 
in my hands, t^Mad and *TtFMoh (ego and attach- 
ment) bent down their heads in surrender. (3) 

True humility and submissiveness have become part 
of my nature. Hypocrisy and duplicity have been 
cast away. (4) 

With the lamp of love and devotion, I came before 

Soami to perform His Arti. (5) 



1. Spirit. 2. A woman's friend or companion, a female friend or 

confidante. 3. See "Surat, Birat and Nirat" in Article 6, in the book 
"Teachings of Radhasoami Faith based on Babuji Maharaj's 
Discourses". Nirat=Discriminating power of Surat (spirit) which 
awakens the desire to leave the bliss and joy of any centre andi 
yearns for that of the higher centre. 4. Birat=The faculty ct 
discrimination. 5. True knowledge, discretion. 



132 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I moved the platter of Arti and brought my mind under 
control. Calling aloud Radhasoami Radhasoami....l 
proceeded towards the region from where the 
sound of thunder comes. (6) 

As the sound of a great magnitude arose in me, my heart 
was filled with intense fervour and yearning. (7) 

With anguish and grief, my heart was rent, breaking 
into pieces, and then only was I blessed with the 
Darshan of Radhasoami. (8) 

With such great hardship I got the Darshan of my Beloved. 
All Karams and Bharams were annihilated. (9) 

The stream of love and devotion flowed, and the bundle 
of Kam (passion) and Krodh (anger) was snatched 
away. (10) 

The pitcher of pride and ego was broken, and I was 

rid of all mundane desires. (11) 

The five Tattwas, twentyfive Prakritis and three Gunas 
were knocked down. (12) 

Thus relieved, my Surat advanced to Gagan Mandal 
(Trikuti), and laid siege to Kal Mandal (the territory 
of Kal). (13) 

Having conquered the fortress of Sunn, I resolved to 
attain the inaccessible region. (14) 

I am iron and Radhasoami is Paras. By a mere touch 
of His, I became fit to get entrance into Nij Dharm 
(Original Abode) (15) 

[Paras (touch -stone) converts iron into gold] 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 133 

I am a snake and Thou art a gem (fixed on my head). In Thy 
lustre and refulgence lies all my happiness. (16) 

I am a lotus and Thou art the refulgent sun. When I 

see Thee, I am filled with joy. (17) 

I am a lake and Thou art a wonderful lotus. Because 
of Thee, I look beautiful and elegant. (18) 

I am a Hans and Thou art a lake, I pick up pearls 

and enjoy Thy profundity. (19) 

I am thirsty and Thou art a stream of Amrit (nectar) 
to slake my thirst. I am pinched with hunger and 
Thou art a great store-house of food. (20) 

I have sung such a wonderful Arti that tears of love 

and yearning gushed forth like a river. (21) 

I have burnt all dirt and impurities. I have swept clean 
the chamber of my heart. (22) 

There is no greater sufferer of the pangs of separation 
from the Beloved. I have discarded all thoughts 
about my position and status. (23) 

I have set fire to my dwelling, and taken an inflamed 
stick in my hand to reduce to ashes all that comes 
my way. I have abandoned all the three worlds in 
a moment. (24) 

I have heard the Shabd of Sat Lok. I have now 

pulverized Kal. (25) 

I have found abode in the Holy Feet of Sat Guru. I 

now enjoy perpetual bliss. (26) 



134 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I cannot describe that pure spiritual joy just as a 
dumb person is unable to describe the taste of 
sweets. (27) 



Shabd 9 

¥R *TT tftr arrnfr Tref i 

With every-surging waves of love, I sing Arti. My heart 
is filled with renewed zeal and enthusiasm. (1) 

In the ocean of Bhakti (devotion) has arisen a mighty 
wave which has yielded pearls of Prit (love). (2) 

My Surat, exhilarated and delighted like a fully-bloomed 
Jasmine, has taken the jubilant Nirat in its company 
in the ceremony of Arti. (3) 

I put a garland round the neck of the Shabd Guru and heard 
the-wonderful sound in Gagan Mandal. (4) 

I wore costumes of five colours; viz., yellow, white, 

red, green and black. (5) 

I saw gardens of five coloured flowers and was extremely 
elated. (6) 

My heart was illumined by the light of Jyoti (flame) 
First I saw T^TTR Shyarm (black) and then took to 
itn Sait (white). (7) 

On hearing Anhad Shabd (incessant sound) in Gagan 
(first heavenly sphere), my surat was delighted. (8) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 135 

By sorting out the sounds of the bell and the conch 
on the right side, I opened the passage to Banknal 
and penetrated into it. (9) 

I performed the first Arti in Trikuti where Guru Swamp 
(form of Guru) is visible. (10) 

The second Arti was of Sat Guru which my wise and 
intelligent Surat performed on reaching Sat 
Lok. (11) 

Thirdly, I performed the special Arti of Radhasoami, 
on beholding His Form in Radhasoami Dham. (12) 

How should I sing His praises! I ever remain devoted 
to His Holy Feet. (13) 

Unique is the glory of Radhasoami Dham which I 

have seen. It beggars all description. (14) 

Radhasoami is the Supreme Being. How should I 

describe His unique grandeur! (15) 



Shabd 10 

^T/tT 3TFJT cT# elTH *p* ^^ l 

?^m ^F3T $3 wr 4%m ii <\ u 

Today my Surat eagerly attaches itself to the Holy 
Feet of Guru. Quitting Shyam (dark place), I take 
location in the Sait-gram (the white village, Sahas- 
dal-kanwal). (1) 

I enter Banknal (crooked tunnel), and then ascend to 
Trikuti. (2) 



136 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

A wonderful lotus has blossomed within me. I put up 
a flag of victory in the Sait-Pad (white region, 
i.e., Sunn). (3) 

Hansas are playing on musical instruments. Guru has 
enabled me to witness such spectacles. (4) 

Ever new musical notes are being heard and the secrets 
of Akshar Purush are unfolded. (5) 

I get to Maha-Sunn; and in Bhanwargupha, I hear a 

melodious sound. (6) 

When I see Sait-Padam (True Lotus, Sat Lok), all 
doubts and misgivings are annihilated. My Surat 
applies itself to the sound of the Bin (harp). (7) 

I behold Alakh and Agam, and beyond them, I find 

Radhasoami Dham. (8) 

There, I perform such a grand Arti and Radhasoami 

is pleased with me. (9) 

How should I describe the glory of the spectacles I 
witness there? It is beyond description. My Surat 
is smiling all the time. (10) 

I disclose in confidence the activities of grace and 
mercy of Radhasoami. He is pleased to embrace 
me. (11) 

I have completed this Arti. What can I sing in praise 
of Radhasoami? (12) 

I have been admitted to the Param Pad (August Abode). 
Kal has been driven off. The Vedas are also put 
to utter disgrace. (13) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 137 

To none were these secrets revealed. Radhasoami 

has graciously given them out now. (14) 

I now sing His Arti. Radhasoami has awakened my 

Surat. (15) 

Yoga 1 and Gyan 2 have withered and faded away. Some 
rare Sants have revealed the secrets. (16) 

Radhasoami has shown a unique spectacle. I have 
merged in the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (17) 



Shabd 11 

"5TTT "^ t?T^ SJTT T£T II t«S II 
^ ^ SIR ^fe^T 3Tft *TTft I 
ITT 3T3 3c^ Wt II 9 II 

I have implanted the Holy Feet of Guru in my heart. 
The stubborn current flowing downwards in the body 
has now been reversed. (1) 

Who but Guru can take care of the mind? Surat has 

now merged fervently in Shabd. (2) 

For innumerable lives, I wandered in delusions. Nobody 
came to my rescue and held me by the arm. (3) 

This time, Sat Guru, in His unbounded grace and 

mercy, has met me and initiated me into the secrets 
of Shabd. (4) 



1. The system of philosophy established by Patanjali. 
2. Vedant Shastra. 



138] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I leave nine orifices and attach myself to the tenth 
door. I churn the Shabd of Sunn, and obtain 
butter. (5) 

With the help of the Guru, my boat is now fast moving 
to the other end. Verily, I have been a recipient 
of an unimaginably great blessing. (6) 

What should I say! I do not possess the requisite 
fitness to describe it. Suffice it to say that my 
Surat has become one with Shabd. (7) 

To experience or realize the bliss of higher regions, 
is a separate matter. None except Sants can 
describe it. (8) 

I ascend to Sunn Shikhar, see Maha-Sunn, and encamp 
in Bhanwargupha. (9) 

I visit Sat Lok, and get admittance into Alakh and 

Agam Loks. (10) 

I proceed onwards with Surat and Nirat and merge 

in the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (11) 

Here I prepare a grand Arti, the requisites for which 

are intense love and yearning. (12) 

Kal and his emissaries have been driven away. I have 
taken Saran of Dayal (Merciful). (13) 

The Merciful Lord looks elegant and majestic; He has 
put on the dress of five colours. In other words, 
He has graciously incarnated in human body made 
of five Tattwas (elements). (14) 

For the sake of Jivas, He has come here from His 
fr^r *t^t Nij Bhawan (original abode). By His 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 139 

grace, milk is coagulated into curd, the curd is 
churned, and butter comes out, which only rare 
Gurumukhs or devotees taste and enjoy. (15-16) 

[The three lower centres of Pind contain poison or brackish 
water, and the three upper centres, water. While the first 
heavenly sphere of Brahmand contains milk, the second, 
curd, and the third, viz., Sunn, contains butter. By churning 
poison or water nothing will be gained. Practices pertaining 
to centres of Pind will confer no spiritual benefit. Radhasoami 
Dayal has graciously promulgated special spiritual practices 
pertaining to higher regions of Brahmand and Dayal Desh. 
So, the changing of the direction of the stubborn current 
flowing in the world actually consists in withdrawing the 
diffused spirituality, concentrating it at the top of Pind, 
and elevating it towards Brahmand and Dayal Desh. The 
spiritual practices of Radhasoami Faith commence from 
the top of Pind, the third Til.] 

Radhasoami calls out to Jivas to perform spiritual 
practices of ascending to the Nij Dham (Original 
Abode). (17) 



Shabd 12 

3to% *3rmt ^ ^ ^Trf sum 1 
•^ -$jF*[ ^ 3tw mm 11 <1 11 

I perform Arti of my Soami and open the way to 

salvation for my kith and kin. (1) 

I thump the head of Kal and Karam. I tear to pieces 
the mantle of worldly attachment and affection in 
a moment. (2) 

Merrily and cheerfully I enshrine Soami in my heart. I 
annihilate all maladies and evils in a moment. (3) 



140] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I prepare the platter of love and fervour and light the 
lamp of Darshan and piety. (4) 

I offer Bhog (food) of reverence and devotion. I sing 
a song of Dhyan and meditation. (5) 

I gaze at the countenance of the Lord with my eyes 

without letting the eyelids meet. (6) 

I am enamoured of the image of Soami. I am an 

attendant at the door of Soami. (7) 

I keep my attention fixed on the Holy Feet and thus, 

do I get the position of an attendant. (8) 

I quit Shyam (third Til) and Kanj (Sahas-dal-kanwal), 
and take my Surat to Sait Padam (Sat Lok). (9) 

I elevate my Surat to heavenly spheres above and 
merrily see the scenes of pristine purity. (10) 

I behold the Holy Feet of Radhasoami, and sacrifice 
my body and mind before Him. (11) 

My Arti is complete. I have got admittance into the 

court of Sat Guru. (12) 



Shabd 13 

isR-I^T TMWIift 'iiimwiM) Tzrft II *\ II 

Darso (de-sirous of Darshan of the Lord) sings his 
Arti. Every moment he is uttering Radhasoami 
Radhasoami. (1) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 141 

He made the platter of learning (knowledge) and 
kindled the flame of Abhyas (devotional practice). 
On acquiring discernment, he adopted the Saran 
of Radhasoami. (2) 

He made earnestness his pen, and love his inkpot. 
He inscribes Radhasoami again and again, and 
chants IT within his heart. (3) 

He learnt Parsi (Persian) and Angrezi (English). By the 
grace of Radhasoami his intellect grew keen. (4) 

He realized that the whole world is an illusory fabric 
and that Radhasoami Nam is the only Truth. (5) 

His spirit got elevated, and the doorway to infinite 
Shabd opened. Perverse thinking was overcome 
and the mind was subdued. (6) 

Love-laden clouds gathered all around, and the 

reverberations of Anhad Shabd began to pour down 
like rain. (7) 

The sun and the moon became invisible, and the 

Sukhmana river gushed forth. (8) 

The door opened and the inner sky became visible 
within; and the heart felt elated at seeing Sunn, 
the top of Brahmand. (9) 

Childhood passed in sports, but the true game has 

been shown to him now only. (10) 

The Lord has now showered His immense grace, and 
the Arti of Darso is now over. (11) 



142 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Shabd 14 

TTS|l4*ll4l ^ ^f II <t II 

I hymn a song of Arti. Radhasoami has become gracious 
upon me. (1) 

Peace and tranquillity are the platter for Arti, and 

Sat Mat (true understanding) the flame of the lamp. 
Pearls of Wtfn Sarmta (equanimity) and Tffa Shil 
(good disposition) are placed in the platter for 
offering. (2) 

I make a garland by threading jewels and place it 

round the neck of.Soami. (3) 

I bring the platter full of diamonds and rubies. I offer 
jewels, gems and emeralds as Bhent. (4) 

I put on costly costumes and jewellery. I apply fragrant 
paste of sandal and other ingredients to my 
body. (5) 

Thus decorated, I come to Soami the way a black- 
bee comes to a lotus. (6) 

I stand before Him with the platter of Arti in my hands. (7) 

I am extremely delighted on performing the Arti I sing 
many Rags 1 and Ragnis 2 or musical modes. (8) 

Musical instruments are being played in the heavens. 
My enthusiasm gets fresh impetus. (9) 

1. Rag — A musical mode. There are six Rags. 2. Ragni — A 
modification of Rag. There are thirty six Ragnis, five or six 
being assigned to each Rag and personified as his wives. 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 143 

I come across the sources of fire, air and water elements. 
Leaving them below, I advance onwards. (10) 

On crossing the sources of the elements, I see suns 
and moons. I leave them also and enter into 
Sukhmana, the middle channel or current. (11) 

I am exhilarated on seeing Jyoti (flame). I see the 

invisible Niranjan. (12) 

My Surat hears the sound of the bell and is drawn to 
that of the conch. (13) 

Passing these, I remove the barrier of Banknal (crooked 
tunnel), go to Trikuti, and perceive the Dhun of 
0m. (14) 

The spiritualized sky of Trikuti calls out in a thunderous 
tone, "O Surat! Welcome, welcome! I sacrifice myself 
before thee, I dedicate myself to thee." (15) 

Witnessing these scenes, I proceed further, and reach the 
lake at Sunn, abounding in lotus flowers. (16) 

I am extremely happy to be in the company of Hansas. 
I now get to Maha-sunn. (17) 

I go to Sohang Purush in Bhanwargupha, hear flute 
and am much delighted. (18) 

From there, I ascend to Sat-Pur (Sat Lok), and meet the 
perfect Sat Guru. This region is 3i%rc Adhar, existing by 
itself, not resting on any prop or support. (19) 

& a = not 

*TT Dhar = ground 



144 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

3WT Adhar = not on ground, without prop 
or support. Pind and Brahmand are*R 
Dhar, whereas Sat Desh is 3T^r; Adhar. 

I hear various notes of the Bin (harp). Sat Purush 

equips me with a telescope. (20) 

I penetrate into Alakh Lok, and the next moment I 

am in Agam Lok. (21) 

I behold the region of Radhasoami. What should I 

say ! It is a unique abode. (22) 

I have said all I had to say. I have now completed 

the Arti. (23) 

Radhasoami has become gracious upon me. He has 
enriched me with His Prashad (blessing). (24) 

I now offer diamonds and rubies (Shabds of spiritual 
regions) and consider body, mind and riches too 
trivial to be offered. (25) 



Shabd 15 

tft *r sfe *m& sm ^5t II S tl 

Today I perform Arti of Sat Guru and dedicate my 

body and mind to Him. (1) 

I give up attachments of all, and cultivate love and 
affection for the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (2) 

I perform Sumiran of the Holy Name regularly. I apply 
myself to Anhad Shabd with love and yearning. (3) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 145 

Hearing Dhun (Shabd, sound), I go on advancing. I 
learn about the Shabd of Sahas-dal-kanwal. (4) 

Having perceived Shyam Sait (Third Til and Sahas-dal- 
kanwal), I proceed further and enter Banknal. (5) 

From there, I reach the region of Trikuti. I call aloud 
Ong Ong in unison with the Shabd or sound 
reverberating there. (6) 

The reverberation of Rarankar Shabd is audible at 
the shore of the Mansarovar lake. I see a large 
gathering of Hansas there. (7) 

The ^<f "T^Sait Pad (the region of Sunn) is very 
profound. Surat and Nirat go inside this region, 
and attain stability. (8) 

I am rid of pain and suffering of recurrent births and 
deaths. Here, milk is separated from water. (9) 

Having seen and sojourned in the region of Sunn or 
Daswan Dwar, which is the 3n?q "q^Atrma Pad (spirit 
pole), I prepare myself to cross Maha-Sunn. (10) 

Dense darkness prevails in the region of Maha-sunn. 
I cross this region with the help of Sat Guru. (11) 

In a moment, I reach Bhanwargupha and catch the 
Dhun (melodious sound) of the Bansri (flute). (12) 

I hear the loud sound of Sohang Sohang, and see 

Hansas of lustrous forms. (13) 

I proceed from there and come to thesmr T^Amar 
Pad, the immortal region. Satnam and the sound 
of the Bin (harp) become audible. (14) 



146 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I reach the entrance of Alakh and Agam, and enjoy 

the wonderful drink of Ami-ras (nectar). (15) 

I rush on, and merge in Radhasoami Dham. (16) 

My Surat performs the 3T*te anrcft Abhed Arti, the 
meaning and explanation of which can be given 
out by Sants only. (17) 

[sfTOt Arat consists of 3U a + T3 rat. 3tt a means to 
come and Til rat means to be absorbed. Abhed means 
unified, indistinguishable. On reaching and merging in the 
Highest Region, the Surat becomes indistinguishably unified 
with the Supreme Father Radhasoami Dayal. Abhed Arati 
signifies total identification of the worshipper with the 
worshipped.] 

There is neither Thai (platter) nor lamp nor wick. I 
sing the songs of Arti with great devotion. (18) 

I worship and serve the Holy Feet, drink Charnamrit 
(the nectar of the Feet), and eat Prashad with 
great elation. (19) 

All the time, I behold the Rup (Form) of Radhasoami. 
I enshrine Radhasoami in my heart. (20) 

My Surat has been awakened in the company of 
Shabd. It is my great good fortune that I have 
met Radhasoami. (21) 



Shabd 16 
TTsnwrtft ^tt tf*r ire srrar \ 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 147 

By the Daya. (grace) of Radhasoami, a spark of love has 
been kindled in my heart. All worldly ties and bondages 
have been cut and delusions removed. (1) 

I have seen Jyoti and perceived soothing Shabd. My 
Surat has merged in Gagan Mandal (Trikuti). (2) 

Saturated with love and yearning, I have become 
oblivious of myself. I have surrendered my body, 
mind and riches and all. (3) 

The question of my honour and protection now rests 
with Thee. I only cherish that my head may always 
rest at Thy holy feet. (4> 

I perform Sumiran of the Holy Name day and night. 
I have got the golden opportunity of uniting myself 
with Shabd. (5) 

I wish I may always be gazing at the loving face or 
countenance of my dear Guru. I dash down Kal 
and Maya. (6) 

May I be singing the hymn of Arti with love! May I 
abide near my Guru, without letting any distance 
occur in between. (7) 

The stream of love and yearning is swelling within 
me. Surat and Nirat are ascending higher and 
higher every day. (8) 

Errors, delusions and deceptions, all have fled away. 
Love for the Holy Feet of Radhasoami is 
enhanced. (9) 



148 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Shabd 17 

ffa tftfT "ETC" SfTT I 

STTTffr TTOIWUfi ^TT^ II 1 It 

Perform Arti of Radhasoami with love and affection. (1) 

The mind enamoured of Maya, is seated within the 
body. You should apply your Surat to the Holy 
Feet (2) 

Hold the platter of WlUmang (fervour) and kindle the 
flame off^s? Virah (yearning) in your heart. (3) 

When Sat Guru becomes Dayal (merciful) and showers 
Daya (grace and mercy). He will grant you the 
gift of Shabd. (4) 

By catching hold of Shabd, ascend to the sky, i.e., 
to Sahas-dal-kanwal and Trikuti. Then go to Sunn 
and drink Amrit (nectar). (5) 

Stay at Mansarovar and enjoy playful activities with 

Hansas there. (6) 

Enter into the Kanwal (lotus) and get to the Sait Pad 

(Sunn). (7) 

Cross the region of Maha-sunn by the grace and mercy 
of Sat Guru. (8) 

In Bhanwargupha, hear the wonderful Bansri (flute). (9) 

Apply your Surat to the Dhun (sound) of Satnarm and 
Bin (harp). (10) 

Behold the Darbar (court) of Alakh Purush and Agam 
Purush. and be filled with Prem (love). (11) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 149 

Your Surat will become a Suhagin and Kal (Satan) 

be rendered powerless. (12) 

[Suhagin is that married woman whose husband is alive, 
and who is beloved of her husband. For innumerable births, 
the Surat has been in Brahmand and Pind, under the 
sway of Kal, who is acting as her lord. Kal having been 
vanquished, the Surat reached her original home in Radhasoami 
Dham and became a Suhagin.] 

The deception of Kal will be wiped out. Your Surat 
will feel elated all the time in the company of 
Purush (Supreme Being). (13) 

It is by the kindness and favour of Sants alone that 

Surat can return to her original home. (14) 

Do attend Satsang and be a .recipient of the drops 

of ambrosia. (15) 

Enshrine the Holy Name RADHASOAMI in your heart. (16) 

Complete the Arti and be drenched in bliss. (17) 



Shabd 18 

frFH «fhTT fareT *fl"^ I 
*=J« "ft 3rra=T 3tfi$ II <\ tl 

Collect your mind at the third Til, and take your seat 

in Sahas-dal-kanwal. (1) 

Turn your inner eyes skywards within, and behold the 
flower garden of Jyoti. (2) 

Anhad Shabd is audible. Let your inner self or your 

interior be filled with joy. (3) 



150 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Surat has ascended to Shikhar (Sahas-dal- 

kanwal) and is going through Banknal (the crooked 
tunnel). (4) 

When a Bhanwara (black-bee) gets to lotus, it rests 
there, so the mind on reaching the Kanwal or lotus 
of Trikuti, stops there fully contented. (5) 

The Dhun of Rarankar is heard, and the forces of 

Kal are vanquished. (6) 

By the grace of Sant Sat Guru all centres within have 
been opened. (7) 

This is the path of the t^R itaNij Piv (True Beloved). 
No body can find it except by good luck. (8) 

Be a recipient of higher powers, and play the game 

of Prem (love). (9) 

Behold the internal spectacles, and let the stream of 
Ami (nectar) flow. (10) 

For the sake of Nij Bhaktas (real and special devotees), 
this new religion has been promulgated. (11) 

The Vedas are ignorant of this secret. Jivas are 
wasting their time in the ceremonial acts and rites 
recommended by the Vedas. (1?) 

This is the Nij Marg (true and special path to salvation) of 
Sants, which can be found in Satsang only. (13) 

Perform the Arti of Sat Guru and win His pleasure. (14) 

By the Daya (grace and mercy) of Radhasoami, attain 
Pooran Pad (final and ultimate goal). (15) 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 151 

Shabd 19 

Today my heart is filled with great enthusiasm. I 
have placed myself under the protection of 
Radhasoami. (1) 

If I receive Thy infinite %^t Mehar (grace and mercy), 
I may perform Arti in various ways. (2) 

Radhasoami is pleased to cast a merciful glance on 
me, and bids me to hold the platter in my hands 
and perform the ceremony of Arti. (3) 

He directs me to behold lovingly the third Til with my 
Surat, and, opening this window, to go beyond. (4) 

Accordingly, I penetrate into Nabh (Sahas dal-kanwal) and 
see Jyoti (flame). I see stars and hear Shabd. (5) 

Passing through Banknal, I ascend to Trikuti, and hear 
the Dhun of Akshar Purush in Sunn. (6) 

I open the gate and reach Maha-sunn. I hear the 

great melody of Bhanwargupha. (7) 

I come to the st*tc srzift Amar Atari (immortal terrace) 
of Sat Lok, and touch the Feet of Alakh Purush 
and Agam Purush. (8) 

This is the special Arti of Radhasoami, which can 
be properly performed only by an exceptionally 
noble Surat. (9) 

The unique current of Prem (love) is flowing from 



152 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

there. Surat comes in contact with Shabd, and 
attains serenity. (10) 

Surat is dyed in the Holy Name and witnesses a 

wonderful bloom of spring. Surat rests in rapturous 
bliss after completing the task. (11) 

Without Sant Sat Guru, none can know the secrets. 
All labour hard in vain and remain on this side 
(i.e., in the region of Maya). (12) 

Radhasoami has favoured me with a great blessing. 
He has showered extraordinary^: Mehar (grace 
and mercy) on me. (13) 

$$$ 
Shabd 20 

^HT 3TT3T ^ OTTtf *TTT I 

Surat today sets out for performing the Arti of Guru. (1) 

She adorns herself with jewellery and ornaments of 

various kinds. (2) 

She has the ear-ring of the mind, the mantle or wrapper 
of attention and the nose-ring of yearning. (3) 

She has the^VrtfNaugri 1 of love, the ^"S^t Chutki 2 of 
alertness and the f^snBichhua 3 of reason. (4) 

1. Naugri = A bracelet consisting of nine precious stones 
set in gold. 2. Chutki = A ring worn by women on any 
of the toes (except the great toe). 3. Bichhua = A ring 
worn on the (little or great) toe. 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 153 

She has the finger ring of five Mudras 1 and the^TT 

Har (necklace) of the purity of heart. (5) 

She has the + uf>£d Karan-phool 2 of grace and mercy 
of Guru. Thus adorned, she enters the Darbar (court) 
of Guru. (6) 

She has the w^ Chhann 3 of discernment, the 
T^oft Pachheli 4 of knowledge and the Nau-nag 5 
of renunciation of the nine doors, i.e., the body 
or Pind of nine orifices. (7) 

She makes a^d^/t Pachlari 6 of the five Tattwas 
(elements), and sees a^l^eiSisphool 7 in Gagan 
(sky). ' (8) 

She wears the ^Ni Baina 8 and hears the ^ Bain 

(sound) of Anhad Shabd. She wears ^^F^nChandra- 
kala and opens the door to Chandra, i.e., the moon 
of the sixth Chakra. (9) 

(Chandra means moon or moon of the sixth chakra. Chandra 
or chandra-kala is the name of an ornament worn on the 
forehead.) 



1. Mudras = Postures of Hatha Yoga. 2. Karan phool = An 
ornament for the ear consisting of a hollow cone of gold 
which is fixed as a pendant to the ear ring. 3. Chhann 
= A bracelet worn with Churies, the Churies being on 
each side and the Chhann in the middle. 4. Pachheli = 
A kind of bracelet worn with Churies, the Churies are 
worn nearest to the hand). 5. Nau-nag = An ornament 
worn on the upper arm consisting of nine precious stones 
set in gold 6. Pachlari — A necklace of five strings. 

7. Sisphool — An ornament for the head (worn by women). 

8. Baina — An ornament worn by women on the forehead. 



154 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

She wears "^FfTJugni 1 and develops ^T/TJug (attach- 
ment) with Sat Guru. She goes through the srrwt 
Arsi (ring with mirror). (10) 

(Jug means a pair, a term used in the game of Chausar 
when two or more pieces come together on the same 
square.) 

She wears . srq^z . Anwat, 2 and the «fTZ Bat (way) is 
opened internally. She sees Jyoti (flame) in the 
temple. (11) 

She sees ^re Jhoomar 3 , TtTht Nagina 4 , and ^^T 
Jhumka 5 , and begins to move with stately 
steps. (12) 

She wears ^e^^ Gulu-band 6 of Sumrian and Wtf^ft 

Hansli 7 of Shil 8 . (13) 

Pulverizing ^Moh (attachment), she wears cftrr Tora 9 
round her neck. Wearing ^fcTTSatlar 10 , she follows 
Sat (Truth). (14) 

She wears ^f^Ghunghru 11 , ^n'?r Jhanjh 12 andTRsf 

1. Jugni — An ornament of the shape of a betel leaf, worn on the breast 
or the front part of the neck. 2. Anwat — A ring generally furnished 
with little bells, worn by women on the great toes. 3. Jhoomar — An 
ornament consisting of a number of chains forming a fringe which is 
attached to the top-knot of a woman's head and falls on the forehead. 
4. Nagina — A ring, especially, a signet-ring. 5. Jhumka — A bell 
shaped pendant of an ear-ring. 6. Gulu-band — A small rectangular 
plate of gold studded with gems worn on the front part of the neck. 

7. Hansli — A collar of a gold worn round the neck as an ornament. 

8. Shil — Virtue, piety. 9. Tora — A gold chain for the neck 
10. Satlar — A chain or necklace of seven strings or rows, 11. 
Ghunghru — A small bell, a string of small bells worn round the wrist 
or ankle. 12. Jhanjh — Cymbal, a hollow tinkling anklet. 



6] Radhasoami [ 155 

Pa-zeb 1 and hears the jingle, and also sees light 
and refulgence within. (15) 

She puts on'^rfc Bank 2 and enters Banknal. She has 
TfarT Tika 3 of trust and reliance. (16) 

She wears a WfcTtChhalla 4 and enters the third Til. 
She wears a^T Kara 5 and penetrates within, 
making a loud sound. (17) 

She wears a ^*-Hi«hd1 Champakali 6 and beholds unique 
buds and petals of lotus. (18) 

She wears a^NftChauki 7 and sees the Chauk 8 of Sunn, 
beyond the region of thunder and lightning. (19) 

She wears a"3^TChhabba 9 and puts her mind and senses 
under control (mind+5 senses = 6) and then wears a 
cT^n Latkan 10 of ^FLatak 11 (20) 

She wears a^^Besar 12 and her Surat gets to the 
bank of?R Sar (Mansarovar lake), and befriends 
with Hansas. (21) 

1. Pa-zeb — An ornament worn on the feet or ankles (consisting 
of a chain with small bells attached). 2. Bank — A semi- 
circular armlet. 3. Tika — An ornamental patch of gold or 
a jewel worn on the forehead. 4. Chhalla = A plain ring 
of gold worn on a finger or toe. 5. Kara — A massive ring 
of gold worn on the wrists 6. Champa — The tree bearing 
a fragrant yellow flower. Champa-kali — A necklace composed 
of small ornaments in the form of a bud of the Champa 
flower. 7. Chauki — A square pendant of a chain, worn on 
the breast. 8. Chauk — A quadrangle, a square, a courtyard. 
9. Chhabba — A pendant of six strings. 10. Latkan — Anything 
hanging, an ear-drop, a nose-ring; a pendant. 11. Latak — 
Absorption in love. 12. Besar — small heavy nose-ring. 



156 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

Passing through Maha-sunn, she ascends to Bhanwar- 
gupha and hears the Murli (flute). There she wears 
a Bhanwar-kali 1 . (22) 

Hearing Dhun (Shabd, sound), the^ Nar ^gKXSunar 
(noble and virtuous Surat) goes to Sat Lok and 
meets Purush. (23) 

[Nar or Nari means woman, female, wife; and Sunar means 
a clever woman, a good housewife.] 

Surat performs the Arti of Sat Purush, with a platter 

of Sat and Sohang in her hands. (24) 

She kindles a dazzling flame of myriads of suns and 

moons. (25) 

Radhasoami bestows Pooran Pad (ultimate and final 
region) and Pooran Prashad (perfect and complete 
blessing) on her. (26) 

Her joy knows no bounds. As a token of thanks-giving, 
she scatters diamonds and rubies at the Holy 
Feet. (27) 

& & & 

Shabd 21 

armr sim ft in n 

The darling devotee, who has reliance and trust on 
the Guru alone, resolves to perform Arti. (1) 

1. Bhanwar-kali — A turning movable ring. 



6 ] Radhasoami [ 157 

I lovingly looked up to Charan (Holy Feet) and adopted 
Saran (protection) of Guru. I adorned myself with 
Shabd. (2) 

I discarded worldly attachments and cried aloud in 
Virah (pangs of separation from the Beloved). I 
have adorned my Surat. (3) 

I drove away Kal and curbed my mind. I burnt away 

sensual pleasures. (4) 

I rose to Gagan (Trikuti) and obtained NAM (Name). 
I, then, went to Sunn. (5) 

I opened my inner eye, and beheld the infinite form 

and expanse. (6) 

I unlocked the shutters, and removed the barriers of 
the Shy am Dwara (the region of Kal). (7) 

I beheld the Deity of Sunn. I vanquished Karams in 

the white arena (Sunn). (8) 

I made the great current of Ami (ambrosia) my food 

and sustenance. (9) 

I strolled the vast courtyard, and enjoyed its singular 
scene. (10) 

I selected and imbibed the right sound, and got 

admittance to Guru's Darbar (court). (11) 

I held the dagger of Shabd in my hand. The mind 
was vanquished, and stepped out of the way. (12) 

I am the darling of Guru. I have been awakened by 
the Holy Name. I have become a great warrior in 
my battle with the mind. (13) 



158 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 

I arrived at a region where the sound of Omkar is 
audible, and the red sun is visible. I then heard 
the playing of thefa<*KiChikara (musical instrument 
like fiddle with four or five wires and horse-hair 
for string). (14) 

Thou art<0'H^Ki Din Dayara (merciful to the humble). 
By removing the noose of Kal and Maya, Thou 
hast done good to me. (15) 

I am fallen, degraded and worthless. I am burdened 
with sins and blemishes. (16) 

I feel proud of my body (i.e., I am so foolish as to 
consider my bodily form to be my true fo r m). I 
am lustful. I am a liar. I have been thrown into a 
desolate place. (17) 

Being engrossed in uncouth efteLobh 1 and bull-like ^ 
Moh 2 , I have lost my faculty of discernment. (18) 

However, I have now separated myself from all, and 
am Thine and Thine alone. I place my head at 
Thy Holy Feet. (19) 

Although I am steeped in desires for the pleasures of 
the body and am irregular in observing rules of 
conduct, yet, Thou hast kindly redeemed me. (20) 

I ascended to Sahas-dal-kanwal and Trikuti, and then 
opened Daswan Dwar (the tenth door). (21) 

Beyond Sunn, I came across the darkness of Maha- 
sunn, and then I saw light in Bhanwargupha. (22) 

1. Greed, avarice. 2. Darkness or delusion of mind preventing 
the discernment of truth leading men to believe in the reality 
of worldly objects, and to addict themselves to mundane or 
sensual enjoyment. 



6 ] Radhasoami l[ 159 

Beyond Bhanwargupha, I had Darshan of Sat Purush, 
and attained the fourth Pad or Lok. (23) 

I went to Alakh and Agam, and sacrificed my body 

and mind before them. (24) 

Both Surat and Nirat moved onward and arrived at Nij 
Dharm (the true and real abode) and found t^t ~m. 
Nij Sar (the Essence of all essences). (25) 

I perform Arti and enhance my love. Fie on the world! 
Fie on the whole world. (26) 

I have found Sat Guru Radhasoami. I surrender myself 
to Him. (27) 

What can I say? I cannot express myself. I am now 

with Radhasoami. (28) 



Shabd 22 

WJT Pm^* 3PTR 3TOPfr II <\ I! 

Radhasoami, who dwells in Sat Lok and Radhasoami 
Dharm and Anarmi Pad, is awakening the Jivas (1) 

Blessed are they in whose house Radhasoami has 

set His feet. (2) 

Who can describe the glory of this occasion? Brahma, 
Vishnu and Mahesh are vanquished. (3) 

Jivas accomplish their task and become happy by 

performing the Arti of Guru. (4) 

With Guru has come a host of Hansas (worthy and gifted 
souls). They are all welcomed and garlanded. (5) 



160 ] Arti at the Holy Feet of [ Bachan 6 

They are all pleased with the food and dresses they 
are offered. They appreciate the feeling and senti- 
ments of love and affection. (6) 

The true and perfect Sat Guru is pleased with the 
service and devotion of Jivas. He grants them 
admission to Sat Lok. (7) 

The disciple gets worldly prosperity, i.e., plenty of 
food and wealth and off-spring or progeny and 
the pleasures of the world along with spiritual 
progress, (8) 

Such, however, is the grace of Sat Guru that no attach- 
ment is felt for the world and the disciple does 
not get entangled in it. (9) 

His Surat remains pure in the company of Guru with 
his attention steadfastly fixed at the Holy Feet. 
A contact is established with Shabd. (10) 

Guru, out of His Daya bestows all these gifts. The 

disciple knows not what to pray for. (11) 

When Sat Guru showers His grace, He enables the 
devotee to perform devotional exercises even 
without his asking for it. (12) 

The unique gift of "^TFTNam andsRmAnam. has been 
bestowed by Sat Guru Himself in His love. (13) 

Nothing now remains to be given. Oh brother! Sat 

Guru Himself is now yours. (14) 

Radhasoami pronounces this benediction that True 

Name may ever help and protect you. (15) 



BACHAN 7 



BINTI AND PRARTHNA (PRAYER) 

AT THE HOLY FEET OF 

PARAM PURUSH PURAN DHANI 

RADHASOAMI 



Shabd 1 

^?=v ^farfr ^3 "^jT "^ftrt I 
3?4 ^j*ft TTSJIWltf) tftft II 1 II 

O Radhasoami! I beseech Thee with folded hands to 
hear my prayer. (1) 

Thou art Sat Purush and Sat Guru, the Munificent 
Lord. Thou art the parent of all the Jivas. (2) 

Be gracious enough to make me Thy own, and extricate 
me from the snares of Kal. (3) 

Sat Yuga, Treta Yuga and Dwapar Yuga have all passed. 
None knew about the path of Shabd. (4) 

In Kali Yuga, the Soami (Lord) has taken pity on 
Jivas, and has openly given out the secrets of 
Shabd. (5) 



162 ] Binti and Prarthna [ Bachan 

He has incarnated Himself here for effecting liberation 
of Jivas. He takes them across the ocean of worldly 
existence. (6) 

Releasing me from the thraldom bf the three worlds, 
He has granted me abode in the fourth Pad (beyond 
Pind, And and Brahmand). Now I realize the status 
of Sat Nam and Sat Guru. (7) 

The first stage is illumined by the Jyoti (flame). The 
second stage is Gagan. Beyond is the third stage 
of Daswan Dwar where is visible the moon (8) 

Beyond Trikuti, Sunn and Maha-sunn, is the throne 
with the umbrella of the Sovereign in the region 
of white resplendent light and incessant Anhad 
Shabd. It is to this Sovereign that I address my 
prayer. (9-10) 

May I be the recipient of happiness here and hereafter. 
O Lord ! Grant me abode in Thy Holy Feet. (11) 



Shabd 2 
ffa Tt*r t& <pr otwt i 

3FT 3TT T^T "^ "^IT I 
spa; $«3 % w& "Sjjn^ I 

*$ f^ET ^T ^fa ^TTT II S II 

O Radhasoami! Deliverer and Liberator of the fallen! 
Thou art my sole prop and support. Every hair 



7 ] Prayer [ 163 

and vein, every joint and part of my body calls 
Thee for help. I am the most insignificant slave. 
Thou art Din Dayal (Merciful to the lowly, Cherisher 
of the poor). (1) 

My mind and senses are full of evil propensities. The 
body is also tied to the world. I am wholly drifting 
in the current of the world. Thou alone art my 
Redeemer. O Radhasoami! The Reservoir of 
happiness! I am most fallen and degraded, badly 
engrossed in the world. (2) 

O Giver of all gifts! Extricate me from the entanglements of 
the world. Thy bounty is exceedingly great. Thou art the 
ocean of mercy. Thou art the succour and support to 
Jivas. Except Thou, there is none to take care of them. 
O Radhasoami! I adopt Thy Saran (protection). I am 
fallen, mean and worthless. (3) 

This is my prayer that I may ever enjoy the protection 
and support of Thy Holy Feet ; I may never be 
separated from Thee; I may always enshrine Thee 
in my heart ; Thy Holy Feet may be my prop 
and support. O Radhasoami! Thou art infinitely 
boundless. Be kind enough to show me Thy Nij 
Darbar. (4) 

If Thy graciousness were to take into account my 
actions, then I am not worthy of finding a place 
or location at Thy door. Thou art profoundly calm 
and serene, and far above this turbulent world; I, 
on the other hand, am being drowned in the ocean 
of this world. O Radhasoami ! Help me reach the 
shore. Thou art the perfect boatman. (5) 



164 ] Binti and Prarthna [ Bachan 

I am a thief, slanderer and egoist. I am treacherous, 
perverse and liar. I am engrossed in passion, lust, 
anger and attachment. How far should I go on 
recounting my faults and blemishes? I am full of 
evils. O Radhasoami! Pardon me and grant me 
liberation posthaste. (6) 

Thy glory and eminence is boundless. Shesh, Ganesh, 
Maya, Brahm and the incarnations, are all unable 
to describe it. They are drifting in the current of 
Kal. O Radhasoami! Thou art beyond all. Thou 
art the support of all these. (7) 

I sacrifice myself at Thy Holy Feet. I do not possess 
the requisite fitness to look at Thy refulgent form. 
Thou art an infinitely vast reservoir of refulgence 
before which suns and moons have no locus standi. 
O Radhasoami ! Who can adopt the support of 
Thy Darshan, without Thy grace and favour? (8) 

Thy Name RADHASOAMI constitutes my lineage as 
well as my family. I keep on uttering RADHASOAMI 
RADHASOAMI. This keeps me ever vigilant and 
watchful. O Radhasoami! I can grasp Thy teachings 
only by Thy kindness (9) 

Thou hast incarnated Thyself as Guru, and come to 
the world for the salvation of Jivas. By assuming 
human form. Thou hast conferred a great benefit 
on the humanity. Thou art my most munificent Sat 
Guru. O Radhasoami! Thou hast removed the barriers 
and opened the gateway to Shabd. (10) 

Unique are the acts of Thy grace. None can describe 
them. They are boundless and limitless. To whom 
Thou showeth, he alone sees. None can 



7 ] Prayer [ 165 

perceive and appreciate them without Thy help. 
O Radhasoami ! My Guru! Except Thou, who can 
emancipate me? (11) 



Shabd 3 

■gjr^r "gift 3^T W3\ pTFJT II ^ 11 

Today I pray to Radhasoami to accomplish my task 

and protect my honour. (1) 

I am Thy slave. I pay obeisance to Thy Holy Feet. 
May I secure admittance to Agam Lok and Anami 
Pad. (2) 

How long should I go on praying? O Soami! I am 
under Thy Saran (protection and care). I offer 
myself to Thee in entirety. (3) 

I know not even how to pray. I only adore Thy Holy 

Feet (4) 

I look to none else except Thee; nor dost Thou have 
a "3"^ Sewak (servant, disciple) worthless like 
me. (5) 

I am quarrelsome. Thou art Radhasoami. Omniscient 
and All-knowing that Thou art, Thou hast united 
me to Thy Holy Feet. (6) 



166 ] Binti and Prarthna [ Bachan 7 

Shabd 4 

*cmft TFTt ^tTTTT P=Hdi I 
$ ^T^r rj^Kl faHdl II 9 II 

Soami! I pray to Thee. Listen to my prayer. (1) 

Count not my faults and blemishes. I am wasting my 
human life and noble faculties I am endowed with. (2) 

lam worthless, harsh and gone astray. I am a destitute, 
always engrossed in worries and anxieties. (3) 

1 hear of Thy great eminence. Thou art giver of all 

things, Dayal (Merciful) and Nij Sant (Special or 
Rare Sant). (4) 

I am always entrapped and ensnared by perversity 

and folly. But Thou art most powerful and wise. (5) 

I am afflicted with the pangs of separation. I am worried 
how to get across the ocean of existence. (6) 

May Thy Graciousness make my Surat noble and 
sincere, so that I may be firm in the Saran of Thy 
Holy Feet. (7) 

May all Karam and Dharam (adherence to acts and 
duties prescribed by old scriptures) be split and cru- 
shed like pulse. Mould me into a noble devotee. (8) 

May I be detached from the desire for name and fame, for 
which I suffer sickness, sorrow and pain. (9) 



BACHAN 8 

EMINENCE OF RADHASOAMI 
AS SAT GURU 



Shabd 1 

*TC> 3TTT?T 3& WTf ^R<ft II <* II 

Guru and Guru alone do I keep in my heart. I make 
preparations for performing the Arti of Guru. (1) 

My Guru is a Perfect Being and Disposer of destiny. To 
His Holy Feet is my mind devoutly attached. (2) 

Inscrutable are the ways of my Guru. None but Guru 
do I recognise. (3) 

I do not recognise Brahma, Vishnu, Mahesh, Ishwar, 
Parmeshwar, Shesh, Ram, Krishna, ten incarnations 
of Brahm, Vyas, Vashishtha, Adi Kumari (Adya), 
Rishis, Munis, goddesses, gods, pilgrimages, fasts, 
rituals, Jogis, Jatis, Tapis, Brahmcharis, Janak, 
Sanak, Sanyasis. Atma, Parmatma, Akshar, and 
Nih-Akshar. (4-8) 



168 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

I know neither Satnam nor Satnam-Anami. All that 
which people describe in the books, matters little 
to me. (9) 

I salute all with folded hands. But none is equal in 

status to Sat Guru. (10) 

Through the grace of Sat Guru have I come to know all; but 
for Guru how could I have known them? (11) 

It is Sat Guru who imparted knowledge about each 
one of them and thus the exact position and status 
of each was known. How can then any of them 
be regarded as superior to Guru? (12-13) 

Guru revealed the sphere of each one of them and 
also their respective positions in the scale of 
creation. (14) 

That is why Sat Guru is the creator as well as the 

dispenser of all. (15) 

So the eminence of Sat Guru is very great and no 
one else can be considered equal to Him. (16) 

When a Jiva accepts the Saran of Guru, his adherence 
to traditional rites and rituals and to illusions and 
delusions is gone. (17) 

The path shown by Guru becomes true Karam and 

Dharam (religious code) for him. (18) 

Whatever a disciple does in obedience to Guru, will 
merit Bhakti (advancement in devotion). (19) 

You should, therefore, first search for Guru. You should 
find out the Guru who can tell you of "Shabd". (20) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 169 

There is none equal to such a Guru. What else remains 
to be done when one has come in contact with 
Him? (21) 

Hence, I am convinced that one should serve none 

but Guru. (22) 

Kal and Karam cannot overcome one who has firm 

faith in Guru. (23) 

Such a devotee has sway over all and he has none 

to fear. (24) 

Many a high and great soul is redeemed through asso- 
ciation with Gurumukh (the chief disciple of the 
Guru). Gurumukh is superior to all of them. (25) 

Exalted most is Gururnukh's role, 

Gurumukh redeems many many a soul. (26) 

How far may I sing the greatness of Gurumukh? None 
understands it. To whom should I explain? (27) 

Kal has spread his net wide in the world. Jivas are 
constantly moving in the cycle of Chaurasi 
(eightyfour). (28) 

If they wish to get out of the cycle of eightyfour, they 
should serve Gurumukh and follow His ways. (29) 

They should give up all other activities, and should 
engage in service and devotion to the Shabd- 
Guru. (30) 

People may reside in Kashi 1 for millions of lives and 

1. The modern city of Varanasi, a most important place of pilgrimage 
of Hindus. 



170 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

engage in study and recitation of the Vedas 1 , Jap 2 , 
Tap 3 , and checks and restrictions of various kinds. They 
may become ascetics and busy themselves in the pursuit 
of learning. They are blind followers of the bygone 
personages whom they never saw with their own eyes, 
and of whose greatness they have only read in the 
books. They are all in delusion. (31-34) 

If anybody now tries to give them correct advice, they 
feel mortified in giving up their adherence to old 
prejudices, beliefs and traditions. (35) 

People are engaged in the outward acts of worship of Shiva, 
Vishnu, Ram, Krishna, goddesses, Ganga or Yamuna. 
Some are idolators. Some go on pilgrimage to the four 
Dhams or places, viz., Badrinath 4 , Dwarka 5 , 
Jagannath 6 and Rameshwar 7 . Some visit Mathura 8 
and Gokul 9 , and are followers of Murari 10 , Madan 10 
Mohan 10 and Kunjbihari 10 . Some belong to the sect of 
Ballabhacharya 11 Some wear rosaries of beads of 
Tuisi (holy basil) round their necks. Some live according 
to established rules of conduct. Some pray at sunrise, 
noon or sunset. Some present libations to the gods, or 

1. The sacred scriptures of the Hindus. 2. Counting silently the 

beads of a rosary, etc.; muttering prayers. 3. Austerity, penance. 
4. A town and temple in the Himalayas. 5. Name of a sacred 
place of Hindus situated near the mouth of the gulf of Kachchh, 
on the western coast of India (it was the capital of Krishna 
and supposed to have been submerged in the sea). 6. Name 
of a celebrated idol, and of a temple near Cuttack, in Orissa. 
7. The ridge of rocks extending from the southern extremity 
of India towards the island of Sri Lanka. 8. Birth place and 
early residence of Krishna, a favourite resort of Hindu pilgrims 
9. The residence of Krishna during his youth. 10. Epithets of 
Krishna. 11. Name of a celebrated founder of a Vaishnava 
sect of Hindus. 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 171 

to the names of deceased ancestors. Some perform 
the ceremony of Gaya 1 to enable the dead to secure 
location in heaven. Some repeat Gayatri 2 Some 
surrender their all to priests. Some read and recite 
Gita 3 and Bhagwat 4 Some hear tales from the Purans 5 
regularly. (36-41) 

The followers of Dadu Saheb, Nanak Saheb, Kabir 
Saheb and Paltu Saheb are all slaves of tradi- 
tions. They do not make any search for the true 
Guru of the time. (42-43) 

None can attain Bhakti (love and devotion) without 
the help of the Guru of the time, and none can 
enter Sat Lok without Bhakti. (44) 

This precept is meant for those Jivas in whose heart a 
spark of love and yearning has been kindled. (45) 

People tied to the world and to its pleasures and 
temptations, need not give up their old beliefs and 
prejudices, as these beliefs constitute their support and 
mainstay. (46-47) 

My teachings are not meant for those people, for 

they are the victims of worldly desires. (48) 

Some are deeply involved in family affairs, Some 

are running after wealth, and name and fame. (49) 

Because of fear of worldly people, they do not give 
up adherence to rites and rituals. They do not 
cultivate love and faith in Sat Guru. (50) 

1. A celebrated place of pilgrimage, among Hinduism in Bihar. 
2. A sacred verse from Rig Veda. 3. Certain sacred writings. 
4. One of the eighteen Purans. 5. Certain well known sacred 
works of Hindu theology and mythology. 



172 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

Devotion to Guru has been preached for those who 

are lovers and are filled with yearning. (51) 

A devotee cannot attain his object until he meets the 
Guru of the time. (52) 

First step is the Bhakti of (or devotion to) Guru, second 
is that of Surat and Nam. (53) 

Until one's devotion to Guru is perfected, one's mind 
and desires cannot be brought under control. (54) 

And unless the mind is curbed, Surat cannot be purified. 
Without purification, how can Surat rise and apply 
itself to Shabd? (55) 

Such a Bhakti is attainable by attending Satsang and 
performing Sewa of Guru. (56) 

One should try every moment to secure the pleasure 
of Guru and work hard for it. (57) 

When the Guru is dear to the devotee and the devotee is 
dear to the Guru, the devotee will get*#3 t^tw Bhakti 
Padarath (gift of devotion) and Pooran Daya (grace 
and mercy in its fullest measure). (58-59) 

Even such an occasion will also come about by Guru's 
kindness. Without grace and mercy, it is like feeding 
with false hopes and expectations. (60) 

Whether a Hindu or a Muslim, a Christian or a Jain, 
without Guru Bhakti, none can attain peace. (61) 

First essential is devotion to Guru. Without Guru Bhakti 
nothing will be achieved. (62) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 173 

What all the religions lack is that they do not give priority 
to devotion to Guru, but resort to other ways and means. 
That is why they fail to attain the real object. Their 
followers are shallow-minded. (63-64) 

Apply yourself firmly to devotion to Guru. All other things 
come in its train. Without devotion to Guru, worldly 
attachments can never be severed. (65) 

Get the coarser bondages of the world severed by 
devotion to Guru and subtler ones by adherence 
to Nam. (66) 

How can the subtler ties be eliminated unless the 

coarser ones are broken ? Therefore, it is incumbent 

upon all to engage in devotion to Guru every 

day (67) 

Devote one life to devotion to Guru; attain Nam (i.e., 
Trikuti) in the second life: reach Mukti Pad (i.e., 
Sunn) in the third life; attain Nij Dham, the final 
abode, in the fourth life. (68) 

Now I carefully perform Arti of Guru. I made the platter 
of my body and the lamp of my mind. (69) 

I kindle the flame of devotion and offer Bhog. (food) 
of love and affection. I fix my eyes on Darshan 
and direct my attention to the Holy Feet. (70) 

In this manner, I perform Arti. May the perfect Sat 

Guru help me. (71) 



174 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

Shabd 2 

tptt tt% irfir ^raft ^ wsvft ii q n 

I have met the Guru who is the bestower of Param 
Pad (Highest Abode). How should I describe His 
ways and status? (1) 

Ignorant as I am, I know not His eminence. Without His 
grace and mercy, how can I recognise Him? (2) 

His reach and position are beyond the ken of the 

Vedas. His secrets and mysteries cannot be known 
by Gyan (philosophical studies) and Yoga (old yogic 
practices). (3) 

His abode is far away beyond their reach. They are 

all under the sway of Kal. (4) 

The abode of the Merciful is inaccessible and infinite. 
It is beyond and distinct from three Sunns. (5) 

[The first Sunn is the boundary between Pind and Brahmand, 
the second is known as Daswan Dwar and the third is 
Maha-sunn, the boundary between the first and the second 
grand divisions of creation.] 

None knows the secrets without the Sant Sat Guru. He 
comes from that Abode and reveals the secrets. (6) 

I am also a Das (slave, devotee) of His Holy Feet. 
I have faith in Him and cherish the hope of being 
admitted to His Abode. (7) 

He initiated me in Surat Shabd Yoga, and graciously 
made me His own. (8) 



8] as Sat Guru [175 

I daily practise this Abhyas (Surat Shabd Yoga). One 
day, I will get Shabd in its true and real form. (3) 

My Sat Guru is Param Dayal (supremely merciful). I 
perform His Arti, and become enriched. (10) 

With the Thai (platter) of Atma (soul), the flame of 

Parmatma (God), and the*fcft Moti (pearl) of Satnam, 
I perform the ceremony of Arti. I am filled with 
love and affection. I am happy in the company of 
Sat Guru like a fish in water. (11-12) 

This Arti is now complete. Nothing remains to be 

said. (13) 



Shabd 3 

■^ "ato ^t fytfcH ^f i 
$f#* qflWf** II q It 

My love for Guru has grown intense. I withdraw my 

Surat and place it at the Holy Feet. (1) 

The form of Sat Guru has captivated my eyes. My 

love is enhanced every moment. ,(2) 

I offer myself to Sat Guru who has vouchsafed His 
protection to me. He stretched His arms to receive 
me and endowed me with strong devotion. (3-4) 

I now perform His Arti and offer my body, mind, riches, 
and everything to Him. (5) 

I do not believe in anyone but Guru. Except Nam, I 

know no haven of rest. (6) 



176 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

There is no one else but Guru. Whatever Guru ordains 
shall come to pass. (7) 

Guru is the Doer and Dispenser of all. Guru is the Acharya 
(the Supreme Preceptor) of all the Jivas. (8) 

Guru is the support of my life. He alone will effect 

my liberation. (9) 

None is so dear to me as Guru. Guru alone will bring 
about my reformation. (10) 

Guru alone dwells in my heart. Seeing this, Jama and Kal 
are put to shame, and they run away. (11) 

My heart is illumined by the splendour of Guru. All 
evils are warded off. All the three kinds of suffering 
are removed. (12) 

[Three kinds of suffering are: one due to the body, another 
caused by providence, like calamity, etc., and a third 
arising from existence in, or from contact with, the world.] 

Enhancing my love and zeal, I perform Arti, and get 

drenched in bliss. (13) 

I am dependent on Guru the way a fish is dependent 
on water. Nothing more remains to be done 
now. (14) 

I have met Radhasoami, the Guru. I drink the nectar 
of His Holy Feet, and remain contented. (15) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 177 

Shabd 4 

3TR H 3TPF^ ffa 3HTTT I 
3TK^t TT^T f ^ m II S II 

My joy is unbounded today. I sing Arti of my Guru. (1) 

I have adorned myself with unique love. Sat Guru 
sits majestically, in the dress He has put on, i.e., 
in the human form He has assumed. (2) 

I fix my gaze on Him with rapt attention. I sing His 

praises again and again. (3) 

friends! Come ye, one and all. Brushing away all 

dust and dirt (of the world), let us join and sing 
His praises and engage in His Darshan. (4) 

My Guru is majestically seated on a Palang (bed, 
bedstead). I am extremely fortunate today. (5) 

1 am always in the august presence of my Guru. I 

rely wholly on His Holy Feet. (6) 

I seek not favour from any other quarter. I have tena- 
ciously attached myself to Guru. (7) 

I offer my body and mind to Guru. I am quite alert to 
His behests. (8) 

Guru has annihilated all my Karams. He has taken 

me across on His boat. (9) 

Guru has enabled my Surat to hear the Shabd current. 
I ascend to Gagan, and reach the abode of the 
creator. (10) 



178 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

I quit Pind, and ascend to the top (Sunn). The mist 

being removed. I become pure. (11) 

I hear the resonance of Nam, and the melodious sound 
of the flute. (12) 

Surat and Nirat go on penetrating within with greater 
vigour. I get across the fourth Region (Sat Lok). (13) 

I get Darshan of Radhasoami. I now remain in His 

august presence all day and night. (14) 



Shabd 5 

"feT f^T "^TT "?T«3 "$ KJT^ II S II 

I now perform Arti of Sat Guru. I apply my Surat to 

Shabd every moment. (1) 

I make all preparations for the ceremony of Arti. I hold 
the platter of Sucheti (vigilance) in my hand. (2) 

[Suchet Singh was the name of the eldest son of Chachaji 
Saheb.] 

I kindle the flame of Sujani (wisdom) and behold 

Sudarshan (beautiful and handsome Form) within. (3) 

[Sujan Singh and Sudarshan Singh were the names of 
the second and the third sons of Chachaji Saheb] 

Satsangis are all Sumeet (good friends). Pratap (good 
fortune) has smiled upon them and they have 
conquered the mind. (4) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 179 

[Sumeet Singh was the eldest son of Suchet Singh. Pratap 
Singh (alias Chachaji Saheb) was the youngest brother of 
Soamiji Maharaj.] 

I offer Bhog (food) with devotion and love. I fetch 

water from the ocean of Ami (nectar). (5) 

When Sat Guru takes His seat on the throne and 
delivers discourses, both Jyoti and Niranjan are 
put to shame. (6) 

I move the platter of Arti before Sat Guru. He casts 

a benign glance at me. (7) 

How should I sing His praises ! I again and again 

devote myself to the Holy Feet. (8) 

I am extremely worthless and humble and meek. Sat 
Guru has been kind and merciful from time 
immemorial. (9) 

He has initiated me in the perfect path of Surat Shabd 
Yoga. The sound of drum has become audible 
within me. (10) 

Shabd is constantly resounding. Ascending higher and 
higher Surat and Nirat are now getting awakened. 
(11) 

I bathe in Triveni (confluence of three currents) and merge 
the subtle mind in the region of Sunn. (12) 

I complete the Arti in all respects. Radhasoami has 
showered immense grace and mercy upon me. (13) 



180 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

Shabd 6 

^ ^ 3TTTrT 61 ^R I 

I will perform Arti of Guru. I will adopt the Saran of 

Guru. (1) 

I will sing the praise of Guru. I will wash the Holy 

Feet of Guru. (2) 

I will sacrifice my mind before Guru. I will always 

associate with Guru. (3) 

I will ward off Kal and overpower Karams in no time. (4) 

I will enshrine the Form of Guru in my heart and 
enjoy the bliss of His Darshan all the time. (5) 

I will hear His discourses and act accordingly. I will 

elevate my Surat to Gagan. (6) 

I will ascend to Sunn and awaken the Shabd thereof. 
I will hear the incessant resonance of Daswan 
Dwar (tenth door). (7) 

I will merge in Sat Lok. After effecting this ascension 
in Abhyas, and experiencing bliss, I will come back 
to the world. (8) 

I will bring the members of my family to the Holy 

Feet of Guru. (9) 

I will teach them the ways of love and devotion, and 
make them perform Arti of Guru. (10) 

I will get my dead ancestors redeemed. I will thus 
prove the futility of the ceremony of Gaya. (11) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 181 

[Gaya is a celebrated place of pilgrimage among Hindus. 
A surviving relative of a dead person performs certain 
ceremony there, called the ceremony of Gaya, expecting 
thereby to secure location in heaven for the dead ancestor.] 

I will remove their illusions and delusions. I will help 
them get rid of wanderings and entanglements in 
false beliefs. (12) 

I will purify their intellect. I will make them firm and 

strong in their adherence to Sant Mat. (13) 

I will concentrate my Surat at the centre of the eyes, 
and translate it to Sahas-dal-kanwal. (14) 

I will get Darshan of Jyoti (flame), and merge in Shabd. (15) 

I will open the door to Banknal, and take my seat in 

Trikuti. (16) 

I will bathe in Mansarovar, and hear the Sarangi 

(violin). (17) 

I will get across Maha-sunn, hear the sound Sohang 
coming from the flute of Bhanwargupha. I will 
unravel hidden sounds and mysteries. (18-19) 

I will rush on the way to Sat Lok, and realize the 

true Nam Pad. (20) 

By means of a telescope, I will behold Alakh, and 

go there. (21) 

I will ascend to the inaccessible mansion of Agam. I 
will not reveal the mysteries of that region. (22) 

I will now prepare for Arti and enhance my love. (23) 



182 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

I will light the lamp of Surat in the platter of Bhakti (devotion). 
I will sing the hymn of Arti before Radhasoami, and 
get to Param Pad (the Original Home). (24-25) 

&$& 

Shabd 7 

T&Z 3fa ^ IcW "3FTTf II 1 II 

Guru explains to me how to perform Arti. He awakens 
me from the stupor of infatuation. (1) 

He reveals to me Anhad Shabd, and turns my Surat 
from this side to that. (2) 

My inner eye is opened and I get Darshan. I am thrilled to 
come to Nij Ghar (true and real home). (3) 

I make a platter of Mansarovar and a lamp of the 

moon for Arti. (4) 

I prepare for Arti with gusto and zeal. Anhad Nad 

becomes audible within me. (5) 

I score victory over the mind, the arch enemy, ^ffi 
Sumat (good understanding) has dawned and ^RT 
Dur-mat (folly) has vanished. (6) 

I devote myself to Guru's Holy Feet. I attain Sat Lok 

by His Daya (grace and mercy). (7) 

Spiritual link being established, I ascend higher and 
higher. My mind is in high spirits at the prospect 
of uttering the Holy Name RADHASOAMI. (8) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 183 

Shabd 8 

I sacrifice myself at the Holy Feet of my Guru, who 
has enabled me to behold Jyoti (flame) within 
myself. (1) 

Darkness is gone, and there is light now. I enjoy the 

blissful company of Guru. (2) 

I recognize none but Guru. Entanglement in rituals 
and delusions, as well as doubts and misgivings 
have all vanished. (3) 

I fix my gaze at the Holy Feet of Guru, and sacrifice 
all, my body, mind and riches, before Him. (4) 

How should I describe the eminence of Guru? I keep 
my Surat attached to the Holy Feet day and night. (5) 

I make ornaments of the glory and majesty of Guru. I use 
Surat as hammer and the mind as anvil. (6) 

I melt Moh (attachment, fatuity) in the'^olcfl Kuthali 1 
off^rf Chitt (attention). I blow air, through the 
pipe of mouth, on the fire offa^FVirah (pangs of 
separation) to make it aglow. (7) 

I draw wire through the ^raft Jantri 2 of Prem (love) 

and give twist to Surat and Nirat. (8) 



I. A crucible, an earthen pot or vase for melting gold, silver, etc. 
2. A perforated plate of steel through which ingots of gold, 
silver, etc., are drawn into wire. 



184 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

I make cfteT Tora 1 and put it round the neck of Guru. 
I feel extremely elated to see the fascinating form 
of Guru. (9) 

I make a^T\^ Bazu-band 2 of love, and ^?TKara 3 

of faith and belief. (10) 

I make an^^jstAngoothi (ring) of my sfn Ang (body), and 
set it with jewels and diamonds of the Holy Name. I 
offer it to Guru to wear it on His finger. (11) 

Radhasoami is Din Dayal (merciful to the humble). I 
perform His Arti with care and attention. (12) 



Shabd 9 

ita *rd #!M to *nt ii i ii 

O^ri Guiyan 4 ! Guru is imparting proper understanding. 
Sakhis, filled with love, are singing in chorus. (1) 

He gives out the secrets and mysteries of inaccessible 
regions, and teaches the practice of Surat Shabd 
Yoga. (2) 

Those who have love and yearning, will apply themselves 
to this path. (3) 



1. A gold or silver chain for the neck, a collarette usually 
consisting of four or five separate chains. 2. Ornament 
worn on the arm, armlet, bracelet, 3. A massive ring of 
gold or silver worn on the wrist or ankles. 4. Playmate. 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 185 

They will cultivate love for Sat Guru and enjoy the bliss 
of Nam. Their latent spirituality will awaken and they 
will get admittance into the Highest Region. (4) 

Who can describe the good luck of those who have been 
attracted to the Holy Feet of Sat Guru! (5) 

Sat Guru will reveal the secrets of the internal path 
and make the 3R"^ ?TK Anhad Shabd of Sunn 
audible to them. (6) 

Sat Guru bestows # ^"SO" Pad (True Region) on 
His devotees, which Yogis 1 ; Yatis 2 and Naths 3 all 
failed to realize. (7) 

He will enable Surat and Nirat to recognize Sat Nam 
and Sat Lok. (8) 

Pointing out Alakh and Agam, He will indicate the 

indescribable Anami (Nameless Being). (9) 

This 3T^ Abhed status is not known to any one. 

Only some rare Sants know it. (10) 

[On reaching Anami Pad, Surat can, at will, merge in the 
Nameless Being or retain its separate entity and enjoy 
the bliss of His Darshan. These two states are known as 
3T l T^ Abhed and ^^ Bhed respectively.] 

"That "So" Pad (True Region) was easily attained by 
me. To whom shall I say about it? (11) 



1. Yogi = One who performs the practice of mastering the 
six nervous centres of Pind. 2. Yati = One who has 
renounced and controlled passions. 3. Nath = Followers 
of Gorakh Nath. 



186 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

I now complete this Arti, and enshrine Radhasoami 

in my heart. (12) 



<i A i) 

Shabd 10 

^fft TPT ^T ^TW II tt || 
3^T 3T^fa "TT ^H ^H ^T It 1 I 

O Premi (lover)! Hearken what I say about Prem (love). 
Engage yourself in the Sewa (service) of Guru 
with love, and devote yourself to His Darshan. (1) 

The discourses of beloved Guru should be as dear 
to a devotee as the lisping of a child is to its 
mother. (2) 

Guru should be as dear to a Gurumukh (devotee) as 
a loving woman is to a passionate lover. (3) 

Be never oblivious of Guru, whether you are eating 
or drinking, walking or moving, sleeping or wak- 
ing. (4) 

The heart pierced by an arrow constantly throbs with 
pain. Exactly the same way does a lover feel the 
pangs of separation from the beloved. (5) 

A ^^J^ Gurumukh who has developed so intense love 
for Guru is verily a worthy recipient of Parmarth. (6) 

So long as one has not developed such love, one is 

only greedy and covetous. (7) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 187 

He is aTR^T3Mana-mukh wandering here and there 
like a rolling stone belonging to none. How can 
he attain Parmarth? (8) 

Radhasoami now enjoins upon you to hold the arm 

of Sat Guru and seek His protection. (9) 



Shabd 11 

7T^ ^TT 3TTSHT, 7T35 ^T *pf fat^HI I! ^ II 

Guru is my life and breath. He has granted me the gift of 
Shabd. Shabd is my prop and support. The true worth 
of Shabd has dawned upon me (1) 

What should I say about the efficacy of Shabd. Shabd 
comes from the inaccessible region. Without Shabd, 
all Jivas wander in darkness. (2) 

They are engaged in the worship of water, stones and 
books. They belong to w\ Wi Man-mat 1 , they work 
under the dictates of the mind. They will be tossed 
about in the cycle of births and deaths. (3) 

Without the practice of Surat Shabd Yoga, a Jiva 
remains afflicted with all sorts of troubles and 
miseries. Without the Sewa (service) of the Sat 
Guru, he will be nowhere. (4) 

O you ignorant one! What else will Sat Guru teach and 

1. Religion in which mind, and not the spirit, is an active 
participant. 



188 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

preach except the secrets of Shabd (viz., Surat Shabd 
Yoga)? Remember, if your mind and senses are not 
under control, you will be crunched by Kal. (5) 

Seek the protection of Radhasoami. You will be saved 
in every way. He will instantly shower His grace 
and mercy upon you and enrich you with the treasure 
that is inaccessible and unapproachable. (6) 



Shabd 12 

7£S vRH ^ 3*«r TR If I 

% •&& fll ?& ■&{ H || q || 

The Holy Feet of Guru are enshrined in my heart. I 

worship them within me every moment. (1) 

I have developed love for the Dhun (Shabd, sound) 
within. I have got to the first Sunn, viz., the great 
expanse beyond third Til. (2) 

The anguish of passion and lust has been replaced 
by Tfto Shil (good disposition) andfwrChimma 
(patience and forgiveness). (3) 

Anger and avarice have also fled away. Egotism and 
infatuation have left. (4) 

Five Shabds have become audible. The mind has 

easily renounced worldly pleasures. (5) 

With the grace of Guru, light has dawned, and the 

world has now become alien. (6) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 189 

I have discarded all external activities and have 

directed my attention inward. (7) 

Guru has afforded such a unique happiness as can- 
not be described. (8) 

The worldly Jivas are all unlucky. They are simply 

wasting their human life. (9) 

Why do they not cultivate love for Guru? Why do they 
remain a slave to «nr Jama (Kal)? (10) 

But who cares to listen to me? I keep mum. (11) 

Strengthen your faith in Guru Mat (religion of 

devotion to Guru). Care not for others. (12) 

Go to Trikuti. Ascend to Sunn. (13) 

Remove the barrier of Maha-sunn. Enter the market 
of Bhanwargupha. (14) 

You will then get to the mansion of Satt Purush and 

hear the Dhun of the '"sff^Bin (harp). (15) 

You will hear the Shabds of Alakh and Agam. Even 
hundred thousand millions of suns and moons look 
pale before the refulgence of those regions. (16) 

You will then meet your beloved Radhasoami. Noth- 
ing can be said about Him, except that He is 
Anarmi a^mt (Nameless Being) (17) 

My Arti is unique. Some rare darling Surat will 

understand it. (18) 

This unfathomable secret has been imparted to you, 
which none knows except Sants. (19) 



190 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

Jivas of the world, who are given to rituals and 
observances, are blind. They have all been 
ensnared by Kal. (20) 

You should not talk to them about this profound Faith. 
It should be kept hidden from them. (21) 

Practise the Abhyas of Surat Shabd Yoga. Apply your 
body and mind to Sumiran (recitation of the Holy 
Name). (22) 

Go on beholding the countenance of Guru. Listen to the 
sound of3R?t TK Anhad Shabd every day. (23) 

Cultivate a keen desire to attend Satsang, and do 

so whenever you can. (24) 

I have learnt the Holy Name RADHASOAMI. This is 
the highest and noblest teaching. (25) 



Shabd 13 

^ ^FTTW ^^FTET II «l 11 

O my darling ! Adopt the Saran of Sat Guru so that 

the toll of Karams be paid off. (1) 

The whole world is lost in errors and delusions. Nobody 
likes to listen to this unique advice. (2) 

They are all unlucky, under the sway of Maya. No- 
body can attain this high status. (3) 

Those who are recipients of the grace and mercy of 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 191 

the Supreme Creator, will alone like to partake of 
this 3H{?r Amrit (nectar). (4) 

How far should I go on dwelling upon this high 
position? Only rare Gururnukhs understand and 
appreciate it (5) 

Nothing is pleasing to them except the Holy Feet of 

Guru. They are absorbed in this bliss. (6) 

On getting Darshan of Guru, they forget all about their 
body. How could they be then aware of what is 
inside and what is outside? (7) 

What should I say of those persons who are so deeply 
absorbed in love? (8) 

They do not find this bliss in Yoga, Gyan and Bairag 1 
which are, in fact, all dry. (9) 

Only some blessed devotees and lovers will be 

recipients of this precious gift. (10) 

Radhasoami says that some rare Gurumukh alone 

will sing this Arti. (11) 



Shabd 14 

ig; w?t 3TP3T if tnf i 

Today I have come under the Saran (protection and 

care) of Guru. My joy knows no bounds. (1) 

1. Renunciation. 



192 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

I have found Guru, the ocean of kindness. Songs of 
congratulations are being sung inside and out- 
side my house. (2) 

Guru is wr "J^r Param Purush (Supreme Being) 
and "g^sr ^FTtSukh-data (conferer of happiness). 
I am strongly attached to His Holy Feet. (3) 

I engage myself in devotion to Guru day and night. I 
sing His praises with my heart and soul. (4) 

I apply my Surat to the Darshan of Guru. I enhance 

my love for Him. (5) 

When I fix my gaze at the countenance of Guru, I behold 
the refulgence of myriads of suns and moons. (6) 

I announce openly that there is none equal to my 

Guru. (7) 

O my brother ! Hold fast to the Holy Feet of Guru. 
You have been endowed with the noble human 
form. Why do you go astray? (8) 

Engender love for Guru and make your life truly fruit- 
ful. This world is unreal like a dream. (9) 

Life in this world is like a dark night, which can be 
illumined if the moon of Guru's image rises. (10) 

When the moonlight of Guru's discourses shines in your 
heart, you attain serenity and calmness. (11) 

There is none greater than my Guru. All are over- 
whelmed by Kal. (12) 

Only a rare Gurumukh (devotee) will seek Sat Guru. 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 193 

Manmukhs (those under the dictates of their minds) 
are all slaves of Kal. (13) 

They only talk of the importance and greatness of Guru, 
but have no love for Him in their hearts. (14) 

They wander under the sway of delusions and errors. 
They do not apply their mind to Guru. (15) 

I consider such Jivas unfortunate, I do not recognize 
anybody except Guru. (16) 

I now perform Arti of Guru and hold fast to the Holy 

Feet of Radhasoami. (17) 



Shabd 15 

f$3l % "^f *H TT5R II 

Let me use the dust of the Feet of Guru as collyrium. 
Then will my inner eye be opened and mind puri- 
fied. (1) 

All darkness will be removed and the sun-like reful- 
gent ^T Rup (image) of Guru will illumine my 
heart. (2) 

This will increase my love for Guru and enhance my 
zest every moment. (3) 

My Surat will ascend to Trikuti, meet Guru, and 
hear the Shabd of the Sat Guru Pad, i.e. of Sat 
Lok. (4) 



194 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

That Sat Guru is now in this world awakening the 

erring humanity. (5) 

What should I sing of the glory and eminence of Sat 
Guru. He is effecting the regeneration of fallen 
Jivas. (6) 

Mana and Maya try their best to keep Jivas in their 

snares but they are kicked away by Sat Guru. (7) 

I am a slave of the slaves of Sat Guru. I devotedly apply my 
body and mind to His Sewa (service). (8) 

I am low, sinful and unclean. Sat Guru has taken me 
in His lap and made me His own. (9) 

Guru has made my life fruitful. I behold His most 

charming and handsome Form. (10) 

This Arti (hymn of praise) was sung by^NTDona. 

So says Radhasoami. (11) 

[Dona=(l) Name of a devotee. (2) Literally means 
two i.e., Surat and Ntj Mana.] 



Shabd 16 

*p ^asTR #f ■srr *fHr u <? u 

How foolish I am that I give up the Darshan of Guru 
and go back to my house (to attend household 
duties)! (1) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 195 

What should I do now to get Guru's Holy Feet 

implanted in my heart ? (2) 

Where can I hear such discourses, and sow the seed 
of Parmarath in my heart ? (3) 

I am day and night in gloom. Why should I leave the 
bliss of the Holy Feet? (4) 

Human life is not to be obtained again. Why should 

I drown myself in the world ? (5) 

Now I have decided never to leave the company of Sat 
Guru. I will sever ties with my body and mind. (6) 

I will eradicate Karams by the strength of Guru, and 
vanquish Kal by attending Satsang. (7) 

If Guru grants me His grace and kindness, this 

difficult task can be accomplished. (8) 

My only desire is that I may never be separated from 
the H oly Feet of G u ru . (9) 

The past Sants as well as the Vedas have ranked 

none greater than Guru. (10) 

All sing the praise of Guru. This humble and meek 

Jiva has come to know of this fact. (11) 

My love and yearning for the Holy Feet of Guru has 
grown intense. I cannot describe the grandeur of 
even a nail of His toe. (12) 

Crores of suns and moons look dull in comparison 

with the refulgence of His nail. (13) 

The sun and the moon remove external darkness, while 



196 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

the Holy Feet illumine the heart and help the 

devotee thread pearls within. I devote myself to 

the nail of my Guru. (14-15) 

I now perform the Arti of Guru and apply my mind to 
the service and devotion of His Holy Feet. (16) 

O Sat Guru! Turn my Surat from this side to that. I 
am now going to my house. But I pray call me 
back. (17) 

Radhasoami! Listen to this prayer of mine. 
Release me from the fetters of worldly 
attachments. (18) 

1 am a slave of Thy slaves. One word from Thy holy 

lips will emancipate me. (19) 



Shabd 17 

If WJl WJ\ "^ ^3FT II q II 

Kal has badly beguiled the world. How far should I 

go on describing it ? (1) 

He has laid stress, in Kali Yuga, on the practices of 

yore. (2) 

Ignorant Jivas, fond of amusement, are entangled in 
the worship of water and stone. (3) 

The intellectual and conceited have become slaves 

of learning. (4) 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 197 

Rest of the Jivas, who are of a mediocre class, are 
engrossed in Japa 1 , Tapa 2 , Vrat 3 , Sanjarm 4 , and 
other delusions. They get roasted in the practice 
of penance amidst five fires. (5-6) 

Look at the tricks of Kal, some are tied by hands 
and others by feet. He has deluded all. To none 
has he shown the right path. (7-8) 

Moved by this pitiable plight of Jivas, Sant Sat Guru 

manifested Himself in the world. (9) 

He taught service and devotion to Guru, importance of 
Nam and the necessity of attending satsang. (10) 

He laid stress on these three methods. Consider all 

other methods as useless. (11) 

Know that the study of the Vedas 5 , Shastras 6 , Smritis 7 
and Purans 8 is mere waste of time. (12) 

Pandits 9 and Bhekhs 10 , for the sake of their earning 

and livelihood, criticise Sants. (13) 

Sants explain the truth to Jivas for their good. But 
Jivas, conceited as they are, do not accept those 
teachings. (14) 

They hanker after wealth, name and fame. They are 
denuded of Parmarth (religious understanding). (15) 

1. Japa = Repeating in a murmuring tone passages from 
scriptures. 2. Tapa = Devout austerity, mortification etc. 
3. Vrat = Fasting. 4. Sanjam = Restraint. 5. Vedas = 
Scriptures of Hindus. 6. Shastras =Religious treatises. 
7. Smritis = Books of codes of laws. 8. Purans = Mytho- 
logical stories. 9. Pandits = Family priests. 10. Bhekh = 
Ascetic, recluse. 



198 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 

They wander in the cycle of transmigration, and again 
and again fall into the four kinds of species. (16) 

They study the books of the past Yugas 1 such as, 

Vedant 2 , and Nyaya 3 . (17) 

They neither possess the means (calibre) nor the requisite 
fitness to study the scriptures, but they are proud 
of their learning. (18) 

They do not study the teachings or religion prescribed 
for the present times. Therefore, they fall into the 
mire below. (19) 

Know that humility and true Guru Bhakti (devotion to 
Guru) constitute the religion of this age. (20) 

Achieving purification and steadiness of mind, 
ascend to Gagan by the path of Shabd. (21) 

Attain the regions of five Shabds by practising Surat 
Shabd Yoga internally. (22) 

Go on ascending, step by step, by the practice of 
Shabd, and reach Sat Nam Sach Khand. (23) 

To this end, first of all, perform devotion to Guru. All 

else comes afterwards. (24) 

Enshrine the image of Guru in your heart and 
cherish love for Him as a Chakor does for the 
moon. (25) 



1. Yugas = Ages. 2. Vedant = The last of the six principal 
systems of Hindu philosophy. 3. Nyaya = One of the six 
religious philosophical systems of the Hindus. 



8 ] as Sat Guru [ 199 

So long as you are not able to engender such love, 
you should continue with the same method as 
prescribed above. (26) 

When Guru Bhakti (devotion to Guru) is perfected, 
your Surat will ascend to higher regions. (27) 

Those who work hard at Shabd Yoga without devo- 
tion to Guru, are foolish. (28) 

Shabd will become audible by the grace and kind- 
ness of Guru. He is all-powerful. He draws your 
Surat upwards. (29) 

Without Gurumukhta (devotion to Guru), Surat will 
never rise, nor will Gagan be pierced and Nam 
obtained. (30) 

Gurumukhta (devotion to Guru) is the base and foundation. 
Other methods are only branches or auxiliary. (31) 

Guru should be dear to a devotee as a son to his 
mother, a woman to her passionate lover, water 
to fish, and Swanti rain to Chatrik (Papiha bird). 
Then only can progress be expected. (32-34) 

I have said all that I have to say, it is now up to you 

to accept it or not. (35) 

This is the Arti of a Gurumukh. Only a Gurumukh 

will testify to it. (36) 

Radhasoami has laid stress on Bhakti (devotion) to 

Guru. Therefore, perform Guru Bhakti. (37) 

Devotion to any one else should be discarded. Why 
do you get yourself plunged in Chaurasi? (38) 



200 ] Eminence of Radhasoami [ Bachan 8 

Radhasoami declares that no activity is at par with 

devotion to Guru. (39) 

Contemplate the form of Guru every day. Always hear 
Guru's Shabd with your ears. (40) 

Eyes, ears and heart, all three should be spotlessly 

clean like a crystal palace. (41) 

Radhasoami repeatedly stresses the importance of 

Guru Bhakti (devotion to Guru). (42) 



BACHAN 9 



IN PRAISE OF 

SAT GURU 

AS THE EMBODIMENT OF SHABD 



Shabd 1 

Blessed is my darling Shabd. What should I say about 
the efficacy of Shabd ! (1)' 

Those alone who have come in contact with Shabd, 

realize the greatness of Shabd. (2) 

Shabd protects me every moment. There is nothing 

like Shabd. (3) 

Those who do not know the superiority of Shabd, 

remain wandering in delusions. (4) 

Blessed are those who have found the Guru who teaches 
Shabd Yoga and who have cultivated love for Shabd. 
Those who are engaged in the practice of Shabd 
(Surat Shabd Yoga) are extremely fortunate. (5-6) 



202] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

The mind cannot be controlled without Shabd Abhyas. 
Therefore, endeavour in applying your Surat to 
Shabd. " (7) 

What for were you granted human form if you do not 
acquire the wealth of Shabd? (8) 

Shabd is resounding every moment within you. Why 
do you not listen to it? (9) 

To get an inkling of Shabd, you must meditate in 

seclusion. (10) 

Give up sloth, slumber and laziness. Apply yourself 

vigorously to Shabd. (11) 

Five Shabds are resounding in the inner recesses of 
every being; find them out. (12) 

Guru has imparted the knowledge of Shabd to you. 

Meditate upon Shabd. (13) 

I have disclosed the secrets of various Shabds. But 
pity it is that nobody pays attention to Shabd. (14) 

Those who did not ascend to higher regions by means 
of Shabd, have wasted their life. (15) 

Radhasoami has said enough, He now keeps mum. 
No one can catch hold of the current of Shabd 
without requisite fitness. (16) 



Shabd 2 

TTS^ % TTTETT ^cft STTft II <1 It 



9 ] In praise of Shabd [ 203 

Shabd has created the three worlds. The entire expanse 
of Maya is due to Shabd. (1) 

Shabd has created And 1 and Brahmand 2 . Shabd has 
brought into existence the seven Dweeps 3 (islands) 
and the Nau-khand 4 (nine continents). (2) 

Shabd sustains the three Gunas or qualities (Satoguna, 
Rajoguna and Tamoguna or Vishnu, Brahma, and 
Shiva) and the creation brought about by them. 
Shabd maintains the earth and the heavens. (3) 

Jiva and Brahm both have emanated from Shabd, 
and so also have the sun and the moon. (4) 

Shabd has created Sunn and Maha-sunn as also the 
fourth Lok (region). (5) 

Shabd is reverberating within everybody. Shabds of 
Alakh and Agam are wonderful. (6) 

Nothing is devoid of Shabd. Shabd fills all space. (7) 

What should I say in praise of Shabd! I enjoin upon 

you to contact with Shabd somehow. (8) 

Guru now impresses upon you that none can help 

the Jivas except Shabd. (9) 



Egg-shaped regions of the three gods. 2. Regions of the 
universal Mind. 3. According to Hindu sages, the terrestrial 
world is divided into seven divisions, all situated round 
the mountain Meru, like the petals of lotus flower, and 
separated from each other by a distinct ocean. 4. One of 
the seven Dweeps or islands, referred to in foot-note No. 
3, is Jambu Dweep which is further divided into nine 
continents, known as 'Nau Khand'. 



204] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Apply your Surat to Shabd lovingly. Shabd alone is 
Chetan (spiritual). It illumines your inner self. (10) 

Practise Shabd Yoga every day. Without Shabd 
your egotism cannot be removed. (11) 

Keeping your mind under restraint perform Shabd Abhyas. 
Kal, Karam, etc., are subdued by Shabd. (12) 

My dear, hear me. Merge your Surat in Shabd. You 
can never be redeemed without Shabd. (13) 

Shabd is ringing within you. Hear it with rapt attention. (14) 

Take your Surat to Gagan Shikhar (Trikuti and Sunn), where 
Dhuns (Shabds) are reverberating melodiously. (15) 

If longing for Shabd is engendered, all pleasures of 

the world will become insipid. (16) 

None has listened to the real Shabd. That is why all 
are subject to recurrent births and deaths. (17) 

Sants have promulgated the path of Shabd. Save Sants, 
no one knows the secrets of Shabd (18) 

Without Shabd, you will be in great distress. Catch 

hold of Shabd. Why labour in vain? (19) 

Concentrate your Surat and apply it to Shabd. This is the 
secret openly disclosed by Radhasoami. (20) 



Shabd 3 

3TcT WR "^T ^rs^ firaM II S 11 



9 ] In praise of Shabd [ 205 

Know ye, that Shabd is the beginning and the end of 
all. (1) 

The three loks (worlds) and the fourth Lok, all have 

been created by Shabd. (2) 

Both Shabd and Surat are like two currents. They 

are the Pran (breath) of Anami Purush. (3) 

All vitality is derived from Shabd and Surat. Without 

Shabd, there is no existence. (4) 

Shabd, in an unmanifest form, is Anam 1 and in a 

manifest form, it is Nam. (5) 

Whether Nam or Anam, it is all Shabd. If there were 

no Shabd, everything would disappear. (6) 

Just as fire is latent in stone, so is Shabd in Anam. 
Both Nam and Anam are of the same form. (7) 

Shabd is the cause, and Shabd, the effect. Shabd 

has created all that exists. (8) 

Shabd assumed the form of Agam, and then that of 
Alakh. Shabd is Sat Nam and Sat Shabd. (9) 

Shabd is Nih-akshar (Maha-sunn). Shabd is Akshar 
(Sunn). Sohang and Rarang, both are Shabd. (10) 

Ong and Niranjan are Shabd. There is Shabd of Brahm 
as well as of Maya. (11) 

Shabd is"sfta Jiva. Shabd is also^Siva (i.e., whom 
Jiva serves or worships). From Shabd emanated 
Surat, and from Surat emanated Shabd. (12) 

1. Nameless. Without Nam or Name. 



206 ] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

sifa OT and Tfa POT are nothing but Shabd. High 

and low, both are Shabd. (13) 

[What merges inarfaOT is termed "qfa POT. What absorbs 
ThT POT, is known as srhrf OT. 3TT?I 'OT' attracts and 
supports all and ^ 'POT' forms the circumference within 
which all is encompassed and held.] 

Shabd is Sewak (one who serves), and Shabd is 

also Soami (Lord, Master). Shabd is^u^iHlAntarjami 
(knower of all). (14) 

Shabd does not die. Shabd is 3T*TCAmar (undying). 
Shabd does not decay. Shabd is stsr Ajar (free 
from decomposition). (15) 

Guru and Das (disciple), both are Shabd. All hopes 
and expectations are false without Shabd. (16) 

Shabd is imperishable. It is the body which perishes. 
Nothing can be gained without Shabd. (17) 

All Sants have spoken of Shabd as the essence of all. 
Without Shabd, one cannot get redemption. (18) 

Shabd is deep, Shabd is profound. Without Shabd, 
one cannot attain the abode of eternal rest and 
peace. (19) 

Without Shabd none can be steady. Without Shabd, 

all religious pursuits are useless. (20) 

Shabd will remove all shackles. Shabd will eliminate 
all physical and mental pain. (21) 

Shabd is the fish and Shabd is the water. Kabir Saheb 
speaks of Shabd. (22) 



9 ] In praise of Shabd [ 207 

Guru Nanak speaks of Shabd, so does Tuisi Saheb. (23) 

Shabd is the^i Vastra 1 and Shabd is the ^RChira 2 
Shabd is the butter, and Shabd is the essence. (24) 

Search within your body and you will find Shabd. Shabd 
is in Sahas-dal.kanwal and Trikuti. (25) 

Without Shabd all Jivas are captives, bound and tied. You 
will get Shabd, if you contact a Faqir (Sant). (26) 

Shabd is the bass (in music), or the left. Shabd is the treble 
(in music), or the right. Without Shabd, all activity is 
vain like the churning of water. (27) 

Catch hold of Shabd, and all becomes yours. He who 
is in contact with Shabd, is rich. (28) 

Shabd is the emperor and Shabd the minister. 

Radhasoami says that one should try to understand 
this secret. (29) 



Shabd 4 

TjSS l& cHTT et ?T^ WK I 
Tg5 % TP\ "3ST 7T5? 3T8TTT II 1 II 

Relying on the grace and mercy of Guru, grasp Shabd 
firmly. In the company of Guru, make Shabd your 
support. (1) 

Shabd will redeem you. Without Shabd you will be 

buried along the currents of eighty four. (2) 

1. Gents' dress. 2. Ladies' dress. 



208 ] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Practising Shabd Yoga is the only real activity. Shabd 
will lift you to Daswan Dwar (tenth orifice, Sunn). (3) 

Engender love for the Guru who is an adept in Shabd 
Yoga. Discard all other activities. (4) 

There is no one else but Shabd to steer you. Shabd 
alone does good to all. (5) 

There are Shabds and Shabds. Guru will impart to 

you true knowledge of different Shabds. (6) 

Fix your Surat at the third Til. You will then come in contact 
with Shabd, and your anxieties will be removed. (7) 

Shabd will take you out of the world. Apply yourself 
carefully to Shabd. (8) 

Make Shabd alone your sustenance. O my friend! 

None can be saved without Shabd. (9) 

Shabd will banish all egotism. Shabd will cast off all 

evils. (10) 

I repeatedly impress upon you that except Shabd, 

there is no essence or reality. (11) 

Do not sit idle. Apply yourself to Shabd. Get across 

in the boat of Shabd. (12) 

Blessed are those whose hearts have been illumined by 
Shabd, and who have the Support of Shabd. (13) 

You also rise by hearing the resonance of Shabd. Shabd 
will then become a garland round your neck. (14) 

Catch hold of Shabd, and leave the rest. Without Shabd, 
there is no salvation. (15) 



9 ] In praise of Shabd [ 209 

You ignorant one ! Learn the secrets of Shabd. Why are 
you going astray under the dictates of mind? (16) 

Withdraw your Surat at the third Til. The current of Shabd 
is on the right side. On the left side, are the snares 
of Kal. Leave the Shabd coming from the left. Listen 
carefully to the sound of the bell and the conch, 
beyond which is the Shabd of Ormkar. (17-18-19) 

Hear Rarankar in Sunn, and the melodious flute in 

Bhanwargupha. (20) 

In Sat Lok, hear the Dhun of the Bin (harp). I will not disclose 
the Dhuns or Shabds of Alakh and Agam. (21) 

Radhasoami has revealed the secrets in detail. Now 
grasp the significance of this revelation, and always 
keep it in your mind. (22) 



Shabd 5 

7!°% fsRT WT "3FT 3T8JT I 
^t£ ^T T&$ ^T TP^T II q II 

Without Shabd, the whole world is groping in the dark. Who 
can cut asunder the noose of Moh (infatuation)? (1) 

Without Shabd, all efforts are futile and all the Jivas 

are in bondage. (2) 

Shabd is the sun. Shabd is the moon. Without Shabd, 
a Jiva remains unclean. (3) 

Without Shabd, all are steeped in ignorance. Shabd 

is the preceptor as well as the precept. (4) 



210 ] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

If you apply yourself to Shabd, you will be a recipient 
of bliss. Sans Shabd, everything is blasphemy. (5) 

Therefore, engage in the practice of Surat Shabd Yoga. 
Think of no other practice. (6) 

Learn the secrets of Shabd from Guru and then merge 
in Shabd. (7) 

Shabd illumines the path to higher regions. Peep into 
the city of Shabd. (8) 

Shabd is distinct and separate from all. Shabd 
accomplishes everybody's task. (9) 

Know that Shabd is the essence of all. Take to Shabd 
and you will be redeemed. (10) 

O friend! Perform Shabd practices. Subdue Kal by 

Shabd. (11) 

See the stages of Shabd within yourself. By the practice 
of Shabd, behold the Beloved. (12) 

Shabd effaces the lines of Karam. Shabd unites you 
with Shabd. (13) 

Without Shabd, all knowledge is superficial and all 

meditation hollow and sham. (14) 

O ignorant one! Do not give up Shabd. Radhasoami 
warns you again and again. (15) 



9] In praise of Shabd [211 

Shabd 6 

■?t^ ^Ft ^nr isfi'mf ^r "are i 

?T^ TTT aft? ^ ^tf ?*r "3T IM tl 

Devote yourself every moment to Shabd. There is no 
friend like Shabd. (1) 

Hear Shabd by closing your ears. Follow the incessant 
resonance of Shabd. (2) 

Shabd will free you from egotism. Contact the current 
of Shabd and you will attain stability within. (3) 

You will see the dazzling light and then remain absorbed 
in sound every moment. (4) 

You will give up all pleasures and become detached 
from the world. You will ascend, and hear a deep 
sound. (5) 

Guru enjoins upon you to remain firmly absorbed in 
Shabd. You will then hear a sound like ^m ^~R 
Barn- Bam. (6) 

pPT ^ Barn-Bam is the sound of the region of Shiva, 
just above the third Til. Shiva is always saluted or addressed 
as Barn-Bam Mahadeo.] 

Your Surat will go up merrily, reach Sunn and hear 

the melodious music. (7) 

You will hear a heavy sound. What should I say about 
the efficacy of Shabd? It is very great. (8) 

Whatever I may say, is inadequate. This matter is like 
a sealed book. How can I say it openly? (9) 



212] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Your Surat will gain access to Adhar (the region resting 
on no support) and enjoy the close company of 
her Beloved. (10) 

All the darkness and impurity of the heart will vanish. 
Shabd will be raining constantly with a soft pattering 
sound. (11) 

The light will spread within you. Ami-ras (nectar) will 

be dripping like dew. (12) 

All efforts of the mind having failed, it is in despair. 
Now the balm of Dhun is applied to Surat. (13) 

I surrender myself whole-heartedly to Guru. Radhasoami 
gives such discourses one after another. (14) 



Shabd 7 

^f "*TtT "Wt cRt #^T TfiE II 1 II 

In the company of Shabd, withdraw and concentrate 
your spirituality. Do not drift in the world, which 
has a vast expanse. (1) 

Without Shabd, you cannot find the way Home. Stages 
of Shabd are to be found within yourself. (2) 

Be allied to Shabd and then repose in peace on the 

cot of the six Chakras. (3) 

Ascend to Gagan, and taste Ami-ras (ambrosia). Without 
Shabd, there is no other straight path. (4) 



9] In praise of Shabd [213 

Fill the pitcher of your mind with Shabd. Shabd alone 
can eradicate Karams. (5) 

Without Shabd, you are wandering homeless. Get detached 
from the world by associating with Shabd. (6) 

Shabd removes the barriers. In the company of Shabd, 
you can peep into the vast courtyard. (7) 

Always sort out the right Shabd (sound). Drink the 
nectar of Shabd yourself, and distribute it to 
others. * (8) 

Then you will strike the pate of Kal. In the company 
of Shabd, there will remain no are Ant. Radhasoami 
proclaims that Shabd opens "STHSant. (9-10) 

[Below Sat Desh, Surat, Mana and Maya, are just together, 
all three of them. This is called WS 'Sant'. Lower down, 
they are twisted. This is called ^rrz 'Ant'. At the third 
Til, they are twisted and intertwined in a knofTTS (Ganth). 
Thus there are Sant, Ant, and Ganth.] 



Shabd 8 

j>_? t-^ 

"g-HT 3T3 7P5? UTTf PRT *TRT i 
*ft ** TO 3&T ^Itf TOT II S II 

Now apply your Surat to Shabd regularly. Always perform 
Surat Shabd practice. Do this alone and do not 
attend to any other activity. (1) 

Behold a shining lotus in the sky above. Then see 

the dazzling Jyoti (flame). (2) 



214] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Reverse the direction of your Surat (spirit) and Mana 
(Mind). Enter Sukhmana (middle current) and then 
turn upwards. (3) 

Abandon Ira (the left side), and join Pingla (the 

right side). Withdraw your Surat (spirit current) and 
proceed. (4) 

Catching hold of the sound, meet the presiding deity of 
the region, from whom the sound rs emanating. Give 
up pride and egotism. Stop going astray. (5) 

See the wonderful spectacle in the dome. Hear Ong 
and thunder. (6) 

Arrive at the shore of Mansarovar lake in the region 
of Sunn, become a Hansa, and feed upon pearls 
all day and night. (7) 

Your Surat will attain its true home and be absorbed 

in the bliss thereof. (8) 

May you ever partake of the bliss of that region. This 
is the Mauj of Radhasoami Dayal. (9) 



Shabd 9 

*& ^pf 1FT W1 UH$U$ II £^ II 

^frft- t5rt=t ^ -$$ ^f *n^ i 
ap "^t ^T tr m$Mi u s ii 

When one begins to hear Shabd, one's mind is brou- 
ght under control. By no other means will it come 
round. (1) 



9 ] In praise of Shabd [ 215 

Yogis are engaged in Yoga practices, and Gyanis in 
acquiring Gyan. (2) 

Tapsis dissipate themselves in Tapa (penance), 'and 
Jatis in Jata (curbing their sense and passions). (3) 

Dhyanis who are engaged in mental contemplation 

suffer jolts. (4) 

Pandits who read and recite the Vedas, will be dis- 
possessed of their power of learning. (5) 

Intellect and cunning will be of no avail. The learned 
will repent their conceit. (6) 

No other practice is efficacious. Apply yourself 
vigorously to the practice of Shabd (Surat Shabd 
Yoga). (7) 

When Guru, well-versed in the secrets and mysteries 
of Shabd, is met, the disciple will have longing 
and yearning for Shabd. (8) 

When one practises Surat Shabd Yoga, then only one's 
mind will become somewhat steady. (9) 

Nothing can be gained by envy, greed or hypocrisy. One 
has to surrender one's body and mind. (10) 

A covetous and hypocritical person can never contact 
Dhun (Shabd). (11) 

This Dhun or Shabd is of the Highest Region. Only 

a Sant soldier can contact it. (12) 

He will control the mind and mount on it. He will lay 
siege to the fortress of Gagan (Trikuti). (13) 



216] In praise of Sat Guru [ Bachan 

He will cross the moat round the expanse of Sunn, 

and come to the border of Maha-Sunn. (14) 

He will then break open the gate of Bhanwargupha. 
The crystal palace of Sat Guru will become 
visible. (15) 

The spectacle of that region is wondrous and astonishing. 
There each ray has the light of crores of suns 
and moons, and illumines ^^ Ghat and srHre 
Aughat. (16-17-18) 

This is a strange sight. Only a Gurumukh devotee 
can enjoy it by reversing and turning his spirit 
current. (19) 

How far should I describe that glory? Whosoever attains 
Sunn Samadhi or Chaitanya Samadhi (state of 
conscious absorption), can know what it is like. 
But then he cannot describe it, just as a dumb 
person is unable to describe the taste of sugar 
he has eaten. This is an indescribable and unique 
story (20-21) 

Radhasoami has revealed the secrets openly. (22) 



*pT ^fT WR TftT 3TW *H 3f II 1 II 

The mind is now delighted to hear Anhad Shabd re- 
sounding in Gagan. (1) 

Shabd 10 



9 ] In praise of Shabd [ 217 

Guru has made this Dhun (Shabd) audible to me within 
my body or Pind. Let me also apply my Surat to 
the sound of thunder. (2) 

I have killed the lion, and conquered this jungle. I 
have come in contact with Shabd after the lapse 
of many a Yuga. (3) 

I have applied myself to Shabd so intently that its 
Dhun (resonance) has now begun to reverberate 
incessantly in every nerve of my body. (4) 

Hearing Shabd, I go to Sunn, and turn out all ghosts 
and goblins (evils). (5) 

My Surat will never come back to these regions of 
evils. By the grace of Guru, I have contacted Shabd 
within myself. (6) 

All suffering has been removed by Shabd. I am now 
wide awake. The world appears to me unreal like 
a dream. (7) 

I now daily hear Shabd in this mansion (body or Pind). 
All the time, I am engaged in this practice. (8) 

I get gems of Shabd within me and proceed onwards 
from one Shabd to another. (9) 

Crushing passion, I seize the current of Shabd. Radhasoami 
addresses all and gives out this teaching. (10) 



BACH AN 10 



A DEFINITION OF SHABD OR NAM 



Shabd 1 

^qr l^ffer ^ <^ddi| n <i it 

My brother ! I am going to define NAM (Name). It is 

of two kinds. (1) 

They are Dhwanyatmak Name and the Varna form of 
the Dhwanyatmak Name. I give out details of both 
these kinds. (2) 

What is uttered by tongue may be termed as Varna 

or Akshar. (3) 

What is spoken and reduced to writing is termed 

Vamatmak. (4) 

This Varnatmak (Varna form of Dhwanyatmak Name) 
iseUsM-N+Lakhayak (pointer or indicator) of Dhun 
(sound). But without perfect Guru, nothing can be 
achieved. (5) 



Bachan 10 ] Shabd or Nam [ 219 

['Varna' means a letter, character, sound; and 'atmak' is 
a suffix meaning, with, consisting of, made and composed 
of. VARNATMAK, therefore, means a Varna form or imitation 
in articulate speech of DHWANI (Dhun) or a DHWANYATMAK 
Name. For instance, 'OM' when uttered orally, is the Varna 
form of the Dhwanyatmak Shabd 'OM' resounding automatically 
in the region of Trikuti. Thus, when the Shabds of higher 
regions or regions above the eyes are expressed on this 
plane in speech or in writing, that expression is the Varna 
form (in the form of the letters of alphabet or the form 
composed in the letters of alphabet) of the Dhwanyatmak 
Shabd of the respective region. This Varna form is, as 
Soamiji Maharaj calls it, ^<sn^* 'Lakhayak' (pointer or 
indicator) of the Dhun or Dhwanyatmak Shabd of which it 
is the Varna form. 

The Varnatmak of the Dhwanyatmak (i.e., the Varna 
form of the Dhwanyatmak Nam), although it comes to be 
written or uttered by tongue, should not be confused with 
mere Varnatmak or Vaikhari names, that is, mere conventional 
names which are also written and uttered, but have no 
connection whatsoever with the nature of the things, objects 
and personages denoted by them, or are merely descriptive 
of certain attributes of the objects or personages signified 
by them. One is Lakhayak (pointer or indicator of the 
Dhun or the Dhwanyatmak Shabds of regions above the 
eyes; the other emanates from Nabhi Chakra (centre at 
navel), passes through heart and throat centres (ganglia 
at heart and throat) and comes out of the mouth for 
carrying on the day-to-day business of life, and has no 
connection with the Dhun at all. The former is called the 
Varnatmak of the Dhwanyatmak or the Varna form of the 
Dhwanyatmak or only Dhwanyatmak; the latter is a pure 
and simple Varnatmak name. The former, if repeated or 
recited in the prescribed manner, can establish a spiritual 
rapport between the devotee and the self-resounding Dhun, 
of which it is the LAKHAYAK.] 

If one comes in contact with a Guru, who is an adept 
in the secrets of Nam or Dhun (Shabd), one's 
Surat, by the help of Dhun, can unite with the 



220 ] Shabd or Nam [ Bachan 

Dhuni (the Being or the Purush), from whom that 
Dhun is emanating. (6) 

If one finds Soami, He will show that Nam (or Word) 
and Narmi (the Purush, whose Nam it is) are one 
and the same. (7) 

One starts with the Sumiran of the Varnatmak or the 
Varna form of a Dhwanyatmak Name. In the end, 
one meets the Dhwanyatmak Narmi (the Being or 
Purush). (8) 

Cleanse your Surat (spirit) and mind with Varna (Varna 
form of the Dhwanyatmak Nam). Then, ascend to 
Gagan, and catch Dhun (Shabd) (9) 

Dhun (Shabd) and Dhuni (The Purush or Being) are 
one and the same. Perceive Shabd by your 
Surat. (10) 

When Shabd and Surat become one, you will per- 
ceive Dhwanyatmak Name. (11) 

But how can one attain this state without Guru and the 
performance of practices taught by Him. (12) 

He, who has love and yearning, is fortunate; he is a 

gurumukh. (13) 

I have described Nam (Name) and Narmi (the Deity 
whose Name it is) and explained the secrets of 
perceiving thear^Abhed (indistinguishable). (14) 

Everything depends upon the Mauj of Guru. He can 
transform anybody He likes, into a gurumukh 
(devout disciple and devotee). (15) 

A Gurumukh offers his body and riches to Guru, he loves 
Him with his fra *RNij Mana (higher mind.) (16) 



10] Shabd or Nam [221 

He then applies himself to Dhun (Shabd), and then 
gets rid of the three Gunas, i.e., he gets beyond 
the sphere of the three Gunas. (17) 

I have described the distinction between 'Varna' and 
'Dhun'. They are also called Vach (gross, phenom- 
enal, visible, manifest) and Laksh (subtle, nourme- 
nal, invisible, unmanifest, formless, incorporeal). (18) 

Vach is Varnatmak, and Laksh is Dhun which is one 
with the Dhuni. (19) 

Bhekhs (ascetics) and, in fact, the whole world are 
entangled in the Varna (Varnatmak form of a Name). 
Only a Sant knows the secrets of Dhun (Dhwan- 
yatrmak Name). (20) 

Bhekhs dissipate themselves in repeating Varna 
(Varnatmak form). They get nothing at all. (21) 

Since they are not initiated in the secrets of Dhun or 
Shabd, they cannot gain the fruit or bliss of the 
Dhwanyatmak Name. (22) 

Though they may utter Nam thousands and lacs of times 
a day, their inner eye shall never be opened. (23) 

Darkness of ignorance will not be removed. They will be 
led astray byift?"Moh 1 ,TRMad 2 and^WKam 3 . (24) 

1. Fatuity, infatuation; fascination, allurement; affection, love. Dark- 
ness or delusion of mind preventing the discernment of truth, lead- 
ing men to believe in the reality of worldly objects, and to addict 
themselves to mundane or sensual enjoyment. 2. Ardent passion, 
desire; lust; sensual enjoyment; pride, arrogance. Intoxication, 
inebriety, drunkenness; madness, insanity, frenzy. 3. Inclination, 
wish, desire, longing, inordinate desire; sexual passion; lust; love 
of pleasure; the object of love or desire. 



222 ] Shabd or Nam [ Bachan 

The reason is that they could not understand and 
grasp the significance of Dhun and Dhuni (the 
Deity from whom emanates the Dhun or Shabd) 
nor did they take to Surat Shabd Yoga. (25) 

They did not meet a Guru who knows the secrets of 
Dhun and who may enable them to perceive Dhun 
(Shabd, sound) and to get rid of ailments and 
maladies. (26) 

Kal has destroyed their intelligence. They have wasted 
their human life. (27) 

Out of compassion, Sants address these Jivas, but 

they do not listen. (28) 

Sants give out the secrets of the five Dhuns (Shabds) 
and teach Surat Shabd Yoga. (29) 

Sants give out the details of Dhuns and their forms 

and regions. (30) 

Sants teach the practice of Surat Shabd Yoga. But 

Jivas do not listen to what Sants say. (31) 

Sants raise the Surat of Jiva to Gagan and make 

Shabd audible to him within himself. (32) 

When the Surat reaches Brahmand, it begins to perceive 
Shabd. While in Sahas-dal-kanwal, it has some 
inkling of Shabd. (33) 

The Surat ascends to Banknal, rushes to Trikuti and 

gets access to Sunn or Daswan Dwar. (34) 

The Surat is delighted to see the spectacle of Maha-sunn 
and it then hears the Shabd of Bhanwargupha. (35) 



10 ] Shabd or Nam [ 223 

The spirit entity then reaches Sat Lok, which is Amar 
Pad (everlasting region) and Mool (origin or source) 
of the creation offePind, ^And and3§n^Brahmand. 
It hears the sound of the Bin (harp). (36) 

The spirit entity then beholds Alakh and Agam also, 
and ultimately meets the ^ ^TRMoo/ Nam (the 
Origin and Source of all Names). (37) 

I now give out openly that RADHASOAMI is that ^ 
^rm Mool Nam. You should grasp the significance 
of this revelation. (38) 

& & & 

Shabd 2 

^ VR vRMI ^ ^T*T W I 
■^)TR T^T s&?T ^J3 3?W It *J II 

I experienced the bliss of Nam, in the company of 
Guru. I gave up pleasures of the world, realizing 
that these are transitory and unreal. (1) 

Having curbed my mind, I got dyed in the colour of 
Nam. I burnt ^rteKrodh (anger) and adoptedfw 
Chhirma (patience and forgiveness). (2) 

Today I obtained the treasure of Nam. I cast off Lobh 
(avarice, greed) realizing that it is^PTFcf Kangal 
(poor). (3) 

When I ascended to Akash (sky), I attained Nam; I 
saw light and the darkness of Moh (attachment, 
infatuation) was gone. (4) 



224] Shabd or Nam [ Bachan 

In Trikuti, I was delighted to receive the wealth of 
Nam. I abandoned Ahankar (pride, egotism) and 
became happy. (5) 

I heard the Dhun of Nam in Sunn or Daswan Dwar. 
Beyond Maha-sunn, I attained Nam Pad. (6) 

In Bhanwargupha, my Surat heard the Shabd of Sohang 
and the melody of =rartBansri (flute), and received 
sustenance from them. (7) 

In the company of Nam, I reached the fourth pad, 

and then went to Alakh Lok. (8) 

Adorning myself with Nam. I arrived at Agam Lok, 
and then, met the Most Excellent, Eminent and 
Illustrious Name RADHASOAMI. (9) 

Making a bonfire of the world, attend Satsang. Your 
"src Ghat or inner self will be illumined. (10) 

■*TFT Man andfT^Mad (pride and arrogance) will both 
be vanquished. In "^"H T^ Nam Pad, your Surat 
will put on a garland of Nam round its neck. (11) 

Sants give out these teachings. But the Bhekhs do 

not accept them. They are foolish. (12) 

Pandits (the learned) and Yogis (Yoga practitioners) 
remained on this end. They could not cross over 
to the other side. Gyanis (sophists) remained lost 
in their sophistry. (13) 

Only some rare Sants have access to the inaccessible 
regions. They have penetrated the barrier at the 
third Til. (14) 



10 ] Shabd or Nam [225 

Sants describe the stages of Nam as they see with their 
eyes. There is no confusion and ambiguity. (15) 

They have lifted the curtain, and revealed Nam. I 

explain this to you out of love. (16) 

Seek the extremely munificent Sat Guru. You will get 
redemption. (17) 

You will then be initiated in the Most Supreme Nam. 
Withdraw your spirituality and proceed upwards. (18) 

Like a fish, ascend upwards, against the current. Like 
a spider, hold fast to the thread, and return along 
it. (19) 

Kal feels tired and exhausted and Maya feels ashamed 
because I do not pay attention to them. (20) 

My Surat has now attained her Nij Gharbar (the 
Original Home) and met the Supreme Being, 
Radhasoami. (21) 



BACHAN 11 



IMPORTANCE OF SATSANG AND 

REVELATION OF SATNAM 

(TRUE NAME) 



Shabd 1 

How far should I go on depicting the crookedness of 
Mana (Mind)? It pays no heed to the words of 
Guru. (1) 

Love has disappeared, and devotion is eclipsed. Instead, 
the reservoir of enmity and jealousy has opened. (2) 

Maya has employed her trickeries and fraud. Kal has 
spread the cover of darkness, ignorance and impunity. 
The result is, Satsang appeals to me on mere 
intellectual and theoretical grounds; forbearance 
and reliance on the Mauj of Guru have completely 
vanished. (3-4) 

It is difficult to describe the state of affairs. The effect 
of Kali Yuga is manifest. (5) 



Bachan 11 ] Importance of Satsang [ 227 

Satsangis are brothers and sisters, being disciples 
of the same Guru. But quarrels and disputes occur 
daily among them. (6) 

Kal thus plays his trickeries and fraud, and gets entrance 
into Satsang. (7) 

When Kal fails in his attempt otherwise, he manages 
to find his way into Sewa (service) in Satsarq. (8) 

Kal gets hold of everybody's mind by employing his 
trickeries in Sewa. 19) 

Kal has so misguided Satsangis that when Guru 
admonishes them, they feel peeved at heart. (10) 

They pay no attention to the admonitions of Guru. 
Again and again, they follow the dictates of their 
mind. (11) 

They find fault with Guru. Thus Kal succeeds in taking 
them to Chaurasi again and again. (12) 

They attended Satsang for a long time, but no benefit 
has accrued to them. (13) 

I now pray to Sat Guru, to subdue Kal and correct 

my mind. (14) 

Kal is not stronger than You. Be pleased to cut off 

the noose of Jama. (15) 

May Satsangis develop strong love for Your Gracious 
Feet and may their minds become pure and clean. (16) 

Banish enmity and malice from their hearts so that 

they may enjoy bliss together. (17) 



228 ] Importance of Satsang [ Bachan 

May Satsangis live together in harmony and always 

love one another. (18) 

This is now the ordainment for all. Those, who do 
not follow this, are under the sway of Kal. (19) 

Those who obey My order, shall be admitted to the 

Darbarof Sat Guru. (20) 

Always pay heed to this advice of Guru and correct 

your understanding. (21) 

Those who are under the sway of Kal, will not accept 
my advice. (22) 

Now have no anxiety or worry. Utter True Name every 
moment. (23) 

Consider yourself to be most abject and insignificant. (24) 

Why do you take airs? Are you not aware that death 

is hovering overhead all the time? (25) 

Have you not seen how a destitute beggar behaves 
in a meek and humble way in this world? (26) 

Anyone may say harsh words to him, but he does 

not take ill at all. (27) 

What have you achieved by attending Satsang for 
such a long time when your mind has not become 
humble and meek like that? (28) 

It now behoves you to cultivate humility. (29) 

Beseech humbly, fall at the feet of, and maintain cordial 
relations with brother Satsangis. (30) 



11 ] Importance of Satsang [ 229 

If a Satsangi is displeased with another, he should 
persuade him, implore him with folded hands and 
fall at his feet. (31-32) 

And if that Satsangi is still not willing to be reconciled, 
he is a sinner against Sat Guru. (33) 

How can the malady of one who is consumed with 

jealousy and rancour be cured? (34) 

The only remedy is that either he exercises his faculty 
of discrimination and brings his mind round, or 
Sat Guru showers His Daya (grace and mercy) 
on him. (35) 

Without Sat Guru's Daya nothing can be achieved, 
and without discrimination bad habits cannot be 
changed. (36) 

If Sat Guru is pleased to take pity on him and showers 
special Daya (grace and mercy), his ^TRcT Dur- 
mat (evil and malice) will be driven away. (37) 

How can the malady of a person who is humble outwardly, 
but harbours malice within, be cured? (38) 

Now such a person should try to discard insincerity 

and hypocrisy and cultivate virtue. (39) 

If he finds himself unable to accomplish this, he should 
pray to Sat Guru for help. (40) 

He should frankly confess his insincerity and 

hypocrisy. He should engender love and faith in 
Satguru and lay bare his faults and shortcomings 
before Him. (41) 



230 ] Importance of Satsang [ Bachan 

He should disclose his sins and blemishes to Sat 

Guru, and, again and again, beseech Him to forgive 
him. (42) 

O Soami! Cleanse me of my falsehood and guile. I 

am powerless. Redeem me. (43) 

It is only if You are extremely gracious that my hypocrisy 
and insincerity will be removed. (44) 

There is no other remedy. Without Daya, nothing can 
be of any avail. (45) 

Hypocritical mind is within everyone. It holds all in 

its grip. (46) 

Jiva attends Satsang, though, internally, he cherishes 
love and regard for the world. However, by the grace 
of Guru, this hypocrisy will be removed. (47) 

He who does not lay bare his faults and shortcomings 
before Guru, and claims himself to be sincere, is 
doubly sinful. He can never be mended. (48-49) 

He is not fit for Satsang. He is suffering from an 

incurable malady. (50) 

But if he comes in contact with the omnipotent Sat 
Guru, bows his head at His Holy Feet and 
attaches himself to Satsang, he will gradually be 
relieved. (51-52) 

If one gets the benefit of Satsang, all his impurities 

will be washed away. (53) 

How should I sing the praises of Satsang! No other 

method is so efficacious. (54) 



11 ] Importance of Satsang [ 231 

Sants say that, in Kali Yuga, there is no means of 

salvation except Satsang. (55) 

Other religious deeds, penances, worship and charity, 
only strengthen ego. (56) 

Further, if these activities are not performed correctly, 
the result is the reverse of what is expected of 
them. (57) 

For this reason, Sants have declared that Satsang 

is superior to all other practices. (58) 

Now I tell you what Satsang is. Satsang is where 
praises of Sat Nam — Sat Purush are sung. (59) 

The fourth Pad (Sphere, Region) is known as Sach 

Khand. It is beyond Maha-sunn. (60) 

Only Sants have spoken of Maha-sunn. (None else 
knew about it). Maha-sunn is beyond Akshar. (61) 

That Akshar is the origin of the Vedas. The Vedas 

could not know what exactly Akshar is. (62) 

They said that whatever they knew, was not Akshar. 
That is why they have called it Neti, Neti, i.e., not 
this, not this. When the Vedas had no know- 
ledge of Akshar, how could they know what is 
beyond it? (63) 

The Vedas and all other revealed books stopped on 
the way. They remained here below Akshar and 
Sunn. (64) 

None knew what is beyond Akshar. Sants alone have 
disclosed it. (65) 



232 ] Importance of Satsang [ Bachan 

Yogeshwars and Vedantis reached only up to the Laksh 
Swamp of Akshar. (66) 

Satnam-Satlok, about which Sants have spoken, is 
beyond all these. It is not correct to say, based only on 
intellect, that all are one and the same. (67-68) 

Sants have declared unequivocally that Vedant Mat 
is a snare of Kal. (69) 

Sants have termed Vedant Mat as Kal Mat (religion 
of Kal). Sat Nam — Sat Purush is far away from 
Vedant Mat (or Kal Mat). (70) 

All the prevalent religions of the world are Kal Mat 
(religions of Kal). The religion of Sat Nam — Sat 
Purush is Dayal Mat (religion of Dayal, Merciful 
Lord). (71) 

I now tell you about Sat Nam. I will reveal all its 

secrets in detail. (72) 

are And and ^"?rre Brahmand were not created then, 
nor did three Loks (worlds) and nine Khands 
(continents) exist. (73) 

Brahm, Atma, Par-Brahm and Parmatrma did not exist, 
then. (74) 

Nor did then exist gods, goddesses, %X Surs 
(angels), ^R Nars (human beings) and tjPt Munis 
(divine beings). There was none to be worshipped 
or served. (75) 

Kal and Maha-Kal and Sunn and Maha-Sunn had not 
come into existence. (76) 



11] Importance of Satsang [233 

There was neither earth nor sky, neither the Vedas 
nor the Purans. None knew Vedant and its Siddhant 
(goal). (77) 

How far should I emphasize that no creation had been 
brought into existence at all. (78) 

Only the Anarm (Nameless), Armaya (sans Maya), Himself 
was there, immersed in His own rapturous bliss 
and love. (79) 

There issued forth His Mauj (current of overflowing 
Love) accompanied by a great Dhun or Sound, 
which announced Sat Nam (True Name) and Sat 
Shabd (True Shabd). (80) 

Sach Khand was brought into being by this great 

Dhun (Shabd). The boundary of this Mandal (sphere) 
extended up to the farthest limit of the reverberations 
of this Dhun (Shabd or Sound). (81) 

Hansas and their dwellings known as Dweeps 

(islands) were created, and also the sixteen sons 
(emanations). (82) 

In this way was Sat Lok created. Upto here, i.e., up to 
Sat Lok — Sat Nam, He Himself is present. (83) 

This state continued for innumerable Yugas. All were 
enraptured in the bliss of Sat Nam. (84) 

The creation up to Sat Lok — Sat Nam is Satya (True), 
i.e., permanent and everlasting. Then the lower 
creation was brought into being. (85) 

One current emanated from there. Another current 

mingled with it. (86) 



234] Importance of Satsang [ Bachan 

These two currents took their location at Sunn and 
created the region of Purush and Prakriti. (87) 

Sants have termed them as Jyoti and Niranjan. They 
are the same as Maya and Brahm. (88) 

They are also called by the names of Shiva and Shakti. 
This state continued for a period of innumerable 
Yugas. (89) 

These two currents brought forth Brahm Shrishti (creation 
of Brahm or Brahmand). Even this fact is not known 
to anybody. (90) 

Then Brahm kept himself aloof from there, and busied 
himself in the Dhyan (contemplation) of Sat Nam 
(or Sat Purush). (91) 

The work of creation was then embarked upon by 

Maya. She created three sons, viz., Vishnu, Brahma 
and Mahadev. (92) 

These three sons of Maya (i.e., the three gods) brought 
into existence Tt ^jf^ Nar-Shrishthi (the creation 
of human beings). They created Vedas, which laid 
down ceremonies, rituals, rites, etc. (93) 

And all engaged themselves in these activities. Thus 
^T Surs (angels), HTNars (human beings) and 
tjPt Munis (divine beings) all became subservient 
to Kal. (94) 

Gyanis and Yogis have wasted their lives in Gyan 
and Yoga. But they could not be free from entangle- 
ments and misapprehensions. (95) 



11 ] Importance of Satsang [ 235 

They did not know the secrets of Sat Purush. They 
tied themselves to the Ved Mat (religion of the 
Vedas). (96) 

Sant Mat (religion of Sants) is far above them. How 
can they know about Sant Mat, which is the Origin 
and Source of all? (97) 

Therefore you should keep the company of Sants and 
give up that of others. (98) 

The company of Sants is called Satsang. If you come 
in contact with a Sant, you can get back to Nij 
Ghar. (99) 

Now I disclose the Dhun of Sat Nam (Sat Lok). There, 
the Bin (harp) and the Bansri (flute) resound. (100) 

in the city of Kal, you will hear music at all times. 

This music comes from the left side. (101) 

The Dhun or Shabd of Sants is distinct arid separate 
from it. He who goes to the fourth Pad (sphere, 
region), will find it. (102) 

I have described the difference between Kal Shabd 
and the Shabd of Sants, and thus I have explained 
what Sant Mat or religion of Sants is. (103) 

I have left nothing unsaid. He, whose inner eye is 

opened, can perceive the reality. (104) 

Only a selected few can find out the real thing, by 
the grace of Sants. Without Sants, nothing can 
be gained. (105) 

Sants have given out the essence. But the ignorant 



236] Importance of Satsang [ Bachan 11 

do not accept it. Without love and faith in Sants, 
how can they get to Nij Ghar? (106) 

Therefore, it is enjoined upon you to cultivate love for 
Sants, and devote yourself earnestly and firmly to 
them. Leaving aside all rituals, observances and 
delusions, merge your Surat in Shabd. (107) 

By reciting Radhasoami Nam 

Let thy life most fruitful be; 

This is the true and real Nam, 

Keep it innermost within thee. (108) 

When you join the Satsang of Soami, you will be initiated 
in the secrets of Nam (Name or Word). (109) 



BACHAN 12 

IMPORTANCE OF BHAKTI 
(DEVOTION) 



Shabd 1 

srfaft wrcra ^t 3t *nf i 
^r w& % f^ir otyM ti s it 

My brother! Listen to the importance of Bhakti (devotion). 
All Sants have testified to it. (1) 

The path of Bhakti alone is Guru Mat (Sant Mat). All other 
religions and paths are false and guileful. (2) 

Without Bhakti, they are all hollow and sham, covers 
without the kernel. (3) 

Therefore, hold fast to Bhakti and give up shrewdness 
altogether. (4) 

Devotion, affection and love are three different words, 
but they denote one and the same thing. (5) 

Bhakti and Bhao (devotion and love) constitute ^^ra 
Guru-Mat. All else are ^T-Hcr Man-Mat. (6) 



238] Importance of Devotion [ Bachan 

[Religions in which *n Mana or mind is an active partner, 
are Man-mat. While that in which spirit is the active 
participant, is^"? TtT Guru Mat or ^TcT "Tel Sant Mat. 

In Guru, the Current of Shabd or Spirituality is flowing 
from above unobstructed, from the Feet of the Supreme 
Father Himself, and consequently, His company is the 
easiest and most practicable way for the Jivas to contact 
this current and to achieve Uddhar (salvation). Therefore, 
Sant Mat is called Guru Mat.] 

The essence of Atma and Parmatma is Prem (love). 
Sat Nam (True Name) is the embodiment of Bhakti 
(devotion). (7) 

Bhakti *rf^r (devotion) andw^Bhagwant (the Supreme 
Being) are one. Sat Guru is the embodiment of 
Prem (love). (8) 

You are also Prem (love) in essence, so are all Jivas. (9) 

But there is one difference. Somewhere it is a drop, 
elsewhere, a wave. (10) 

At one place, it is ocean of Prem (Love) and at 

another, it is the source and fountain head of Prem 
(love). (11) 

At one place, it is T^TIchcha (desire) which is pre- 
dominant, and at another, it is ^rqiMaya which 
is powerful. (12) 

At one place there was a little of Maya, and that too 
was purified because of its association with the 
ocean of spirituality. (13) 

In the Source, there is no Maya. There, it is all Prem 
(love) (14) 



12 ] Importance of Devotion [ 239 

He is an immense Reservoir of Prem, having no begin- 
ning and no end. (15) 

Only Sants have access there and none else. It is 

the Abode of Sant Sat Guru. (16) 

Such is the greatness of the path of Prem and Bhakti 
(love and devotion) that if you adopt it, it will take 
you to the reservoir of Amrit (ambrosia) (17) 

First of all you should perform Bhakti of Guru. Then 

will you attain Nam. (18) 

Sing the Arti of Guru, so that He may be pleased with you. 
He will grant you the treasure of Prem. (19) 

Radhasoami proclaims that then you will be a recipient 
of ^rfafl^H Bhakti Dan (gift of devotion). (20) 



Shabd 2 

Give up the fear and regard for the world. Heed what 
I say, perform Bhakti. (1) 

Banish fear and regard for caste and colour. Heed 

what I say, perform Bhakti. (2) 

Fear not friend or foe. Heed what I say, perform 

Bhakti. (3) 

Forsake fear of your parents. Heed what I say, perform 
Bhakti. (4) 



240] Importance of Devotion [ Bachan 

Do not be afraid of your wife and children. Heed 

what I say, perform Bhakti. (5) 

Do not be afraid of your brothers and nephews. Heed 
what I say, perform Bhakti. (6) 

Have no fear of your mother-in-law and father-in-law. 
Heed what I say, perform Bhakti. (7) 

Fear not your daughter-in-law and son-in-law. Heed 
what I say, perform Bhakti. (8) 

Cast off fear of your friends and acquaintances. Heed 
what I say, perform Bhakti. (9) 

Have no fear of kith and kin. Engage in Bhakti. (10) 

When you have resolved to apply yourself to Bhakti, have 
no fear of them. You should perform Bhakti. (11) 

Should you fear the ignorant and foolish who are un- 
aware of the secrets? Perform Bhakti. (12) 

Let your mind be free from fear of all these people. 

Listen to me, my dear, perform Bhakti. (13) 

An anchorite of one sect feels bashful on seeking 
one of another sect. Such people are imperfect. 
They should perform Bhakti. (14) 

So long as you are not free from fear of all, you are 

imperfect. So, perform Bhakti. (15) 

Honour or dishonour whatever befalls you, consider such 
to be the Mauj, and keep on performing Bhakti. (16) 

Derive strength from Guru, to face all sorts of situations. 
I tell you, my dear, perform Bhakti. (17) 



1-2 ] Importance of Devotion [ 241 

Nobody can cause you any harm. Why do you fear? 
Perform Bhakti. (18) 

Nothing happens without the Mauj (ordainment) of 
Guru. I tell you my dear, perform Bhakti. (19) 

You are imperfect in your Bhakti. That is why you 

falter. What more should I tell you? Go on performing 
Bhakti. (20) 

Slowly and gradually you will gain stability. There is 

no other remedy but to perform Bhakti. (21) 

One day your imperfect Bhakti will become perfect. 
Give up hypocrisy and engage in Bhakti. (22) 

Insincere Bhakti will not do. Perform true and sincere 
Bhakti, no matter if it is imperfect. (23) 

Radhasoami graciously declares that you should perform 
Bhakti in whatever manner you can. (24) 



Shabd 3 

STtTIT TTrT IsTRT «PT 3*R II S II 

My dear! Do not be deceived on coming into this world. 
I caution you, do not be deceived here. (1) 

Consider none to be your friend. All are Thugs, out 

to strangle you. (2) 

When you proceed earnestly on the path of Guru, they 
feel alarmed and come forward to stop you. (3) 



242] Importance of Devotion [ Bachan 12 

They make all sorts of caustic remarks to create confusion 
and misapprehension in your mind. (4) 

Beware of them. They are your enemies, though they 
pose to be your well-wishers. (5) 

Your good or harm is none of their concern; they 

only cling to their own selfish ends. (6) 

You, too, are sagacious and dear to Guru. Mingle 
with them but keep your attention steadfast in the 
Holy Feet of Guru. (7) 

They, too, would be benefited in this way. And at the same 
time, your Bhakti would suffer no set-back. (8) 

Those who are averse to Guru-Bhakti and Nam and 
remain intractable, should be discarded with tact 
and humility. There is no sin in it. (9-10) 

But cultivate friendship with those rare ones who are 
well disposed towards Guru-Bhakti and Nam. (11) 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you that you should engage 
in Bhakti again and again. (12) 

Take all possible care that Bhakti receives no setback 
or any account, otherwise, you shall have to repent 
a lot. (13) 



BACHAN 13 

CHARACTERISTICS OF A PERFECT 
GURU AND TRUE PARMARTHI 



Shabd 1 

?T«5 f^IT ^]RT "=rft "^f II 1 II 

He alone is Guru who is attached to Shabd (spiritual 
sound). He adores none but Shabd. (1) 

The perfect Guru is He who is absorbed in Shabd. 

Make yourself the dust of His feet. (2) 

Do not apply other tests. Do not see His merits and 

demerits. (3) 

Learn the secrets of Shabd from Him and perform the 
practice of Shabd with your heart and soul. (4) 

SAR UPDESH 
(TRUE TEACHINGS) 
Test of a Parmarthi 

Listen with attention to what I say in detail. These 



244 ] Characteristics of a True Parmarthi [ Bachan 

teachings are for those Jivas who are imbued 

with love for the Supreme Father. (5) 

A parmarthi is he who, being fed up with sensual 

pleasures, longs for Parmarth. (6) 

He has no affection for wealth and progeny. He does 
not hanker aftep worldly objects. (7) 

He is not a slave of his body and senses. He has 

lost sleep, hunger and lethargy. (8) 

With his heart pierced by the arrow of the pangs of 
separation, he roams about in search of a true 
Sadh and Guru. (9) 

Whenever he meets a Sadh or Faqir, he serves him 

and endeavours to please him. (10) 

Even if he comes across a hypocrite or an imposter, 
he serves him as if he were a true Sadhu. (11) 

He has respect and regard for recluse and ascetics. 
He washes their feet and partakes of their 
Parshad. (12) 

Sat Guru Himself would come to meet such a Parmarthi. (13) 

When he hears the discourses of Sat Guru, love and 
devotion swell in his heart. (14) 

When he enhances his love for Sat Guru, he receives 
His grace and mercy. (15) 

MODE OF DARSHAN 

He should daily have^RDarshan and 'qWT Parsan 
(seeing and touching) of Sant Sat Guru and should 
enshrine His most attractive form in his heart. (16) 



13 ] Importance of Bhakti [ 245 

He should drink His ^T^T^^Charnamrit and eat His 
wrc Prashad. He should banish egotism from his 
mind and apply himself whole-heartedly to these 
activities. (17) 

MODE OF SEWA 

The devotee should serve Sat Guru with body, mind 
and riches, and consider Him as Sat Purush. (18) 

SEWA BY BODY 

He should daily perform Arti and cast off ^tr Kam 
(passion), "gfcrKrodh (anger) and^Mad (arrogance) 
from his mind. (19) 

He should massage the legs and feet of his Guru, 
fan Him, grind flour for His bread and fetch water 
from the well for Him. (20) 

He should clean the gutter, sweep the house and 
should bring earth for the use of his Guru, by 
digging it from a pit. (21) 

He should attend on his Guru while He is washing 
His hands and brushing His teeth with a twig, 
which he has cut from a tree. (22) 

He should rub the body of his Guru with ^CTUbtan 
(a paste composed of one or other kind of meal, 
turmeric, oil and perfume) for cleaning the skin, 
and assist Him in bathing. He should offer a towel 
to his Guru for wiping His body and assist Him 
in wearing Dhoti 1 . (23) 

1. Dhoti = A cloth worn round the waist, passing between the legs 
and tucked in behind. 



246 ] Sewa by Riches [ Bachan 

He should wash His Dhoti and towel and draw comb 
through His hair to remove knots. (24) 

He should help Him put on cloths and apply Tilak 1 
on the forehead. He should prepare food and place 
it before Him. (25) 

He should help Him wash His mouth, and should prepare 
\w&] Huqqa (hubble bubble), make bed for Him 
and then offer prayer to Him. (26) 

He should receive the spittle in a spittoon, and drink 
it all. (27) 

He should perform all kinds of services, high or low, 

as occasion demands. (28) 

He should not hesitate to perform any Sewa, he should 
do whatever Guru orders. (29) 

SEWA BY RICHES 

Sewa performed by money consists in utilising it in 

the service of Guru. (30) 

Guru is not hungry for your money. He has the wealth 
of Bhaktiof Nam. (31) 

But He confers spiritual good on you, by making you give 
away your wealth to the hungry and thirsty. (32) 

You get His grace for nothing, if you please Him. (33) 

His pleasure is a great boon. It amounts to the special 
grace of the Supreme Creator Himself. (34) 

1. Tilak = Mark or marks made with coloured eye earths, sandal 
wood, or unguents upon the forehead and between the eye brows. 



13 ] Sewa by mind and intellect [ 247 

SEWA BY MIND AND INTELLECT 

The devotee should have Darshan and then listen to 
the discourses. He should ruminate over them 
every day. (35) 

He should pick out the essence, and then digest it 

as mental and spiritual food. (36) 

Thus nourished, he will grow strong. He will not care 
for worldly fear and shame any more. (37) 

Know that Guru Bhakti is love for Guru. First it is at 
the mental level but when Surat is imbued with it, 
it ripens and becomes mature. (38) 

This love goes on taking deeper roots in the inner 

recesses of the devotee. Ultimately, he loses himself 
completely in the love of Guru. (39) 

The form of the Guru would be as dear to the devotees 
as the husband is to a loving wife and the running 
stream of water to a fish. (40) 

This is how a devotee should attend Satsang and 
associate himself with Sat Guru. Then will he reap 
the real benefit of Satsang. (41) 

Being pleased with the devotee, Sat Guru bestows on 
him the gift of Nam. The devotee should, with all 
humility, enshrine Guru's Nam in his heart. He will 
then realize the true efficacy of Nam. (42) 

SEWA BY SURAT AND NIRAT, 
I.E., INTERNAL ABHYAS (PRACTICE) 

The devotee should sit in a secluded place, turn his 
senses inward and perform Abhyas. He will attain 
peace of mind. (43) 



248] Sewa by Surat and Nirat [ Bachan 

He should withdraw the two petals (the currents flowing 
to the two eyes from the focus), and advance to 
Gagan. He will hear Shabd and feel delighted. (44) 

He will behold Jyoti flame (in Sahas-dal-kanwal), the 
Sun (in Trikuti), and the Moon (in Sunn). (45) 

He will reach Sat Lok and settle there. On hearing 
the incessant resounding of Shabd, his Surat will 
smile in ecstasy and bliss. (46) 

He would then realize the glory and greatness of Sat 
Guru, by whose grace, he heard the Dhun of the 
Bin (harp). (47) 

He meets Alakh, Agam and Anami. He now sings 

the glory of Radhasoami. (48) 



Shabd 2 

W: 3TPT "tf'TT^ T&Mt I 
iftf tfHH *$? *HT* H 1 II 

He who sets fire to his earthly home, merges in the 

cool sea. (1) 

He loosens the knot that ties the spirit to inert matter. 
He merges the drop in the sea. (2) 

He waters the garden of Surat Shabd and enjoys 

flowers and fruits. (3) 

He opens the lock to Gagan Mandal (Trikuti) and 
gets Wet Lai and ^tisOawahar (rubies and gems), 
i.e., the sounds of that region. (4) 



13 ] A True Parmarthi [ 249 

He peeps into the mansion of Sunn Shikhar and beholds 
marvellous spectacles. (5) 

He bathes in the pure stream of the Mansarovar lake. (6) 

He enjoys "delicious fruit in the company of Hansas. 
He expresses utter aversion for this world. (7) 

He pierces the barrier of Maha-sunn and proceeds 

to Bhanwargupha. (8) 

He reaches Satnarm Pad (Sat-Lok) and rapidly advances 
to Alakh and Agam. (9) 

He meets Sat Guru Radhasoami, and thus returns to 
his true home. (10) 



Shabd 3 

•?£5T W$ TfT It <\ II 

The relationship between Guru and Chela, as is prevailing 
in the world, is all hypocritical. (1) 

To whom should I speak? Nobody is sincerely 
engaged in search. All are drifting in the current 
of deception. (2) 

The Guru hankers after money, name and fame. The 
Chela, for his selfish ends, has got himself tied 
to the so-called Guru. (3) 

The true path of Surat Shabd remains concealed. (4) 



250 ] Characteristics of [ Bachan 

Both Guru and Chela are imposters and hypocrites. 

Both will go to Chaurasi. (5) 

If one comes in contact with a Guru who is an embodiment 
of Shabd and an adept in the practice of Surat 
Shabd Yoga, one can get across. (6) 

A true Chela (disciple, pupil) is he who is *pr^t Suratvant 
(i.e., whose Surat or spiritual force is emerging) 
and a true lover of Supreme Father. (7) 

Such Guru and Chela are rare indeed. 

By Mauj alone can they meet. (8) 

If a Guru is not conversant with the secrets of Surat 
Shabd, renounce him forthwith. It will be a good 
riddance. (9) 

Radhasoami says that if you understand these discourses, 
your task can be accomplished. (10) 



Shabd 4 

TiTTTfT If -^rN TtTT ^ II 1 II 

My dear, seek Sat Guru. He is a rare jewel in the 

world. (1) 

With whomsoever He is pleased, He would grant him 
His Darshan. (2) 

By having His Darshan, one gets to Sat Lok, true 

region of Sat Nam. (3) 



13 ] A Perfect Guru [ 251 

True and real Nam is obtained from Sat Guru alone. 

Without Him, all Jivas drift downstream. (4) 

Jivas are roaming in the cycle of births and deaths. 
They eat, drink and make merry, developing pride 
and egotism. (5) 

The malady of arrogance and pride is spreading far 
and wide. Those who consider themselves big, 
shall suffer. (6) 

He who is humble and meek at heart, will get his 

Surat merged in Shabd. (7) 

Without Shabd, the whole world is groping in the 
dark. Without the Saran of Sat Guru, all are in 
delusion. (8) 

Those who learn the secrets of Shabd and practise 
Surat Shabd Yoga, would get the Essence. (9) 

Sat Guru is He who is absorbed in Shabd. This is 

the true test of Sat Guru. (10) 

Open your eyes and you will find Him near at hand. 
What more should I say? I have disclosed enough. 
Now it all depends upon your luck (fitness) my 
dear. If you do not recognise Him, the cycle of 
Chaurasi awaits you there. (11-12) 

What Radhasoami wanted to say He has said and 

has said it well. (13) 



BACHAN 14 

CHITAONI (ADMONITION) 
Parti 

Shabd 1 

tp? $ -m ^FT *TTt * II 9 II 

Surat separated from Dhun (Shabd), and became attached 
to the mind by befriending it. (1) 

Entangled in the snares of the world, she engaged 
in fruitless pursuits. Destitute and homeless, she 
roams. (2) 

She pays no heed to the teachings of Guru. She 
indulges in the pleasures of the senses, which 
are full of venom and evil. (3) 

In vain, she is taking up a burden. She will have to 
undergo punishment at the hands of Kal. (4) 

She is undergoing great pain and misery. Sat Guru 

now addresses her thus. (5) 

My dear, listen to what I say. Turn within yourself and 
behold light. (6) 



Bachan 14] Admonition (Parti) [253 

Enjoy the great bliss of Shabd. Ascend and open 

the shutters of Gagan (Trikuti). (7) 

There is no refuge except Guru. Radhasoami alone 

can accomplish your task. (8) 



Shabd 2 

^ <£effo *rr?f $ arrf ti tgj it 

"3PTtT -*rm ^ TR TtJ TRsFT t 

wjt ^r "ft *r t m f ti i n 

O Surat! Who are you and whence have you come? 
This world is a net spread by the mind. Why do 
you get entangled in it? (1) 

You are a ray from the Purush (Supreme Being) and 
an inhabitant of the purely spiritual region. Kal 
has put a noose round your neck. (2) 

Turn back and go to your Home, by the grace of Sat 
Guru and in the company of Sadhs (those who 
are engaged in Parmath). (3) 

Listen to Anhad Shabd within, says Radhasoami. (4) 



Shabd 3 

3%frm ftNfJt fgrs <lh*\iu n tgj m 

-m "^f TFT aivww n <\ ii 



254 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ Bachan 

Moved by the pangs of separation from the Beloved, 
peep through the latticed screen. You are unnece- 
ssarily idling away your time amidst the mind and 
the senses which are the aliens. (1) 

The perfect Sat Guru gives you the secrets of your true 
home. Stop wandering. You have got an opportunity to 
escape, this time. You will not have it again. (2-3) 

Now press the fart Til (sesamum seed), extract oil 

and kindle the flame within you. (4) 

[If you penetrate third Til, you will be a recipient of the 
current of ambrosia and will be able to get Darshan (vision) 
of Jyoti (flame).] 

Radhasoami says that this is the first stage in the 

process of ascension to higher regions. (5) 



Shabd 4 

^t *ft ^Btf -mm 3TFST *RTO II ^ II 

3TH .MTST fa»T f*# % 3TPT II 3 II 

Now attend Satsang carefully. You have been endowed 
with the precious human form. You will not have 
such an opportunity again. (1) 

The pleasures derived from wife and progeny, wealth 
and property and name and fame ultimately turn 
painful. (2) 

Therefore, keep yourself aloof from them and adopt 

Saran of Guru, and attend Satsang. (3) 



14 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ 255 

I have awakened you. All worldly paraphernalia are 

transitory like a dream. (4) 

False is your body, false your wealth. False is your 
mind which is so strongly attached to them. (5) 

Only Satsang, Sat Guru and Nam (Name of the 

Supreme Being) are true. (6) 

O, ye gently one (Surat), act upon what I say, and 
you will be released from the cycle of births and 
deaths. (7) 

Radhasoami counsels you to ascend to tr Nabh (first 
heavenly sphere) and to penetrate into Shabd. (8) 



Shabd 5 

^TrT ^3*Tf ^ -^ *£T tttr ]| ^ \\ 

^rr srqjn 3tttt*t t 

STeTT <][ ^TCTfT ^tf «IcT SJR II *) II 

O Surat! Why do you not listen to the Dhun of Nam? 
Do you think you are in peace and comfort? You 
are lost in a labyrinth. Awake, take warning and 
proceed towards your true home. (1) 

Pleasures of mind and senses are the net spread by 
Kal to entangle you in. (2) 

O my dear! Get out of this net, and run away. Sat 

Guru discloses all the secrets. (3) 



256 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ Bachan 

Hurry up. Place yourself under the protection of Sat 
Guru. You will not get such an opportunity again. (4) 

Your stay in the body is for four days only. Thereafter, 
you will again fall in the cycle of births and 
deaths. (5) 

Therefore, listen to what I say. Give up "%Moh (attach- 
ment) and ^TRKam (passion). (6) 

But the crazy mind turns a deaf ear to this advice and 
remains engrossed in the pleasures of the senses. (7) 

What can the feeble Jiva do so long as Radhasoami 
Dayal does not accord His help? (8) 



Shabd 6 

wi ^ar^r ^jttT irtf «t^r i 

Wi* ^t T£$t 3FFTt T^tcT II S II 

O Surat! You have had enough sleep. Now get up and 
proceed. Why do you waste your capital here? (1) 

Come under the protection of Sat Guru. Hold fast to 

Nam and get rid of all evils. (2) 

Kal strikes at you every moment. Associate yourself 
with Shabd, and throw away the load of 
Karams. (3) 

Why do you not wash off the impurities of your mind 
now? Why do you not merge your Surat in 
Shabd? (4) 



14] Admonition (Part 1) [257 

Behold the marvellous Jyoti (flame) within yourself. 
Radhasoami has opened the spring of Bhakti. (5) 



Shabd 7 

%? 3JT "3>f<TT "& ^pf ^RT I 

TThrr "CRT ~m Tgi§ "wrsr ti s n 

O Surat! Hear me, I tell you for your own good. Do 

not get drowned with the foolish mind. (1) 

You are drifting day and night with Kam (passions 
and desires). You have been endowed with this 
human body after innumerable wanderings in the 
cycle of births and deaths. (2) 

Anchor your boat to the ^uz Ghat 1 of Sat Guru, viz., 
Satsang, and thus save yourself from the trap and 
treachery of Jama (Kal). (3) 

Give up thoughts and vagaries of the mind. Entertain 
no thought of high and low (such as caste, creed, 
family, lineage, etc.). (4) 

It is a great obstacle. It pollutes intelligence and under- 
standing. But, what can be done, nobody listen 
to me? (5) 

If Sat Guru grants you His special favour, you can be 
initiated in the secrets of Nam, and then you can 
hear the internal sounds. (6) 



Water-side landing place. 



258 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ Bachan 

Radhasoami discloses this marvellous secret. When 
you join Satsang, you will get the Saran of Sat 
Guru. (7) 



Shabd 8 

TR tTTTTT %H flFT H^HT II S II 

O friend! Follow now the guidance of Guru and keep away 
from the path of tRMana (mind) every moment. (1) 

Give up the pleasures of the senses. Hear the Dhun 
(Shabd) and ascend along it to"^ Nabh (sky, 
heaven). (2) 

Why do you allow yourself to be consumed in the 

fire of the world? Do not allow yourself to be devoured 
by infatuation, vanity and arrogance. (3) 

Slowly and gradually perfect the alchemy (process of 
conversion of dross into prime element) of NAM. This 
is how you will get across the ocean of life. (4) 

Act according to the advice of Radhasoami and you 

will have no fear of Jama. (5) 



Shabd 9 

fT=T "5TTT *ri*TT II <* II 



14 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ 259 

Why do you wander deluded in the world? Your stay 
here is for four days only. (1) 

All those who surround you are selfish. (2) 

Mother, father, wife and son, none will be true to you. (3) 

There is none except Sat Guru who can grant you 

liberation. (4) 

Without Nam, all Jivas roam about in the cycle of 

eightyfour. (5) 

Adorned with the crown of Surat on the head, the 

mind ascends high with the dignity and grandeur 

. of a bridegroom. On meeting the bride-like 

captivating Dhun at Trikuti, it stops there. (6-7) 

Perform Dhyan (contemplation) of Radhasoami morning 
and evening. (8) 



Shabd 10 

W^ \ ^^ ^t" Wt T; IHt II itt II 
^T f^R ■& <p 7T3? fcUKI I 
TR ^m ■qrft "3R> II <\ II 

O Surat! I know you are unhappy here, ever since 
you parted company with Shabd and engendered 
friendship with the mind. (1) 

You are tied to the foolish mind and the body. You 
are allured by the pleasures of the senses. (2) 

Members of the family and other relations are all 
tormentors. But you are lost in their company. (3) 



260 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ Bachan 

You are Chaitanya (spirit, true and real) while the 
rest are all Jarh (matter, transitory and perishable). 
Why do you identify yourself with them? (4) 

Therefore, come to your senses and proceed homeward 
this very moment. Otherwise, you will have to wander 
in the four Khans. 1 (5) 

Attend Satsang, endeavour to get access to True Abode 
and cultivate love for Sat Guru. (6) 

Sat Guru will impart the knowledge of the jewel of 
Nam. Turn round and ascend to the sky within. (7) 

Do this much now. Sat Guru will take care of the rest. (8) 

Act upon the ordainment of Radhasoami, you will be 
relieved of pain, and get happiness. (9) 



Shabd 11 
"^ TJ,^fa ^rfrT 3Sp# tl t^ II 

^ ^ ^ -^ ^Ht ii <\ ii 

O Surat! What folly is this on your part that you are 
going astray in the company of the mind? You do 
not listen to the words of Guru! (1) 



All varieties of life on this earth originate in four different ways or 
forms, viz., (i) born from an egg, e.g., a bird, a fish, a snake, a 
lizard, etc., (ii) born from the womb, e.g., man, animal, etc., (iii) 
generated by warm vapour or sweat, e.g., lice, etc., and (iv) sprouting 
or germinating from the earth, e.g., plants and minerals. 



14 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ 261 

You are allured by wealth and woman. Day and night 
you keep company with them. (2) 

Kal has cast this net of Moh (attachment) and thrown 
the grains of the pleasures of senses. Jivas are 
being entrapped therein like birds. (3) 

You are ignorant and have become a victim of greed. 
It will cause you great harm. (4) 

I now tell you clearly that none other than the Guru 

can save you. (5) 

Annihilate worldly ties and bondages, and forget 
about the comforts of body and mind. Engender 
love for Guru. (6) 

Get the alchemy of Nam from Him. You will be relieved 
from all troubles and tribulations. (7) 

You will then get detached from the body, and ascend 
to Gag an. (8) 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you, my dear, to save your- 
self from the onslaughts of Jama. (9) 



Shabd 12 

<h 3 <pt <b stern ii i ii 

The world is pitch dark and the body is full of vice 

and evil. (1) 

The states of wakefulness and dream are both marked 



262 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ Bachan 

by forgetfulness. The ignorant Jiva is lost in a 
labyrinth. (2) 

He has become an alien here. He has lost memory 

of his original home. (3) 

He is wandering in different Khans (species), assuming 
various bodies fruitlessly. (4) 

All the time he is sad, undergoing suffering and pain. 
Who is there to listen to his wailings? He cries 
in vain. He will be cast into hell and suffer the 
tortures at the hands of Jama. (5-6) 

After innumerable wanderings, he got the noble human 
form. But alas! he is smitten here by the mind 
and senses. (7) 

Sant Sat Guru admonishes him again and again, and 
shows the path to the tenth door. (8) 

But he does not pay attention to His words. Again 
and again, he rushes towards the nine doors. (9) 

He sticks to customary observances and wastes his time 
in fruitless pursuits. He does not understand Surat 
Shabd Yoga, by which he would be redeemed. (10) 

He will gain nothing by churning water; he does not 

care to churn milk. (11) 

How far should I go on relating his misfortunes? He 
indulges in outward activities (such as rites, rituals 
and observances). (12) 

He does not apply his mind to the internal practice 

of Surat Shabd Yoga. (13) 



14 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ 263 

The learned devote themselves to the Vedas, religious 
books, codes of laws, mythological stories, etc. (14) 

But without Sat Guru and Surat Shabd Yoga, no one 
can cross the ocean of life. (15) 

I tender you the most beneficial advice, my dear, now 
accept and act upon it. (16) 

Radhasoami says, "Raise your Surat to the gate of 

Nabh (sky, heaven)". (17) 



Shabd 13 

^RTf ^t ^TEIT "^ <55^r 11 <i u 

Come along, O Surat, to *the Guru's place, where 
there is neither body, nor Karam (activity) nor pain 
or anguish. (1) 

The body, the mind and the senses, all constitute an 
alien country. Give up your attachment to Pind or 
body. (2) 

Listen attentively to the message of Guru. Catch hold 
of Shabd by your Surat and run towards the final 
abode of rest and peace. (3) 

Brahma, Vishnu, Gaur, Ganesh, Narad, Saraswati and 
Shesh have no place there. (4) 

Only Sants have access to that Region. He alone 
will reach there, who is a recipient of Sat Guru's 
Daya (grace and mercy). (5) 



264 ] Admonition (Part 1) [ Bachan 14 

Kal and Karam are powerless. Kal's teeth are broken 
and his sting cut off. (6) 

Now I salute Sat Guru who is Radhasoami, the 
perfect Master and the sole Lord of true wealth 
(Surat). (7) 



BACHAN 15 

CHITAONI (ADMONITION) 
Part 2 

Shabd 1 

^P* *t 3TT% 3p «TT TTM II <1 II 

Proceed carefully, this world is a snare. Your wealth 
and property will be of no avail. (1) 

Hold fast to the Feet of Guru, take the support of 
Nam and attend Satsang. Give thought to this 
matter. (2) 

Your mind is under the sway of passion and anger. 
You are put on the wrong path by your Karams 
(actions). (3) 

What more should I speak of the plight of this mind? 
It is overcome with grief and illness. (4) 

You see with your own eyes that Jama and Kal are 
devouring Jivas, and the whole world is full of 
pain and affliction. (5) 



266 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Even then you do not awake, and try to shield yourself. 
The terrible Kal is striking Jivas every moment. (6) 

Sat Guru Radhasoami Dayal, in His grace and mercy, 
redeems Jivas by taking them in His Saran (care 
and protection). (7) 



Shabd 2 

cTRT "3PT ^ttk farntfT it i 

-tft§- ^R TJ^T "STTT ft II <1 11 

Fear and regard for the world mar progress, and 

attachment for the world is a noose. (1) 

Attachment to the family causes distress. Although a 
high-born maiden, Surat is married to Kal. (2) 

Karma (action) has put a noose round your neck and 
Jama heartily laughs at you. (3) 

You never think of your death; you feel attached to 

body. (4) 

You are swallowed up by pride and egotism. You have 
taken a heavy load of Karmas on your head. (5) 

By attaining human form, you won the game, but ultimately 
lost it because you did not take steps to curb 
mundane desires. (6) 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you to make right 

endeavours. (7) 

Improve your lot in the company of Guru. Enjoy the 

infinite bliss of Nam. (8) 



15] Admonition (Part 2) [267 

Shabd 3 

Do not find faults with others. Why daily add to your 
own sin? (1) 

Why do you unnecessarily make others sad? Why 
not give up your own blemishes one by one (2) 

Do not buzz all the time like a fly, otherwise you will 
receive injury and suffer loss every moment. (3) 

Always behold in others merits and virtues; you will 

be a recipient of bliss every moment. (4) 

I now enjoin upon you to hear me attentively and act 
upon my advice. (5) 

I have laid the modus operandi of Hansas. All Sants 
have said so. (6) 

Now, follow My precepts, or you will have to beat 

your head in utter repentance. (7) 

Do touch the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. This is the 

noble advice I tender to you. (8) 



Shabd 4 

W\t % 3TH timm ^HrT II S II 

O traveller! Beware! Swindlers have spread their 

nets. (1) 



268 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Do not travel alone on this path. Without the guidance 
of Guru, you will not get through. (2) 

Cheats and swindlers will rob you of your capital, 

and enslave you. (3) 

They have held up the whole world. In the absence 

of Guru, all are being looted. (4) 

O my friend! Pay heed to my words. Shun the company 
of swindlers, and catch hold of Guru's hem. (5) 

There is no protector other than Guru. I repeat it again 
and again. (6) 

Engender strong love for Guru, and you will be taken 
to your destination. (7) 

The essence of all endeavours is to cling to the Holy 
Feet of Guru. It will detach you from the pleasures 
of the senses. (8) 

These pleasures of the senses are the swindlers; they 
are swindling Jivas. Radhasoami enjoins upon you 
to come under His Saran, and He will save you. 
Make Nam your constant companion and you will 
attain salvation. (9-10) 



Shabd 5 

ftrsr trr ^f iff *ffwT f i 
w ^flr tfrt ^r sfim* 3f n i n 

Among your associates and companions none is a 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 269 

friend. Why are you asleep in the midst of these 
robbers and cheats? (1) 

Awake and attach yourself to Satsang. Guru will then 
dye you in the colour of pure Nam. (2) 

Wealth and property will be of no avail to you. Give 

them up instantly. (3) 

Accomplish your task while it is still day-time, for 

ahead is the night dark. (4) 

You will not get this human form again. You will wander 
in the wilderness of Chaurasi. (5) 

Serve Guru. Secure His pleasure. Conform to this 

mode of conduct and behaviour. (6) 

Bear in mind that except Guru, you have no friend. (7) 

Do not get entangled in the meshes of the world. 
Keep yourself engaged in Bhajan (devotion, 
prayers) day and night. (8) 

Accept the precepts of Sadh and Guru and remain 

indifferent to the world. (9) 

Give up cunning and craft. Why do you plunge yourself 
into a deplorable condition? (10) 

Perform Sumiran and serve Guru. Elevate your Surat 
to higher regions this very day. (11) 

Otherwise, W& Kal (tomorrow), ^HcT Kal will settle 
accounts with you. There, you will be thrown into 
the fire of hell. (12) 



270 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Take heed right now. It is not known what may happen 
next moment. (13) 

Radhasoami explains this to you. One admonition should 
be enough for your correction. (14) 



Shabd 6 

"flffaT % *S^ Tft f^rT TTH II lN) II 

t^t t^t *ntr «n^ Vptt 
^m ^t srt «r m imi 

Be afraid of death day and night. One day a crowd 
of mourners will gather at your place. The agents 
of Jama (Kal) will trample you. (1) 

You give no thought to that day. You are lost in plea- 
sures now. (2) 

One day, four pall-bearers will take you to the 

crematorium on a bier. (3) 

Brothers, kinsmen, relatives, will all be following the 

bier as mourners. (4) 

They will place you at the crematorium. Your wife will 
wail and mourn with her hair dishevelled in 
agony. (5) 

Here, you will be burnt in fire. There, you will find 

abode in hell. (6) 

As you do not now heed the advice of Sat Guru, you 
are ruining your life both in this world and in the 
world hereafter. (7) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 271 

On that day, you will repent very much. At present, 

you are doing harm to yourself. (8) 

Your youth is gone and old age has arrived. How 

long will the world keep you company? (9) 

Take warning. Bow down your head at the Holy Feet 
of Guru. (10) 

Radhasoami has now explained you everything. (11) 



Shabd 7 

m ~& II* ^R 3TR II %m li 

^RT 'frrfW ^JFR II S II 

You are tied to gross bondages. The first bondage 
is body, the second is of wife. The third bondage 
is son, and the fourth is of grandson. (1-2' 

Your grandson may have a grandson; thus, there win 
be no end to your bondages. (3) 

I need not describe other bondages such as wealth, 
property and business. (4) 

You are tightly bound fourfold, fivefold and sevenfold. (5) 

How can you now secure release? You are tied to a 
heavy stake. (6) 

You cannot be released except by death. While alive, 
you do not heed advice. (7) 



272 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Worldly honour and family prestige constitute the 

strongest of all shackles. (8) 

You do not give up old traditions and customs because 
you fear that if you do so, your worldly status 
might get a set back. (9) 

How far should I relate your sufferings and misfor- 
tunes? You are destined to wander in the form of 
a ghost or goblin. (10) 

You have taken this transitory world to be a reality. 

How can you then attain Nam (Word)? (11) 

Fetters are put on your Feet. You are handcuffed. 
Your neck is chained. You are imprisoned in a 
black hole where your sufferings are worse. (12) 

The wicked Kal has tied you down in various ways. 
But you feel merry and remain submerged in the 
world. (13) 

You are a fool to take pains for pleasures. What should 
I say to such a conceited fellow? (14) 

Be ashamed of your conduct. Have some sense of 
decency and good name. Otherwise, you will have 
to undergo punishment in hell. (15) 

If you now adopt the Saran of Radhasoami, you will 
get some gift from Him. (16) 



Shabd 8 

^tTT iR 1?t ^ TTT=TT II <* U 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 273 

Awake! Leave the world. Give up hypocrisy. Take Guru's 
Saran. (1) 

Steeped in sensual pleasures, you have become thought- 
less, negligent of your real interest. You are wandering 
here and there. In the end, you will have to beat 
your head in despair and repentance. (2) 

Why are you wasting yourself after family and kinsmen? 
You will gain nothing. (3) 

They will keep company for four days and then leave 
you in the lurch. (4) 

Beware of the deceitful world. Save your capital 1 . 

Gird up your loins for journey upward. (5) 

Join the company of Guru, and holding the sword of 
Nam in your hand, start on the journey. (6) 

Bend the bow of Surat in Gagan and shoot arrows 

of Dhun (sounds). (7) 

Thus escaping the onslaughts of Kal, come to the 

Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (8) 



Shabd 9 

■?Rt tr -^nr ^®f qgg ^r «tpt i 

pPTT rJTT ^ SR ara UfHIM II <\ II 

O mind! Leave this region of pain and pleasure. Ascend 
and come in contact with True Nam. (1) 

1. Spirituality. 



274] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Your stay in the body is for four days. Thereafter you 
have to depart from this hamlet. (2) 

Wealth, wife, sons and grandsons will be of no avail. (3) 

Two currents, of incoming and outgoing breath, are 
flowing continuously. A day will come when there 
will remain only the carcass. (4) 

This body is like a leather bag for carrying water. It 
is discharging foul matter all the twentyfour 
hours. (5) 

You are heedless and careless. You do not pay attention 
to the true and real Shabd. (6) 

Maya in the form of a woman is following you. Why 
do you not give up Kam (lust and passion). (7) 

But you cannot get rid of her without the grace and 
mercy of Guru. Therefore, go on uttering Guru's 
Name. (8) 

Enshrine the form of Guru in your heart and keep 

your mind under restraint and check. (9) 

He is merciful and compassionate. He would feel pity 
for you and help you every moment. (10) 

Abstain from^ffaBhogs (pleasures). Why do you invite 
illness for yourself? There is no comfort in it. (11) 

O dear! Act upon Guru's advice. Then will you secure 
peace and rest. (12) 

He will remove all your troubles and miseries, and 

grant you abode in the eternal region. (13) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 275 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you to seek Nij Nam. (14) 

Shabd 10 

et^ ^ "SFT "5TRT ^?T II IS£ II 
~%T3 ^"^ 4" TTfrT "*TT ^ ^t I 
^TT ^TT ^' "^trf ^T II S 11 

Lo! The whole world is drifting. Seeing this pitiable 
condition, I caution you again and again. (1) 

In all the four Yugas, you have been subject to 
transmigration, undergoing severe pains and the 
torments of hell. (2) 

Innumerable lives have been spent in suffering and pain. 
Nowhere could you secure peace for a moment. (3) 

You suffered from disasters and adversities, as a result 
of your good and evil acts, and because you did 
not fall at the Holy Feet of Sat Guru. (4) 

Now you have been blessed with this human form. 
You should engage in Bhakti, so that the Karmas 
(effects of good and evil acts) be eradicated and 
washed away. (5) 

Negligence on your part this time, will not be forgiven; 
you will have to undergo all sorts of troubles. (6) 

Give up negligence, forget the world and drink the 

beverage of Nam. (7) 

Serve Guru with awe and reverence. This is the secret 
Radhasoami has disclosed. (8) 



276 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Shabd 11 

^f *TT% | ^T ^RTTT H $& || 
•^fr ^ff ^Jt? ^J=ft 1%TrT 3"3vt I 
ift •& «B^ ^Kt II <1 II 

Mind my words. Hear attentively what I say. It is for 

your own good. (1) 

You are imprisoned in the world like a parrot caught 

in a trap. (2) 

Like a monkey, you are foolish enough to put yourself 
in the trap. (3) 

You are caught here like a fish which, for the sake 

of taste, gets its heart pierced. (4) 

As a male elephant, seeing a fake female elephant, 
puts himself in bondage, so are you enticed in 
this world. (5) 

How long should I go on repeating that cruel and tortuous 
Kal has entrapped you in various ways? (6) 

You are ignorant; you do not know his stratagem and 
trickery. He has caught you by fraud and force. (7) 

You do not pay heed to the mode of escape. Then 

how can you effect your release? (8) 

Sant Sat Guru is your benefactor. But you do not 

associate with Him carefully. (9) 

He is merciful. He will show you the way to secure 

release, and effect your redemption. (10) 



15] Admonition (Part 2) [277 

He will cut asunder the ropes of five Tattwas and three 
Gunas, which have kept you in bondage. (11) 

Removing all doubts and misgivings from your mind, 
take to His company. You will then attain a unique 
status. (12) 

Consider the allurements of the world to be deceptions; 
you have become a friend of the foolish mind. (13) 

Shun its company every moment, otherwise, it will 

take the very life out of you. (14) 

You will be thrown far away from your home and tossed 
about in the cycle of births and deaths. (15) 

You will be in a very sad plight. Who will take you 

out from there? (16) 

Therefore, you should act upon the advice of Radhasoami, 
which He gives after due consideration. (17) 



Shabd 12 

3T^3? \ ^pfr TST '3PT Tf I 

mr *"ot ft* «f » * a 

Why do you remain entangled in the world? What 

will you gain by your wanderings? (1) 

Get alerted in your mind and seek your spiritual welfare 
in Satsang. (2) 

When the fire of Virah (pangs of separation from the 
Beloved) starts burning within you, remove the impurity 
of worldly association. (3) 



278 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Develop attachment for Sat Guru. You will get absorbed 
in Shabd. (4) 

You will be released from recurrent births and deaths 
and will find abode in the eternal region. (5) 

Your latent *rrn Bhag (spiritual fitness) will be awakened, 
you will be initiated in the secrets of Nam (Name, 
Word) and get to the Dharm (Region) of the Supreme 
Being. (6) 

Kal has robbed the whole world and is leading all 

Jivas astray. (7) 

Nobody is afraid of death, which is inevitable, nor of the 
torments and tortures at the hands of Jama. (8) 

tft$ Moh (fascination for the world) has put the noose on 
all. efdLobh (greed, avarice) has devoured all. (9) 

How can you be awakened? You do not seek the 

company of Guru. (10) 

"^r Kam (desire, passion) and^H Krodh (anger) 
lead Jivas to undignified and unbecoming 
activities. (11) 

There is none, except Guru, whom you may call your 
own and who can cut this net. (12) 

Kith and kin, friends and relatives are all selfseekers. 
They will not come near you, if you not have 
money. (13) 

How far should I admonish the mind? It allows these 
very persons to claw your flesh. (14) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 279 

Guru and Sadh repeatedly warn you. But you do not 

trust them. (15) 

Radhasoami says that without grace and mercy nobody 
would listen. (16) 



Shabd 13 

•SRRTt ^T3T "3JW 3FRF II 1 II 

You are blessed with the human form. Do something 
for your real good. (1) 

Do not get lost in the world. Know, it is unreal like 

a dream. (2) 

Your body and dwelling are all transitory and perishable. 
Why do you dissipate yourself in delusions? (3) 

Jivas are lost in infatuation. None can escape Kal's 

clutches. (4) 

The fire of mundane desires has consumed the whole 
world. All are being roasted in it. (5) 

There is no way out. All are thrown in the fires of hell. (6) 

Day and night, they are being consumed, thereafter, 
they will be condemned to recurrent births and 
deaths. (7) 

They will remain wandering from one species to 
another. They will not be at rest anywhere. (8) 

The pain they suffer, cannot be described, (9) 



280 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Out of pity, Sant Sat Guru gives out the practice of 

Sumiran (repetition) of the Holy Name. (10) 

But Jivas do not follow His path and adopt Surat 

Shabd Yoga. (11) 

Without Sat Guru and the practice of Surat Shabd 
Yoga, they cannot get rid of transmigration. (12) 

But how far should I go on stressing this upon them? 
They do not listen to me. (13) 

They are all wpsr Man-mukhs (ego-centric, selfwilled). 
They are constantly subjected to pain, because 
they do not care for Guru's precepts. (14) 

They do not serve Guru, but demand regard and service 
from others. (15) 

They do not care for their spiritual welfare. They will 

have to burn in the fires of hell. (16) 

Radhasoami has given this special discourse. Try to 
understand its import, and act upon it. (17) 



Shabd 14 

"*n? rffr TTf «Tft arfrr "^t I 
1PT ^ W«T ^ xr^fT II <\ II 

Conduct yourself cautiously and prudently in the world. 
The path is crooked, strewn with obstacles. Do 
not be swayed by the dictates of mind. (1) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 281 

The ocean of worldly existence is very deep. How 
can you get to the other side without the help of 
Guru? (2) 

Love Guru as intensely as a lustful man loves his 

sweet-heart. (3) 

Associate with Guru. Remember Him all the time. 

Cling to His Feet sincerely. (4) 

Give up fraud and hypocrisy. Follow Guru's precepts. (5) 

Be always fearful of Kal. Death may come any moment. (6) 

O wanton mind! Come to your senses and remain 
vigilant as you take each breath of your life. Repeat 
the Name RADHASOAMI every moment. (7) 

Negligence in this life will bring torments and harass- 
ments in future and you will be unable to mend 
your mistakes then. (8) 

Whatever you have to accomplish, accomplish it now. 
Do not rely on the future. (9) 

Desire not the pleasures of the world, nor be affected 
by its sorrows. (10) 

Welcome the hour of trouble and calamity, for then 
one comes to remember and utter the Holy Name 
every moment. (11) 

While in affluent circumstances, one always remains 
negligent and careless. One is carried away by 
the waves of the mind. (12) 

Therefore, attend Satsang with care and vigilance, 



282 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

and you will get across the rivers of pain and 
pleasure. (13) 

Realize your real form within, and then proceed further 
with your Surat. (14) 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you to ascend and meet 

Shabd Guru. (15) 



Shabd 15 

W\ t ^FTf TTCrR 3TO ^SRT^T II %& II 

Whi'fft ^rr T^rr n <\ it 

O mind! What makes you proud? This body of yours 
will mingle in dust and you will be thrown into the 
cycle of Chaurasi. (1) 

Be humble and meek at heart. Avoid Kam (desire, 

passion) and Krodh (anger). (2) 

Engender love for and faith in Guru. Prepare the elixir 
of Nam within yourself. (3) 

Do not act upon the dictates of your impure mind. 

Treasure Guru's precepts in your heart. (4) 

Your stupid mind does not take the Saran of Guru. Be- 
coming more and more greedy, it gets surfeited. (5) 

Do not follow the dictates of your mind. If you do so, 
you will be lost in the world. (6) 

You have to deal with your stupid mind very carefully. 
Do not forget the Holy Feet of Guru. (7) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 283 

Fix the countenance of Guru in your eyes. Ascend to 
higher regions by means of Surat Shabd Yoga. (8) 

Perform Sumiran of RAD HAS OAM I, and keep in your 
mind whatever He says. (9) 



Shabd 16 

^t?r ft ^tf ^ni ^rra % n ^ )i 
*nr (H sr ^sr ^ro *r arr^ i 

tt| erfrf ^rnr ^ n s m 

Connect your Surat with the Holy Name (NAM). The 
body and wealth will not serve your purpose. You 
will be confronted by Jama (angel of death). (1) 

You have now a golden opportunity. Protect yourself 
from heat and friction, and be calm and cool. (2) 

Perform Sumiran and Sewa of Sat Guru. Turn away 
your mind from desires and passions. (3) 

Control your mind and senses as much as possible. 
Drink from the cup of Guru (Shabd current which 
is full of Amrit). (4) 

You will gain equanimity and get to higher regions. 
You will be released from the shackles of the 
mind. (5) 

Give up laziness, perform Bhajan, and get out the 

domain of Kal. (6) 

With every breath, offer prayers to Guru. It is He alone 
who will liberate you from the physical body. (7) 



284 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

There is no other remedy so effective as the repetition 
of RADHASOAMI Nam which you should do day 
in and day out. (8) 

Always associate with Sadhs in a spirit of love and 

devotion. Avoid the company of worldly people. (9) 

Radhasoami enjoins upon you to attach yourself to 

True Name. (10) 



Shabd 17 

•3FTfT ^ "#tPT faW fafl? Tfa I 
TTfc % ^TO IcTOT 3*^ -qtf? II <\ It 

How am I to be awakened from the world? Moh (attach- 
ment) has now tied me tightly. (1) 

I am being put in stronger chains and tighter noose. (2) 

Nets are now spread wide, and I have started developing 
taste for the pleasures of the world bit by bit. (3) 

Suffering will follow all this. But nobody is there to 

tell about it. (4) 

One day, a crowd of mourners will gather at your 

place. You suffer pains of various kinds. (5) 

You will then repent. But at present, you are not in a 
mood to listen to the advice. You are wasting your 
precious time. (6) 

You do not think of your death. You are passing your 
days and nights in negligence. (7) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 285 

You follow the dictates of your mind. You are day 

and night paying the toll of Karams. (8) 

At night, you stretch yourself and sleep in comfort 

knowing not what may happen the next morning. (9) 

Kal has subdued you by giving you a sound beating, 
and Karams have trampled you badly. (10) 

Tamo-guna (darkness, ignorance, passion) has clouded 
your inner vision. You have lost all memory and 
knowledge of your true home. (11) 

Sant Sat Guru is awakening you, but you do not heed 
His words. (12) 

You do not perform Bhajan and Sumiran, nor do you 
inculcate love for the Holy Feet of Sant Sat 
Guru. (13) 

Imagine how you can escape from Jama's onslaughts. 
You are, day and night, engrossed in pleasures 
and sorrows. (14) 

Except Guru, who can redeem you? You have become 
a prisoner in many ways. (15) 

Without Satsang and Nam, you can never get to your 
true home. (16) 

Radhasoami has sung the praises of Satsang and Nam. 
Come under the Saran of Sant Sat Guru. (17) 



286 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Shabd 18 

^MPditl ^R ift& "erst 1 
3f 4^T ?2T3T "SIR II q || 

The vicious mind is after me. How can I get rid of it? (1) 

My mind never heeds Sat Guru's precepts, it rather 

shows Him arrogance. (2) 

By its intellect soiled with Kam and Krodh (desires, 
passions and anger), it wants to test Guru. (3) 

It does not serve Him nor develops faith in Him. On 
the contrary, it expects respect from Him. (4) 

The mind does not realize its own condition. Then, 

how can it find the haven of peace? (5) 

Day and night, it wallows in Lobh (greediness, cupidity) 
and Moh (attachment, infatuation). (6) 

How can it understand the principles of Sant Mat 

when it puts forward its own reasoning. (7) 

With such Jivas, Sants keep mum. These Jivas are 

causing harm to themselves. (8) 

All the Jivas are slaves of perversity and vice. How 
to describe the state of their degradation? (9) 

Those who are recipient of grace and mercy, accept 
the Saran of Sat Guru, and they alone recognise 
Him. (10) 

Giving up reliance on their own wisdom and cleverness, 
Jivas should consider themselves to be 
ignorant. (11) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 287 

Then only will Sat Guru be pleased to initiate them 

into the secrets of True Home. (12) 

He will free them from perversity and vice and attach 
their Surat to Shabd. (13) 

All Sants have declared that, without Shabd, salvation 
of soul is impossible. (14) 

Radhasoami also says the same. He who accepts 

His words, is wise indeed. (15) 



Shabd 19 

#<n tr ^r *A mf i 

■# Wm % •*& sTC3TT tl <* II 

dear brother! I tell you now how to awaken the 

dormant mind. (1) 

ltookto pilgrimage, also observed fasts and acquired 
learning and wisdom. (2) 

1 performed Japa and Tapa, practised restraints of 

various kinds and observed silence. (3) 

I also took many other measures but this mind was 

not awakened. (4) 

Ultimately, after great search, I found the Sant Sat 
Guru, who gave out the following method. (5) 

Attend Satsang, serve Sat Guru and surrender your 

body and mind to Him. (6) 



288 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ Bachan 

Ascend to Gagan, hear the Shabd of Sat Guru and 
carefully direct your attention to Him and His 
Shabd. (7) 

Slowly and gradually, the mind will be awakened. 
You will begin to realize that the whole world is 
perishable. (8) 

The Surat will get the help of the mind. Both will 

reach their respective destinations. (9) 

Whatever, other methods may be tried, without Shabd, 
the mind cannot be awakened. (10) 

I have given out this method after due consideration 
for the correction of the mind. (11) 

It is sheer waste of time to take recourse to other 

means. They will not lead you home. (12) 

Without Sant, all are going astray. Nobody can find 

Shabd. (13) 

Again and again, I stress the importance of Shabd. 

You should apply your Surat to Shabd. (14) 

You will find abode in your true home. You will be 
released from the cycle of recurrent births and 
deaths. (15) 

Radhasoami says that without the Saran of Sat Guru 
all remain wandering in various species of 
existence. (16) 



15] Admonition (Part 2) [289 

Shabd 20 

Tate Tfrflrar ^ ft* *? * H *5 II 

*t ^R ftraT *& facHI vtt& I 
(ft *r^t ^TfT *n ^ || q || 

Seek the Beloved within yourself. If you are anxious to 
meet your Beloved, do not stray in the world. (1) 

Pilgrimages, fasts, rituals, observances, etc., detain 
you on the path. (2) 

So long as you do not find the perfect Sat Guru, you 
will remain steeped in sin. (3) 

You will never be favoured with the nectar of Nam. 
You will remain drifting in various species, such 
as birds, etc. (4) 

Pandits (learned), Qazis (judges, those who administer 
Muslim Law), Bhekhs (anchorites) and Shekhs (Muslim 
divines) are all misled at every step. (5) 

You will not find your Beloved in their company. You 
will meet your Beloved if you associate with a 
Sadh. ' (6) 

These persons are lost in the desires for pleasures of 
the world. Errors, doubts, suspicions and misappre- 
hensions have sunk deep into their veins. (7) 

Without a Sant, nobody can learn the secrets of the 
Path.. He impresses upon you the necessity of 
detaching yourself from the world. (8) 

As long as you do not meet a Sant, you will be 

deceived by the world. (9) 



290 ] Admonition (Part 2) I Bachan 

If you take the Saran of Radhasoami, you will merge 
in the refulgence of the dazzling Jyoti (flame). (10) 



Shabd 21 

m& in "ekt # ^nuFwt u i u 

Guru repeatedly enjoins upon you to reconcile your 
mind and devote yourself to Sumiran (repetition) 
of Radhasoami Nam. (1) 

With every breath, your capital is being reduced and 
your life is being spent away. (2) 

You have got an opportunity of sitting on a throne. 
Give up the habit of rummaging in rubbish. (3) 

The path of salvation of soul is now shown by Guru. 

Catch hold of Shabd disclosed by Guru. (4) 

Apply your Surat to Shabd. Always wait upon and 

pay homage to Guru. (5) 

Get His Daya (grace and mercy) every moment. Accept 
Saran (protection and care) of His Holy Feet. (6) 

He initiates you in the secrets of the higher regions 
represented in the human microcosm. Catch hold 
of Shabd, and get across the ocean of life. (7) 

When once you are assiduously engaged in the work 
of salvation of your soul, you will no more pay 
attention to the affairs of the world. Your Surat 
shall ascend to the Amar Pad (Sat Lok). (8) 



15 ] Admonition (Part 2) [ 291 

Those who associate with Guru, get rid of recurrent 

births and deaths. (9) 

The world is a snare, leave it. Try to understand the 
reality. Then will you be released from Chaurasi. (10) 

Attend Satsang. Cultivate love for Guru. Elevate your 
Surat and behold the celestial spectacles unfolded 
to you as in a mirror. (11) 

Hear the Shabd of Gagan (Trikuti). This is what you 
have got to do. (12) 

Reach the Region which is independent of any prop 
or support. The knot of body and mind will be 
loosened and opened thereby. (13) 

You will not find anybody here who is truly happy. 

Therefore, act according to Guru's instructions. (14) 

The fools are caught in the meshes of pain and suffering. 
Why do you get yourself entrapped with them? (15) 

Give up thinking in terms of 'mine and thine'. Adopt 

the Saran of Radhasoami. (16) 



BACHAN 16 

CHITAONI (ADMONITION) 

Part 3 
DEVOTION TO SAT GURU 

Shabd 1 

-qz tr ^frr ^r% wit i 
-^tft ^3rt %jzm ^m "arm n q ii 

After wandering through crores of lives, you have now 
got this human form, which is a rare asset. (1) 

Do not waste it. Take care. Apply yourself to devotion 
every moment. (2) 

If you were to perform Bhakti (devotion), it must be 
of Guru. You should get initiation in Shabd Yoga 
from Him. (3) 

If one does not know Surat Shabd Yoga, one is a 

false Guru. (4) 

Guru is He who is absorbed in Shabd. He does not 

perform any other practice. (5) 



Bachan 16 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 293 

I have disclosed the Shabds of Gagan (Trikuti), Sunn, 
Bhanwargupha, Sat Lok and Agam Lok. (6-7) 

I have explained fully how to recognise a Guru, leaving 
no ambiguity or doubt. (8) 

The Perfect Guru is He who performs Surat Shabd 
Yoga. Become the dust of His Holy Feet. (9) 

Do not apply other tests for recognising Him. Look 

not for merits and demerits in Him. (10) 

After getting initiated by Him in the mysteries of Shabd, 
practise Surat Shabd Yoga whole-heartedly. (11) 

Have some pity on your soul. Save it from trans- 
migration. (12) 

Otherwise, you will be subjected to all kinds of torments in 
hell, and be burnt in fire pits again and again. (13) 

Worldly pleasures will last only for four days. Thereafter, 
you will undergo pain and suffering. (14) 

Moved by your miserable plight, I caution you again 
and again. (15) 

I am filled with compassion for you. Awake and arise 
my dear. Guru will help you. (16) 

Worship none but Guru. Have His Darshan, and attend 
on His Holy Feet. (17) 

Worship of Guru includes the worship of all, just as 

the ocean embraces all rivers. (18) 

If one worships Guru, undoubtedly one worships all 
gods and goddesses, Ishwar (God) and Mahesh 



294] Admonition (Part 3) [ Bachan 

(Shiva), Sun and Shesh (thousand headed serpent), 
Gaur (Shiva's wife) and Ganesh (Shiva's son), Brahm 
and Par-Brahm, Satnarm, the three worlds and the 
fourth Dharm (Dayal Desh). Do not have any doubt 
about it. (19-20-21) 

Hence I repeatedly applaud the Bhakti of Guru every 
moment. (22) 

Become a gurumukh (devotee of Guru). Carry out His 
behests. One who has taken Saran of Guru, gets 
across the ocean of life in no time. (23) 

How am I to sing the praises of Guru? There is none 
equal to Him. (24) 

All religions have laid down the worship of Guru. Those 
who are antagonistic to Guru, will find no resting 
place anywhere. (25) 

Worldly pleasures and enjoyments, and power and 
position are secured by wealth or through the kind- 
ness of rulers. (26) 

Do you not dance attendance on officials in order to 
obtain wealth, honour and position? (27) 

You carry out their orders so meticulously that you 

neglect even your meal and sleep. (28) 

To what use did you put the wealth so amassed? 
You squandered it for securing name and fame 
in the world. „ (29) 

I have emphasized the transitory nature of the world, 
it lasts for four days only. (30) 



16 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 295 

It is for this perishable wealth that you serve authorities 
with such meticulous care and attention as can 
not be described. (31) 

But you neglect the service of Guru, which would bring 
you help and succour at all times and in all 
circumstances. (32) 

Days, fortnights, months and even the whole year, 
pass, and yet there is no yearning in your heart 
for the Darshan of Guru. (33) 

How can you then hope for the salvation of your soul? 
You have to abide in hell, suffering pain and torments 
on all sides. (34) 

Think over the matter. Who will help you in that condition? 
You do not engender love for Guru. (35) 

If you do not believe this, you should consider the 

matter from a different angle. (36) 

You are, at ail times, afflicted by diseases and sorrows. 
Know that they are the messengers of death. (37) 

Death is inevitable. It devours all Jivas. (38) 

This death will come to you also. One day Kal will 

make an assault on you. (39) 

Take some measures to ward off that calamity. Wealth 
and position will not be of any help. (40) 

If you were wise, you would have made good use of 
your riches. Good use lies in spending the riches 
in the service of the Spiritual Guide. (41-42) 

Guru is not hungry for your money. He has the wealth 
of Bhakti and Nam. (43) 



296] Admonition (Part 3) [ Bachan 

But in order to do you good, He makes you spend 

your money on the poor and needy. (44) 

You secure His grace at no cost, if you win His 

pleasure. (45) 

It is really a great boon if Guru is pleased with you, 
for His pleasure means the pleasure of Sat Purush 
Himself. (46) 

Whosoever secures the pleasure of Guru, is above 

all. (47) 

If Guru is pleased, the Creator is pleased. Kal and 

Karma can do no harm. (48) 

The position of Guru is acknowledged by all. The old 
sages, such as, Shuk Deo, Narad and Vyas, have 
sung His praises. (49) 

You should, therefore, win the pleasure of Guru. It is 
no good pleasing others. (50) 

If Guru is pleased with you, not the slightest injury or 
harm can be caused to you, not a single hair of 
yours can be touched, even though the whole world 
is displeased with you. (51) 

He who pleases all others, but has enmity with Guru, 
and speaks ill of Him, and takes Him to be a 
human being, is obviously bringing his own ruin. 
He shall be thrown into hell to suffer tortures 
there. (52-53-54) 

You should, therefore, try to see things in their right 
perspective. Somehow or other, seek the pleasure 
of Guru. (55) 



16 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 297 

Family and kinsmen cannot help you at all, nor can 
the people of your caste and community be of 
any help to you. (56) 

They keep you company for four days only. They are 
selfish to the core. (57) 

Do not be afraid or regardful of them. Apply yourself 
whole-heartedly to Guru Bhakti. (58) 

Guru will help you here and hereafter. Even the creator 
(Kal) is afraid of Him. (59) 

Family and kinsmen will do no good. In their company 
you will be hurled into hell. (60) 

Associate with them only to the extent it is necessary. 
If you are excessively attached to them, you will 
have to suffer much. (61) 

Therefore, attend Satsang, serve Sat Guru, and get 
Nam Padarath (bliss of Name) every moment. (62) 

There is nothing like Guru, Nam and Satsang. (63) 

These three would accomplish your task. Your Karmas 
would be eradicated and you will secure admittance 
to the Original Home. (64) 

Accept these words, otherwise you will have to repent 
in the end. (65) 

Wealth and honour will do no good. Power and pelf 

are not everlasting. (66) 

Therefore, perform Bhakti and make your life fruitful. (67) 



298] Admonition (Part 3) [ Bachan 

Shabd 2 

^ 3TRfft Tp TffW "eft ^ I 
T^? ^TR ^ 3R WT ^ II 1 II 

friend! Listen. I explain to you how to perform Arti, 

in clear terms. (1) 

First, you take into your hands a platter of WIT Sardha 
(faith). Then place Ghee (rarified butter) of Prem 
(love) in the lamp, and light up the wick of ^m 
Sama and"^T Dama (control over senses, internal 
and external). (2) 

Withdraw from the world and its pleasures. Then, you 
can renounce Kam (desire, passion) and sFte Krodh 
(anger) in a moment. (3) 

Sing the song of Surat Shabd and join your f^tf Chit 

(attention) to the Holy Feet of Guru. (4) 

Radhasoami will then shower His grace and mercy 
upon you, and will one day grant you abode into 
the Region of Nij Nam (Radhasoami Dham). (5) 

Fix your gaze on Guru and move the platter in a circle 
and bring your body and mind under control. (6) 

Prepare yourself for the journey to the Pooran Pad 

(Perfect Abode). Merge your Surat in True Name. (7) 

1 sang Arti with love and devotion. I turned away 

my mind from the affairs of the world by Shabd 
Yoga. (8) 



16 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 299 

Shabd 3 

#5TcT *BT Ttfm ^ OTTtT I 
•fart "^ ^HT W TRTW il S II 

What are you thinking about, my dear? Why do you 
not perform Arti? You will not get such an opportunity 
again. (1) 

But, my friend, what can I do without the requisite 
strength? My body and mind are very unsteady. (2) 

However, maintaining patience, I take the necessary 
course of attending Satsang, and approach 
Soami. (3) 

When the merciful Sat Guru showers grace and mercy, 
the wanton mind will be brought under control in 
a moment. (4) 

He will place the platter of Shabd in the hands of 

Surat, and kindle the flame of Prem. (5) 

When thus you perform Arti, you will attain Mukti 

Pad. (6) 

Believe this is true. Consider the Lord to be 

omnipotent. (7) 

Offer Bhog (food) to Him, and then partake of the 
Prashad and Charnamrit, and thus train your 
mind. (8) 

Recite the True Name RADHASOAMI; you will then 
attain Sat Lok. (9) 



BACH AN 17 

CHITAONI (ADMONITION) TO BHEKHS 
Part 4 

Shabd 1 

i' ^ r[rr# $jfc ii q ii 

I ask you, how do you claim to be a Sadh? (1) 

You have not given up pride and anger, nor can you 

tolerate harsh words. (2) 

You are neither kind at heart nor gentle in speech. 
There is no trace of compassion in you. (3) 

You do not worship anybody, but you get yourself wor- 
shipped by others. You beg and amass money. (4) 

You have not given up Kam (desire, passion) and 
Lobh (greed, avarice). You are being crushed by 
Moh (attachment) and Irsha (jealousy). (5) 

You do not perform Bhajan and Bhakti. You will never 
be spared by Jama (the angel of death). (6) 



Bachan 17 ] Chitaoni to Bhekhs [ 301 

You have relinguished your home. You have also relin- 
quished your avocation. You are a shirker. (7) 

You aimlessly roam about from place to place. You 
have donned the clothes of a recluse, but your 
conduct is'most unbecoming. (8) 

You are engrossed in fraud, trickery and hypocrisy. 
Before householders, you feign to follow religious 
observances and rules of conduct. (9) 

You would eat itz\ Roti (toasted cake) in Chauka 1 
only. You make distinction between ordinary Roti(a 
cake of flour or meal toasted on an earthen or 
iron dish or plate) and \Tt Puri (the same fried 
in Ghee or oil). (10) 

You do not possess right understanding and thinking, 
nor have you come in contact with a perfect Guru. 
You have fear and regard for householders. (11) 

The feet of Sants are holier than all the sixtyeight 
places of pilgrimage. The ground which they tread 
becomes hallowed. (12) 

You are given to observances and delusions. Why 

do you dub yourself as Sadh? (13) 

You assume the appearance of a Bhekh (recluse) and 
dupe the world. Kal has played a trick upon you. He 
has employed you for deceiving people. (14) 

Now come to your senses and devote yourself to 
Satsang. Be afraid of the torments of hell. (15) 

1. The space in which a Hindu cooks and eats his victuals. 



302 ] Admonition (Part 4) [ Bachan 

Practise renunciation. Engender love and yearning. 
Perform Bhakti (devotion), and run away from the 
world. (16) 

Curb your mind. Restrain your senses. Apply your 

Surat to Shabd coming from above. (17) 

And you will become kind at heart and pure of intellect 
and get rid of the deceitful mind. (18) 

What more should I say? One word is enough for an 
Adhikari (fitted for true Parmarth). (19) 

Those who are shameless and hypocrites, and are over- 
come by mundane considerations, are like demons 
and brutes. How can they grasp the reality? (20) 

Radhasoami now sums up that only the Hansa Jivas 
will accept Him by His discourses. (21) 



Shabd 2 

far *nt cfst % mf n <i n 

You have not practised Shabd. Then how can you 

know the Reality? (1) 

This Shabd comes from the Region which does not 
rest on any support. What is the use of harping 
on hearsay? (2) 

If you had turned your Surat (spirit-current) inwards, you 
would have received secrets of that Region. You 
would have stopped talking. You would not have 



17 ] Chitaoni to Bhekhs [ 303 

been pleased with anything but Shabd. (3-4) 

You do not firmly cling to Shabd. Your mind is, therefore, 
always unsteady. (5) 

if you had contacted Shabd, your mind would have 

been intoxicated with its bliss. (6) 

You would not have applied yourself to anything except 
Shabd. You would have discarded all mundane 
desires. (7) 

You would have engendered love for Him who 
describes the efficacy of Shabd before you. (8) 

You have not grasped the true importance of Shabd. 
What you say is all fiction. (9) 

If you had loved Shabd, you would not have cared 

for name and fame. (10) 

The state of your mind would have been quite different. 
Your Surat (spirit-current) would not have gone 
downwards. (11) 

You may talk much, but you cannot practise Shabd. (12) 

Those who practised Shabd, my dear, their Surats 

got unattainable bliss. (13) 

The whole world appears to be insipid and tasteless 
to them. Shabd alone is the best and the highest 
of all. (14) 

Radhasoami give's out this teaching. Those who follow 
it, will enjoy the bliss of Shabd. (15) 



BACHAN 18 



DEVOTION TO SAT GURU 



Shabd 1 

Adopt Guru (spiritual Guide) after thorough search. 
Nobody finds the right path without Guru. (1) 

Jivas are drowned in the ocean of life. They find no 

one to save them. (2) 

Learned people of the world, ascetics, Yogis, Gyanis 
(wise) all have failed. (3) 

They do not engender love for Sants. How can they 

be redeemed? (4) 

They are lost in pilgrimage, fasting and penance. They 
are puffed up with learning. (5) 

They did not get even a particle of the bliss of Bhakti 
(devotion). They failed to take the Saran of 
devotees. (6) 



Bachan 18] Devotion to Sat Guru [305 

They did not know the secret of Bhakti, because they 
did not accept Guru as Sat Purush. (7) 

Guru redeems all those who worship His Holy Feet. (8) 

Your face is always turned away from Guru. You act 
under the dictates of your mind. (9) 

You are lost in Karams (rites and rituals). You are not 
making any fruitful use of the human body. (10) 

Come to your senses. Associate with Guru and 
engender love for Him. (11) 

Radhasoami repeatedly emphasises that those who 
make endeavours shall attain a high status. (12) 



Shabd 2 

Tg5 "^t 3R ?T ^T? TJ-JTT I 
TJ5 ^TPT ^Ttf ^5T ^ ^3JT || <\ || 

Worship Guru every moment. There is no deity equal 
to Him. (1) 

Attend on the Holy Feet of Guru. Sacrifice your body 
and mind to Him. (2) 

Have His Darshan with your eyes. Listen to His Bachans 
with your ears. (3) 

By the strength of Guru, subdue your mind. By the 

help of Guru, kill Kal. (4) 

Guru came here as Brahm. He explained the status 
of Par Brahm. (5) 



306] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Guru revealed Satnam Pad and gave clue to Alakh 

and Agam. (6) 

Radhasoami assumed the form of Guru. The Nameless 
and Impersonal Supreme Being is not superior to 
Guru. (7) 



Shabd 3 

tjs; ezjh srfr "^r wt 3 i 

Tp» ^rrsr "^ftrr f*R ftR ^r n i it 

Enshrine the form of Guru in your heart. Utter the 

Name of Guru every moment. (1) 

Sing Guru and Guru alone. He will then help you. (2) 

Without Guru, nobody can reach any stage high or 

low. (3) 

It is the Guru who revealed to me the secrets of higher 
regions, and raised my Surat to Sunn. (4) 

Guru enabled me to behold the spectacles of Maha- 
sunn and Bhanwar-gupha. (5) 

Guru took me to Sat Lok, and then enabled me to 

meet Alakh Purush and Agam Purush. (6) 

Guru gave out all the secrets. It is through Guru that 
I came to know of the secrets of the Supreme 
Father Radhasoami. (7) 



18 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 307 

Shabd 4 

■rpr ^jr *m ^rr ^n| it q n 

Cling fast to the Holy Feet of Guru, and associate 

with Him. (1) 

Let the discourses of Guru be your support and suste- 
nance. Intently gaze at Guru's countenance. (2) 

The status of Guru is very high. Sing the hymn of 

His praises. (3) 

Enshrine Guru in your heart so that Kal's influence 

may be effaced. (4) 

Give up Asa and Mansa (desire and longing) for sensual 
enjoyments and run away from the world. (5) 

Cherish desire and longing for Guru's Shabd and Holy 
Feet. (6) 

Turn away your desires and inclinations from the 
pleasures and objects of the world, and apply your 
mind and senses to the Guru. (7) 

Remember Guru all day and night. Remember none 
else but Guru. (8) 

Even while breathing and eating do not forget Guru. 
Sing the praises of Guru every moment. (9) 

Guru is your benefactor. Save Guru none is your friend. (10) 

Guru will save you from the noose of Jama. Guru will 
impart to you the secrets for securing true 
happiness. (11) 



308 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Guru will take you across the ocean. He will take 

care of you every moment. (12) 

Guru will look after you, in the manner, a tortoise 

hatches its eggs. (13) 

[See Note to couplet No. 28 of Shabd 4 of Bachan 3.] 

There is no saviour like Guru. Family and kinsmen 

are all like snakes. (14) 

Therefore, never forsake the company of Guru. Turn 
your mind away from wealth and women. (15) 

Guru Bhakti (devotion to Guru) always confers happi- 
ness. Without Guru, even your own mind and intellect 
bring you pain and sorrow. (16) 

Have faith in Guru. Swim across the world by the 

blessing of Guru. (17) 

Guru will remove your vanity, infatuation and arrogance. 
Desire, passion and anger will become afraid 
of you. (18) 

By the grace of Guru, greed and avarice will be cast 
off, and Maya and Marmta 1 will be vanquished. (19) 

If you rely upon Guru, no one can get an upper hand 
over you. (20) 

You will receive the alchemy of Nam from Guru. The 
witch of desire will run away. (21) 



1. Mamta = Cupidity; attachment; covetousness. 



18 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 309 

Take Guru's Chamamrit 1 and Prashad 2 with love; all 
troubles will be over. (22) 

Sacrifice your body and mind before Guru. Behold 
the form of Guru in your Hridaya (heart). (23) 

Guru is the giver. Guru is bountiful. Worship Guru 

every moment. (24) 

Guru is Satnarm Sat Purush. Guru is also Alakh Purush 
and Agam Purush. (25) 

Radhasoami is the Name of Guru. By worshipping 
Guru, attain Nij Pad (Original Abode) and enjoy 
eternal and perfect bliss. (26) 

Guru is Antarjami 3 in every way. Sing the praises of 
and contemplate the form of RADHASOAMI. (27) 



Shabd 5 

w^ ^jt to ^rfr t 
Trarpr e£t f^ft «mt II ** u 

Utter the Name of Sat Guru. Enshrine Sat Guru in 

your heart. (1) 

1. Charnamrit = Water sanctified by washing the feet of 
Sant Sat Guru. The wash of the feet of Sant Sat Guru. 

2. Prashad = Sacrament. Eatables, garlands, clothes and other 
articles distributed after being sanctified by Sant Sat Guru. 

3. Antarjami = Knower of the inner parts or of the heart. 
Knower of th interior. Providence. Deity. Pervading the 
inner parts. The Supreme Spirit. The Supreme Spirit guiding 
and regulating the creation below, checking and regulating 
the internal feelings. 



310 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Have trust and reliance on Sat Guru. And then you 

need not feel dejected. (2) 

Sat Guru will protect and nourish you every moment. 
He will remove your arrogance. (3) 

Always remember the Holy Feet of Sat Guru. Do not 
be displeased with Him. (4) 

Now hear about the status of Sat Guru from me, although 
words are too inadequate to give even the remotest 
idea of His power and eminence. (5) 

He will pull you out of the nine apertures and seat you 
at the tenth. There, your duality will be over. (6) 

He will give you the drink of the nectar of Shabd 

and save you from the torments of hell. (7) 

He will unfold the secrets of the inaccessible region 

and give out all the details of the path. (8) 

Those who associate with Sat Guru, are never afraid 
of the world. (9) 

Those who are antagonistic to Guru, drown in the 

ocean of worldly existence. (10) 

They wander in the cycle of transmigration, suffering 
pain in every life. (11) 

You should ponder over the matter. There is none 

equal to Guru in the whole world. (12) 

Those who take to Guru Bhakti (devotion to Guru), 
secure access to Nij Darbar (Real Home). (13) 



18 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 311 

Those who do not hold Guru Bhakti dear, are losers 
and beaten, even after having won the game. (14) 

[To be blessed with the human life is tantamount to winning 
the game. And to waste it by not applying it to Sat Guru 
Bhakti, is losing the game.] 

It is a' great thing to be a lover of the Holy Feet of 

Guru. It cahnot be described in words. (15) 

Those who love Guru very dearly, are instrumental in 
getting salvation for all their kith and kin. (16) 

Blessed are the parents of those who, renouncing 

everything, engage in Guru Bhakti. (17) 

Those who patiently put up with the calumny at hands of 
worldly people, are recipients of happiness. (18) 

Those who value worldly honour and fame, will fail to 
perform Guru Bhakti. (19) 

A warrior does not turn back from the battlefield. A 

faithful wife burns herself on her husband's pyre. (20) 

If the warrior turns away, he is dubbed a coward. If 
the faithful wife turns back from the cremation 
ground, she will be born as a scavenger in her 
next birth. (21) 

The bird Papiha does not break its vow. A moth consigns 
itself to the flame. (22) 

As water is dear to fish, so is Sat Guru to the 
Gurumukh. (23) 

Verily, a devotee of such a higher order is a rare 
find. He is the recipient of Guru's favour in full 
measure. (24) 



312 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Radhasoami says that Guru Himself will come to 

awaken such a devotee. (25) 



Shabd 6 

Do what Sat Guru orders you to do. Follow not the 

dictates of your mind. (1) 

The mind turns you away from Sat Guru and leads 

you to perdition. (2) 

It will whirl you in the wheel of Kal and entangle you 
in the meshes of worldly attachments. (3) 

The mind is an arch-enemy, take it not to be your friend. It 
will keep you away from Guru Bhakti. (4) 

It will throw you in the whirlpool of desire, passion 
and anger, in the company of your wife, son, riches 
and family. (5) 

It will lead you astray through desires for the pleasures 
of senses, and destroy your Bhakti and capacity 
for discernment. (6) 

As long as the beloved Sat Guru is not met, you will not 
get rid of the tricks and pranks of the mind. (7) 

How far should I describe the fraud, atrocity and trickery 
of the mind. Even the sages and holy men could 
not know them. (8) 



18] Devotion to Sat Guru [313 

Therefore, seek the true Sat Guru. Without Sat Guru 
none can be saved. (9) 

There is no friend like Sat Guru. He alone can wash 
the impure mind clean. (10) 

I am very lucky, for I have become the darling of Sat 
Guru. (11) 

What can the worldly people know about the eminence 
and glory of Sat Guru? Even the Vedas and other 
revealed books do not know it. (12) 

Gyanis (learned) and Yogis all got tired and exhausted 
in their efforts, but none could understand the 
grandeur and glory of Sat Guru. (13) 

Therefore, I lay stress on the Saran of the Sat Guru. 

I perform His Arti every day. (14) 

When I lovingly perform Arti, all my kith and kin will 

be redeemed. (15) 

I now prepare for Arti. Radhasoami has showered 

grace on me. (16) 

Radhasoami is supremely gracious and merciful. I have 
been greatly enriched by performing His Arti. (17) 



3^" tr f*\ ^rr Wri^fc "5V<T i 
tffa VR 3^ 'fa># 3tT ifttT II 1 II 

O mind, get dyed in the colour of love for Sat Guru. 

Do not make friend with anybody else. (1) 

Shabd 7 



314 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Keep this advice in your mind. Without Guru, all activities 
are wrong and improper. (2) 

Go to Guru and beg for His Prashad. Cast off all 

impurities, and remain free from Maya. (3) 

Subdue your mind which is the root of all evils. Apply 
your Surat to the practice of Shabd. (4) 

Subdue worldliness, and ascend sky-wards. Follow 

this precept of Sants. (5) 

Utter Guru's name with your heart and soul. Go on 
enhancing your love for Him every moment. (6) 

Radhasoami sings this special song. Give up trickeries 
of the mind and affection for the objects of 
Maya. (7) 



Shabd 8 

ttj^ wt rw wtctT Tm ii q n 

Conform to the Mauj (will) of Guru. Comply with the 

pleasure of Guru, dear friend. (1) 

Whatever Guru does, consider it to be in your interest, 
and whatever Guru orders, follow it with care and 
attention. (2) 

Adopt the attitude of gratefulness; whatever pleasure 
and pain He dispenses for you, are for your 
good. (3) 



18 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 315 

Remember, admonition and chastisement are in fact, 
marks of His affection; look upon all the pleasures 
of the senses as disease. (4) 

What else should I say? I am grateful to Guru every 
moment. Except Him, there is none who can do 
anything. (5) 

Let neither troubles afflict you, nor pleasures inebriate 
you. (6) 

Do not forget Him at any time. Rely on Him amidst 

pain and pleasure. (7) 

Guru and Shabd are the true friends. There is none 

else. Keep them always in your mind. (8) 

Guru is Sat Purush; Guru is the Creator. He would 

one day steer your ship across. (9) 

Except Him, there is none in this world. Sacrifice 

your mind and spirit at His Feet. (10) 

He always looks to your good; He is the protector of 
your mind and body. (11) 

Enshrine Him in your heart gratefully; He will remove 
your troubles completely. (12) 

But what can He do when your own mind is so worth- 
less? You do not turn away from the currents of 
venom (sensual pleasures). (13) 

Again and again, you fall a prey to pleasures. You 

do not listen to His beneficent advice. (14) 

That is why you are penalized; even then you do not 
listen, impudent as you are. (15) 



316] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Endure whatever befalls you now. Go and pray to 

Guru. (16) 

Run and cling fast to Him; He alone would help 

you. (17) 

There is no other door to knock at. Be alert. Cling 

to His Feet carefully. (18) 

You have committed sins day and night; you have 

not acted upon the advice of Guru. (19) 

Hence you are subjected to pain and affliction. It is 

He alone who will rescue you! (20) 

Be with Radhasoami; then only will you gain access 
to the inaccessible Shabd. (21) 



Shabd 9 

3TFrT HfisT ^Pf ^Tt og& 3T*JRT I 

"^ ctto "craft ist^t ^r*T ^jeht it <\ ii 

O my friend! Do something today to do good to your 
soul. Look steadfastly at Guru. Give up the world 
which is unreal like a dream. (.1) 

Otherwise, you will have to repent and come to grief. 
You will suffer great many torments in ihe domain 
of Jama, viz., hell. (2) 

Listen attentively and accept the words of advice. 

Apply your Surat to Shabd. (3) 

Otherwise, you will die and be born in the four species 



18 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 317 

of life again and again. Pay, oh, do pay heed to 
what I say. (4) 

Give up pride and vanity and apply yourself to the 

Dhyan of the Holy Feet of Guru. (5) 

Without Guru, who else is there to come to your help? 
Without Nam, who will take you across? (6) 

Complete your task today, and run away with Guru. 

Your throne and crown lie unoccupied. (7) 

Make acquaintance with Shabd, and adorn your Surat. 
Abandon worldly honour and reputation. (8) 

Cleanse your mind and Surat in the company of Guru, 
otherwise, your covers will not be removed. (9) 

Shake off impurities by the help of Guru. Give up plea- 
sures of the world, for they are like itches. (10) 

Radhasoami warns you that if you do not accept this 
advice, you shall suffer. (11) 



Shabd 10 

jg; <tft*iR ^efr -^ writ I 

vn *aft wr wm ii q ii 

My noble friend, curbing the vagaries of the mind, 

come to the Satsang of Guru. (1) 

Be alert and win the battle. This opportunity will not 

be available again. (2) 



318 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

Your fortune has been enhanced by the kindness of 
Guru. Bathe in the current of Amrit (nectar). (3) 

Pick up pearls. Attain the status of a Hansa 

(celestial being). Ascend to Sahas-dal-kanwal, 
beyond And. (4) 

Survey every part or division of the expanse of 

Brahmand with your own eyes. (5) 

Your Surat will go beyond the Kanwal (Sahas-dal- 
kanwal), open the door to Trikuti, and reach the 
region of Sunn. (6) 

You will proceed to your home with a lamp in your 
hand, removing the darkness pervading your inner 
recesses. (7) 

Catching the reverberations of Shabd coming from 
above, you will move like a spider upwards along 
the thread (current) of Shabd. (8) 

Beyond the ocean (of three worlds) is the^cr ^ 
Sait Pad or Sunn which is distinct (from the 
lower creation of three worlds). On crossing Sunn, 
you will hear the resonance of the Shabd of 
Bhanwargupha. (9) 

Sat Shabd (Satnarm, Sat Lok) is the support and sustenance 
of the Shabd of Sunn. You will secure entrance 
into Sat Lok which is Guru's Darbar. (10) 

Absorbed in the love of Sat Guru, you will become 

oblivious of the world. (11) 

Sar Shabd (Satnarm, Sat Lok) receives splendour and 
refulgence from Anarmi, where there is no Nam 



18] Devotion to Sat Guru [319 

(Shabd) and Rup (Form). (Shabd and Rup are 
hidden in the Region of Anami, above Sat Lok). (12) 

The Nij Dharm (Special Abode) of Sants is above 
Alakh and Agam. On reaching there, your Surat 
will get true embellishment. (13) 

Radhasoami is the sovereign of^r^f Achal (unchange- 
able) region. I sacrifice myself at His Holy 
Feet. (14) 

I perform this Arti of my Guru and penetrate from 

this end to that. (15) 

& & & 
Shabd 11 

m t& *mr? 11 ^ n 

O my Bhonra like mind (enamoured of lotus), gaze 

at the lotus eyes of Guru. (1) 

[See note to copulet 21, Shabd 4, Bachan 3] 

Purify yourself. Be calm and cool. Listen to Anhad 

Shabd. (2) 

Your fortune will be brightened up if you traverse 

internally. (3) 

The region of Trikuti is echoing with the rumbling of 
clouds. Like a peacock, be thrilled to scream and 
dance in joy. (4) 

Let your Surat break open the door of^Nabh (Sunn) 
and announce its victory with an uproar. (5) 



320 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ Bachan 

When you come to the "tfcT ^ Sait Pad (Sat Lok), 

Kal is vanquished. (6) 

Radhasoami gave His Darshan to the Jivas in the 
form of Sant Sat Guru, and turned their minds 
and Surats upwards and inwards. (7) 



Shabd 12 
wmr "sjttt up ■fcr ^ i 

w # tf? Tgrft *H II q II 

You have been attending Satsang for long. It is now 
high time that you give up your old habits. (1) 

How long will you go on acting hypocritically towards 
your Guru? You should now recognise the exalted 
position and status of Guru. (2) 

Consider not Guru to be a human being. He is the 

very life and soul of Sat Purush. (3) 

Persuade your mind as best as you can. Do accept 
this truth. Have firm faith in Him and contemplate 
His image. (4) 

Out of sheer grace and mercy, He delivers discourses. 
He is the Perfect Being, the Nameless One. (5) 

Guru has assumed the human form. He will effect 

your salvation somehow or the other. (6) 

Serve Him. Worship Him. Consider Guru Nanak, Kabir 
Sat Nam and all Sants to be included in Him. 
Your task will be accomplished by Him. Stop wandering. 
Give up vanity. (7-9) 



18 ] Devotion to Sat Guru [ 321 

Do not miss this opportunity. You will not meet a 

personage greater than Him. (10) 

If you miss the Guru this time, you will have to wander 
in the four categories of life. (11) 

You will not find such an exalted Guru again. Do accept 
my advice at this very instant. (12) 

Why do you pride yourself upon reading books and 

singing hymns. (13) 

This pride has ruined you (in the past), and is still 

causing you great harm. (14) 

I, therefore, tell you, my dear, that this utter carelessness 
is not good. (15) 

Be quick. Give up hypocrisy. Engender love and faith 
in Guru. (16) 

If even now you do not come round and accept my 
advice, you know well what will befall you. (17) 

You are under Kal's sway. It is for this reason that 
your mind does not reconcile to those words of 
advice. (18) 

If you keep on associating with Guru and attending 
His Satsang, it is possible that slowly and gradually 
your mind may reconcile itself to Parmarth. (19) 

One thing I know my brother! 

You are a confirmed infidel. (20) 

Radhasoami declares that such Jivas will remain in 

distress. (21) 



BACHAN 19 

DEVOTION TO GURU AND NAM 



Shabd 1 
COMMANDMENTS 

*^fr "^ "cut fft -sr^r ^^>C n <\ n 

Arise and awake, my dear. I say this for thy good. (1) 

Search for the perfect Guru. I say this for thy good. (2) 

Look for the Guru who is absorbed in Shabd. I say 

this for thy good. (3) 

Serve that Guru. I say this for thy good. (4) 

Drink His Charnamrit (the wash of His Feet). I say 

this for thy good. (5) 

Partake of His Prashad (food sanctified by His touch 
or tasting). I say this for thy good. (6) 

Perform His Arti. I say this for thy good. (7) 

Sacrifice body and mind to Him. I say this for thy 

good. (8) 



Bachan 19] Commandments [323 

Follow His precepts. I say this for thy good. (9) 

Secure His pleasure. I say this for thy good. (10) 

Perform Bhajan every day regularly. I say this for thy 
good. (11) 

Have compassion for all living beings. I say this for 

thy good. (12) 

Injure none. I say this for thy good. (13) 

Pass not sarcastic remarks. I say this for thy good. (14) 

Utter not harsh words. I say this for thy good. (15) 

Make all happy. I say this for thy good. (16) 

Drink deep of the nectar of the Holy Name. I say 

this for thy good. (17) 

Cultivate tolerance and forgiveness. I say this for thy 
good. (18) 

Be contented, discreet and thoughtful. I say this for 

thy good. (19) 

Give up licentiousness and anger. I say this for thy 

good. (20) 

Drive away greed and attachement. I say this for thy 
good. " (21) 

Be humble and unassuming. I say this for thy good. (22) 

Engender love for Sants. I say this for thy good. (23) 

Do not eat much. I say this for thy good. (24) 

Keep awake during Satsang. I say this for thy good. (25) 



324] Commandments [ Bachan 

Shun name and fame. I say this for thy good. (26) 

Annihilate desires for sensual pleasure. I say this for 
thy good. (27) 

Acquire equanimity and self-restraint. I say this for 

thy good. (28) 

Do not give up devotion and renunciation. I say this 

for thy good. (29) 

Contemplate the form of Guru. I say this for thy good. (30) 

Utter nothing but the Name of Guru. I say this for thy 
good. (31) 

Praise Guru day in and day out. I say this for thy 

good. (32) 

Enhance your love for Guru. I say this for thy good. (33) 

Pilgrimages and idol-worship are delusions. I say this 
for thy good. (34) 

Forget that thou belongest to a high caste or clan. I 

say this for thy good. (35) 

Adhere not to the past ones. I say this for thy good. (36) 

Follow the Guru of the time. I say this for thy good. (37) 

Guru's Feet are the place of pilgrimage. I say this 

for thy good. (38) 

Service to Guru is real fast. I say this for thy good. (39) 

Guru's teachings constitute true knowledge. I say this 
for thy good. (40) 



19 ] Commandments [ 325 

All other knowledge is hypocrisy. I say this for thy 

good. (41) 

Give up adherence to traditions and observances. I 

say this for thy good. (42) 

Act up to Guru's words. I say this for thy good. (43) 

Do not follow Gyan-marg. I say this for thy good. (44) 

Hold fast to the path of devotion. I say this for thy 

good. (45) 

Follow the path of Surat Shabd. I say this for thy 

good. (46) 

Raise thy Surat to the third Til. I say this for thy 

good. (47) 

Then proceed to Trikuti. I say this for thy good. (48) 

Enter the tenth aperture, viz., Sunn. I say this for thy 
good. (49) 

Come up to Bhanwargupha. I say this for thy good. (50) 

Effect entrance into Sat Lok. I say this for thy good. (51) 

Attain Alakh and Agam. I say this for thy good. (52) 

Adore the Holy Name Radhasoami. i say this for thy 

good. (53) 

Put an end to all wanderings and entanglements. I 

say this for thy good. (54) 

Stick tenaciously to Guru. I say this for thy good. (55) 



326 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Shabd 2 

f^TT fl# ^f ^T II <t II 

O dear! Perform Dhyan of Guru. You cannot be liberated 
without it. (1) 

Be dyed in the colour of Nam and you will attain Nij 

Dharm (Original Abode). (2) 

Adopt the Saran of Guru firmly. Without this, your 

task will not be accomplished. (3) 

Why cherish (worldly) name and gain, 

When pay back you have to again ? (4) 

Whatever Karams (actions) you perform, you will have 
to undergo their consequences. (5) 

Take courage and free yourself from the entanglements 
of the world, somehow or the other. (6) 

Those who have subdued their minds, are verily brave. (7) 

Your mind is your arch enemy. It*is difficult to subdue 
it (8) 

Pursue it tenaciously. Leave all other efforts. (9) 

First, engender love for Guru, and then apply yourself 
internally to Shabd. (10) 

Act upon these two injunctions of Mine. You need 

not make any other efforts. (11) 

When you have succeeded in vanquishing your mind, 
raise your Surat to Gagan (sky, heavenly regions). (12) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 327 

Apply yourself to this activity alone. All other activities 
of the world are false and useless. Discard them 
all. (13) 

Radhasoami lays stress on the Saran of Nam. (14) 



Shabd 3 

tf^t f^r cEfa ^rrbrr t 
^^r^T Tgtim it q u 

Who else but the Guru will emancipate you? Who 

else but the Nam will reform you? (1) 

Without Bhajan, who will secure release for you? Without 
Saran, who will mend and correct you? (2) 

Without longing and yearning, who will pray earnestly? 
Without pain or affliction, who will remember the 
Name of the Supreme Father? (3) 

Without Shabd, who will embellish you? Without 

Satsang, who will take care of you? (4) 

Who will crush Kai and how will Karams be eradicated 
and exhausted? (5) 

A Sant will come to your help and rescue. Some Bhakt 
(devotee) will burn both Kal and Karams. (6) 

The task of the devotee will be accomplished by 
Satsang .only. But he has to sacrifice his body 
and mind. (7) 

He alone will adopt Nij Nam and redeem the world. (8) 



328 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

He will effect regeneration of Jivas. He will remove 

their pride, egotism and infatuation. (9) 

He who sincerely takes the Saran of Sat Guru, will 
alone behold the Nam Pad (Region of Nam). (10) 

He who praises Radhasoami, will secure admittance 
into that Region. (11) 



Shabd 4 

TO fsFT ^ft 1 Tkl "3*nT II <* H 

Without Guru, you can never be redeemed. Without 
Nam, you can never secure the salvation of your 
soul. (1) 

Without Satsang, you can never get to the reality. Without 
Prem, you can never meet the Beloved. (2) 

Without Surat Shabd Yoga, you can never rise to 

Gagan. Without Daya (grace and mercy), the massive 
barriers will not open. (3) 

Without Surat, Shabd cannot be contacted. Without 
Nirat, Dhun (Shabd) cannot become your prop and 
support. (4) 

First of all, engender love for Guru. Then can you drink 
the nectar of Nam, by subduing your mind. (5) 

Quit this world, taking it to be Kal's domain. Come 
to the abode of the Dayal (Merciful) and make 
your life fruitful. (6) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 329 

In the company of Guru, you will attain the status of 
Sant. You will contact Shabd and get admittance 
to the fourth Pad (Region). (7) 

Radhasoami has spoken of things most sublime. 
One who listens to and acts upon them, will be 
redeemed. (8) 



Shabd 5 
^r sj=r sir ft, <nr *frr ft^w n ^ u 

^ tr «frm ^tt ii h ii 

O Surat! Listen to Dhun (Shabd, sound). Give up 
pleasures of the world, which are worthless. Wife, 
progeny, wealth and name and fame are of no 
avail. (1) 

Worldly honour and reputation will bring you no 

comfort and peace. (2) 

If you engage in Bhakti (devotion) to Sat Guru and 
drink the bliss of Nam you will secure entrance 
into the eternal region. (3) 

If you attend Satsang whole-heartedly, you will attain 
Sat Nam. (4) 

Raise your Surat to higher regions where Dhun is 

audible all the time. (5) 

Then you will make your human life truly fruitful and 

you will find rest and peace in Shabd. (6) 



330 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

The drum of breath is beating perpetually as a warning 
to eventual departure from here. (7) 

Radhasoami has provided a boat. Get across the 

ocean of Universe free of any charge. (8) 



Shabd 6 

clTT U% S& 3TT^T?T II 1 II 

O Surat! Hear me. Your Lord dwells high above. (1) 

Forsake the company of this paramour (mind). Behold 
the refulgence of your beloved Lord. (2) 

Follow Guru, and you will find abode in the unchange- 
able region. (3) 

Take the Saran of Sadh, so that you may get an 

abode in Shabd. (4) 

The body, you are caged in, belongs to Kal. Why do 
you cherish hopes and expectations from an 
alien? (5) 

The noose of the pleasures of the ten senses has 

been put around your neck. (6) 

You are tied down to nine apertures. You have no 

rest even for a single breath. (7) 

Open the tenth window, and enjoy true bliss. (8) 

The perfect Sat Guru gives you this advice. You should 
believe Him and accept His words. (9) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 331 

Utter the Holy Name RADHASOAMI. All Karams will 
be eradicated. (10) 



Shabd 7 

O Surat! Why have you become mad? Your life is 

being wasted. (1) 

You are passing your days in worldly enjoyments and 
sufferings; you will go empty handed. (2) 

You will suffer tortures in hell and then fall into the 

cycle of transmigration. (3) 

Who will help you there? You should accept my advice 
now. (4) 

Engender love for Guru. O brother, do what He bids 

you to do. (5) 

Unite your Surat with Shabd. Practise this Yoga every 
day. (6) 

Your lot will improve day by day. Kal will not then 

harass you. (7) 

You will enjoy the indescribable bliss of Shabd. The 
mind will easily turn away from the pleasures of 
the world. (8) 

You will rise upwards from the sixth centre and secure 
access to Sahas-dal-kanwal. (9) 



332 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

The moment you get beyond the sixth Chakra or the 
third Til, you will see lightning and hear the 
resounding of Anhad Shabd. (10) 

Suns and moons will then become visible. Your mind 
and Surat will come in touch with Sukhmana (the 
middle current). (11) 

You will see the marvellous form of Guru, the refulgence 
and glory of which cannot be described. (12) 

When Guru manifests Himself in human form, He draws 
and raises your mind. (13) 

He helps you proceed further. Your mind, asleep for 
ages, will then wake up. (14) 

Passing through Banknal, you will come to Trikuti and 
then to Sunn, and see the Mansarovar lake. (15) 

The region where Hansas (celestial beings) abide in 
all gracefulness, is extremely fascinating. (16) 

The melodious Kingri (fiddle) is audible there, hearing 
which, your Surat will get intoxicated. (17) 

You will go to Maha-sunn, where Achint Dweep has 

been carefully designed. (18) 

On seeing Bhanwargupha, illumined by the white refulgent 
sun, you will become detached from all. (19) 

You will prepare yourself for the fourth Pad (Region), 
you will hear the melody of the Bin (harp). (20) 

You will behold Alakh and Agam, and get Darshan of 
Radhasoami. (21) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 333 

His glory and majesty beggar all description. He has done 
a lot for a poor and destitute person like myself. (22) 



Shabd 8 

fina^l **$$ ^ W* 'WW II $Zt II 

^ft ^nr 3n«nr n <i u 

O Virahni (sick' at heart)! Take Saran of your Guru. 
In this world, there js none who is your true friend. 
So stick to Nam. (1) 

Join your Surat (spirit-current) to Shabd. Barriers will 
be removed and doors to higher regions will be 
thrown open. (2) 

Mire of Kam (desire, passion) and Krodh (anger) will 
be removed and you will bathe in the pure current 
of spirituality. (3) 

Anhad Shabd is resounding in Gagan Mandal (Trikuti). 
Hear it and make it your support. (4) 

Without Sant, no one can reach the ultimate and final 
goal. Therefore, follow a Sant. (5) 

Radhasoami is your well-wisher. He addresses you 

for your own good. (6) 

He who accepts His words, will merge in the Ultimate 
Goal, and come to know of the most sublime 
secrets. (7) 



334 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Shabd 9 

■gjw wt w^ srte^ TFT 3ft II "Ni II 

^ "^mcT cR # II 1 II 

By associating with Sat Guru, Surat washes her mind, 
enhances love and faith every moment and 
surrenders the body. (1) 

Thus purified, Surat enjoys the bliss of Shabd, and, turning 
upwards, ascends to the region of thunder. (2) 

She withdraws from the five senses, twentyfive Prakritis 
(properties) and three Gunas (qualities). (3) 

She becomes absorbed in Dhun (Shabd) and does 
not disclose the state of bliss to anybody. (4) 

How can she disclose it to those who have never 

tasted and experienced this bliss? (5) 

Pandit (learned), Gyani (wise) and Bhekh (ascetic) 
are all deluded. They are engaged in pilgrimage, 
fasting, rites, etc. (6) 

How can they get this most excellent bliss of Shabd? 
They are always busy in spreading the net of 
delusions and illusions. (7) 

Who will explain all this to them? They do not heed 

the words of Sant. (8) 

The six Shastras (books or systems of philosophy), 
Smriti (ancient codes of laws) and Puran (books 
of theology and mythology), all follow the beaten 
track. They do not give up old practices. (9) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 335 

They worship Shiva, Shakti and Ganesh. Who is to 

point out to them their mistakes? (10) 

They teach the worship of Vishnu, the sun and various 
gods. (11) 

They have no idea of Guru Bhakti (devotion to Guru) 
and the eminence of Sants. (12) 

They do not heed the counsel imparted to them for their 
good. Why should I then care for them? (13) 

Radhasoami points out the way. Catch hold of Dhun 
(Shabd) within you. (14) 



Shabd 10 

^r «wR«ji eta ^rrf ii s n 

O my mind! Go to Guru-ghat 1 , and get the sheet of 
your Surat washed clean, with the soap of Sewa, 
the rubbing of Darshan, the water of Prem, the 
Reh 2 of Bachans, the Bhathi 3 of faith, and the 
fire of Virah (pangs of separation). (1-3) 

Remove dirt and impurity by squeezing and rinsing it 
in the. river of Bhakti (devotion), flowing day and 
night. (4) 



1. Ghat =A-place for washing clothes, on the bank of a river or 
tank. 2. Reh = Fossil alkali, used for washing and making soap. 
3. Bhathi = washerman's boiler or copper. 



336 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

When the sheet of Surat is thus cleansed and bright- 
ened, the mind puts it on with great delight. (5) 

The mind and Surat go up in the company of Shabd 

and arrive at Trikuti. (6) 

The Surat ascends to Sunn and attains the status of 
a Hansa. In Maha-sunn, she attains a still more 
radiant form. (7) 

She hears 'Sohang' in Bhanwargupha, and 'Sat Sat' 

in Sat Lok. (8) 

Meeting Alakh and Agam, she merges in the Holy 

Feet of Radhasoami. (9) 



Shabd 11 

Turn and look within yourself. Why do you wander 

about in the wilderness? (1) 

Guru exhorts you every moment to perform Sumiran 
day and night. (2) 

Enshrine the image of Guru within yourself and make 
your wanton mind steady. (3) 

Then direct your Surat towards the door to higher 

regions, and penetrate the third Til. (4) 

Sit quietly there, i.e., in Gagan, and apply your mind 
to the current of Shabd. (5) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 337 

Fix your Surat in Sunn. Do not wander about in the 

regions of the three Gunas (qualities). (6) 

Why do you fall a victim to the forces of evils and 

vices? (7) 

Your life has been wasted in deceptions and delusions. 
Now, search for Shabd. (8) 

Always move in the company of Sant. Do not run 

after wealth, honour and reputation. (9) 

Control your mind and senses. Engage yourself in 

this effort only. (10) 

In course of time, you will be able to subdue your 
mind and senses; and then you will hear Nad 
(Shabd). (11) 

Thereafter, it will not take long to awaken your latent 
spirituality. You will be immersed in the bliss of 
melodious Shabds (sounds). (12) 

Now, fall at the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. He will 

accomplish your task in a moment. (13) 



Shabd 12 

^fr ^ TR 3^^ «R I 
■Ere - 3 *ts fmit M ii <i ii 

Listen to Anhabd Shabd. See the macrocosm in the 
microcosm within you. (1) 

Apply yourself to Shabd Abhyas taught by Guru. Enjoying 
the bliss of Shabd, go on penetrating within. (2) 



338 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Turn round the wheel (above third Til) and Shabd will 
become audible to you. (3) 

Sat Guru says that without Nam, you cannot secure 
access to higher regions. (4) 

Now attend Satsang and adopt the Saran of Guru. (5) 

Know that the'pleasures of the world are diseases 
and the desire for wealth and property is a source 
of misery and pain. (6) 

Vast is the ocean of worldly existence. All are getting 
drowned in it. (7) 

Without Guru, nobody can get across. Without Nam, 
none can be steady and patient. (8) 

Now, take care of Surat, so that you may contact 

Shabd. (9) 

You are led astray by pains and pleasures of body, 

mind and senses. (10) 

You have wasted your life in following the dictates of 
ego and self. You never cared to know about your 
Creator. (11) 

Now think over the matter calmly and control your 

mind somewhat within yourself. (12) 

Then only your Surat can meet Shabd. This is what 

Radhasoami says. (13) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 339 

Shabd 13 

Guru declares that the whole world is blind and ignorant. 
Nobody cares to know what is within. (1) 

All are lost in outward f (worldly) activities. No one 

adopts internal Shabd (sound). (2)" 

Their minds are absorbed in the pleasures of the world. 
As a consequence of their Karams, they are under- 
going great ups and downs all the time. (3) 

Ensnared by Kal, Jivas have become dirty. (4) 

Guru repeatedly enjoins upon them to seek Shabd 

within themselves. (5) 

But they do not pay heed to Guru's «N Bain (words). 
Then how can their inner eye be opened? (6) 

Only some rare deserving Jiva will follow the words 

of Guru. (7) 

The mind plays trick and creates confusion when one 
takes to Guru's advice. (8) 

Kal shows his trickeries to Jivas and deceives them 

in one way or the other. (9) 

Kal does not allow them to perform Guru Bhakti. He 
creates obstacles in various ways. (10) 

Sometimes, Kal beguiles Jivas in the form of a friend, 
at other times, he acts as an enemy giving 
threats. (11) 



340 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Sometimes Kal inflicts illness on Jivas. He spreads 

his nets in various ways. (12) 

Jivas thus cannot enjoy the bliss of Shabd. They are 
always in troubles of one kind or the other. (13) 

He, on whom Guru is kind and gracious escapes 
the onslaughts of Kal, by applying himself to 
Shabd. (14) 

He, who has experienced the bliss of Shabd, will not 
be affected by the fire (pain, sorrow, anguish) of 
the world. (15) 

Only Guru Bhakti (devotion to Guru) is TTNt Sanchi 
(true and reliable). All else is ^rrVt Kanchi 
(imperfect and incomplete.) (16) 

Those Jivas who have taken the Saran of Radhasoami, 
shall be redeemed. (17) 

<* & x> 
Shabd 14 



fgK ^f "5l£ "gill qFjfT^ I 
ft$ ^ fT^ ^? Tff^ II S II 



The Surat does not ascend. What should be done? 
So long as it does not quit the body, you will 
remain in grief. (1) 

The mind does not come round. It is steeped in perversity 
and error. It is being consumed in the fire of 
sensual pleasures. (2) 

Under the sway of Karams and three Gunas, the Jiva 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 341 

is always in a state of fear. He undergoes pain 

and pleasure. (3) 

Take Guru's Saran and place your head at His Holy 

Feet. There is no other remedy. (4) 

When the nectar of Nam has saturated your"^RGhat 
(inner being or self), withdraw your Surat and raise 
it to Gagan. (5) 

Only Sant Mat is true; it takes your Surat to Shabd. 

Do adopt it. (6) 

Your mind will rise and stop at Gagan (Trikuti). Your 
Surat will unite with Shabd and enjoy its bliss. (7) 

In Sunn, you will make an inquiry regarding onward 
journey (through Maha-sunn). You will reach Home 
and enjoy perfect happiness and bliss. (8) 

Utter Guru's Name and the mind will be curbed. The 
task will be completed when the Surat gets to 
Sat Lok. (9) 

The true home is beyond Alakh and Agam. Settle 

down at the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (10) 



Shabd 15 

\ ^r ^nt «f"Ui*0 ii i ii 

We know Guru will redeem us. O Surat! Why are 

you agitated and demented? (1) 



342 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Cling to Shabd firmly. Kal can cause no harm to you (2) 

Lose your identity in Shabd. Listen to none else. (3) 

Adopt Guru Mat. Give up all illusions and delusions, 

doubts and misgivings. (4) 

Ascend to, and take your seat in the inaccessible 
and unapproachable Region called Radhasoami 
Dham. (5) 



Shabd 16 

%TT ^T tR ^TT ?pf 3f II <1 II 

Why do you not take the Saran of Guru? Your human 
life is being wasted in delusions. (1) 

Why do you lose your capital in the company of wife, 
son. family, etc., who are all Thugs? (2) 

Why do you not ponder over the fact that the world 

is unreal? (3) 

The mind is a fool. It is allured by the world. How 
can it extricate itself from these meshes? (4) 

No remedy can be effective without Guru. One may take 
any measure, one will only tire oneself out. (5) 

O friend! Stick to Nam. Have patience and withdraw 
within. (6) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [343 

Look to the Mauj of the Beloved. Whatever He 
ordains is for your good. (7) 

Yhur intellect is soiled, your mind unsteady and wavering. 
That is why you lose. (8) 

You are not aware of the secrets, so you are getting 
entangled in the net of delusions and deceptions. (9) 

Know that there is no friend and helper except Guru,. (10) 

Remember the high and exalted status of Guru. Join 
your Surat to Nij Shabd. (11) 

There is none except Shabd which can liberate you 

from this noose. (12) 

Therefore, open the door to Shabd with the master- 
key provided by Guru. (13) 

No one can detain a ^g^Gurumukh. He will effect 
his entry into the mansion. (14) 

A H-i*i*2iMan-rmukh, on the other hand, will go astray. 
He will rise and fall again and again. (15) 

A Man-mukh will not secure a resting place. How far 
should Guru explain these things? (16) 

A Man-mukh will not give up the dictates of his mind. 
He will blame Guru (for his failure). (17) 

He will not adopt the path and method shown by 

Guru. (18) 

Then how can a Man-mukh accomplish his task? He 
will be pushed and jostled about by Jama. (19) 



344 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Radhasoami, therefore, enjoins upon you to convert 
your antagonistic mind into a friend. (20) 



Shabd 17 

TR TTRt rR $H ^nft I 
f^ft TFT ^fTtT faUlO II <* it 

Curb the mind and control brutish tendencies. Give 

up the pleasures of the senses. (1) 

Exercise control on slumber and idleness. Listen to 

Shabd intently, in the company of Guru. (2) 

Attend Satsang, and have Darshan of Guru daily. (3) 

Why do you allow your mind to get the upper hand 
on you every time? Banish worldly desires. (4) 

Cast off all these delusions. Then will you see your 

home. (5) 

Ascend and open the door to Gagan (Trikuti). Enter 

Daswan Dwar (tenth door). (6) 

Then, get across Maha-sunn and see the refulgence 
of Bhanwargupha. (7) 

Then you will find most adorable Satnarm. Go on to 

Alakh and Agam. (8) 

By the grace of the most munificent Sat Guru, you 
will enter Radhasoami Dharm, which is boundless 
and infinite. (9) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 345 



Shabd 18 

t^t^ ^TT cRf T?HT II <\ 11 

O brother! Make for your true and real home. Why 

stay in an alien land? (1) 

Go on accomplishing your own task. Do not get 

involved in the aliens' job. (2) 

(Work out the salvation of your Surat. Do not get engrossed 
in the activities which strengthen the body and the mind, 
for that is the work of Kal and Maya, who are aliens. 
That is not your work.) 

Enshrine the Name of Guru within and proceed onward. 
This is the real earning which you will carry 
with you. (3) 

The world is all round dirty. Get yourself washed. Act 
upon this advice. (4) 

The pleasures of the world are transitory. Give them 

up one by one. (5) 

Adopt firmly the Saran of Guru. Do this and do it 

vigorously. (6) 

Steady your mind and Surat within. Look up to Gagan 
and catch the Dhun. (7) 

You cannot be free by any other measure. You have 
been badly entangled in the meshes. (8) 



346 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Guru now graciously gives His teachings. Accept His 
words and act accordingly. (9) 

Why are you wasting your life for nothing? Nowhere 
will you be able to achieve your object. (10) 

Withdraw your diffused spirituality, and concentrate it 
at the focus of the eyes. (11) 

Duality, viz., the feeling of mine and thine, will disappear 
here. Fix your gaze at the Jyoti (flame). (12) 

Quit the Shyarm (black), the third Til, and hold on to 
the Sait (white), Sahas-dal-kanwal. Hear the Dhun 
by straining your Surat. (13) 

Enter Banknal and get on to Trikuti. (14) 

Then secure entrance to Sunn, and let your Surat 

bathe in the Mansarovar lake. (15) 

The vast expanse of Maha-sunn is dark. From there, 
proceed to Bhanwargupha. (16) 

Gracefully enter the fourth Lok (Sat Lok) and hear 

melodious «fto Bin (harp). (17) 

Beyond Alakh and Agam will be seen a marvellous 

mansion. (18) 

There, you will meet Radhasoami and become most 
delighted. (19) 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 347 

Shabd 19 

Proceed carefully. The world is a place of fraud and 
deception. Give up pride and egotism. The mind 
is very gross and coarse. (1) 

Give up Khudi (self, ego). Perform devotion, or you 
will suffer loss and be beaten with clubs. (2) 

Attend Guru's Satsang. Swing your Surat to Gagan 

(sky, heaven). (3) 

Be delighted within. Conquer the fort of Trikuti (4) 

Your relation with your kith and kin is for four days 
only. Why do you forget yourself in their 
company? (5) 

Perform Bhajan internally and take the Saran of Guru's 
Holy Feet. (6) 

There is no true companion except Guru. Sit near 

Him and pulverize your mind. (7) 

He will accomplish your task, and unburden you of 

your load of sins. (8) 

You will then be dyed in the colour of Nam. Lie down 
on the bed of Shabd. (9) 

Your dormant lot has brightened greatly. Your mind 

has become a parrot of the heavens. (10) 

It had been sleeping for ages. It has now awakened 
in a moment. (11) 



348 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 

Ponder over the true nature of the world. There is no 
reality in it. It is all hollow. (12) 

Turn away from the world, and churn your mind. Why 
do you waste your precious time? (13) 

Guru has now showered His grace upon you. He has 
put Kal on the wrong track. (14) 

Radhasoami says to you, "I invite you to Sat Lok. 

Come along." (15) 



Shabd 20 

aft tr ^3" w wm i 

^ ^f ^3TT ^falT II <* II 

O mind! Look at the world. What is it worth? You 
are here entrapped in illusions and delusions. (1) 

You are full of evil tendencies. Adopt measures to 

cast them off. (2) 

You will then realize this world to be unreal and hollow. 
Carefully stick to the Holy Feet of Guru. (3) 

You will be initiated by Him in the most sublime Nam. 
You will then see the way to Moksh (emancipation) 
within your ^R Ghat (inside). (4) 

Begin to follow Shabd. You will find that it is the 

essence of all essences. (5) 

Why are you wandering in the regions below the eyes? 



19 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ 349 

Peep through the window of the third faeT Til, and 
get on to the other side. (6) 

You will learn the mode of devotional practices from 
Guru. Without His assistance, this door or window 
cannot be opened. (7) 

Curb your mind, and apply your Surat to devotional 

exercises with love and affection. (8) 

Your Surat will then proceed with the Dhun to the 
region where Amrit (nectar) is dripping every 
moment. (9) 

Drink the bliss of Nam and be vigilant. Riddhi 1 and 

Siddhi 2 will be standing at your door. (10) 

Do not accept them (Riddhi and Siddhi). Keep on 

going onward. (11) 

Proceed and attain the Darbar of Radhasoami which 
is the goal and essence of all spiritual endeavours 
and internal practices. (12) 



Shabd 21 

3T^ 3Rfi" ^jnr tffraTT i 
^ -f^r ^r cmrefr m n q ii 

Surat is drifting in the mid-stream. Who else except 

Guru can ferry it across? (1) 

1. Prosperity personified as the wife of Kuber, the god of 
riches. 2. Supernatural power or faculty. 



350 ] Devotion to Guru and Nam [ Bachan 19 

Jiva is grossly attached to the world. Who can release 
him except Nam? (2) 

Jiva does not make Nam his prop and support. He 

does not engender love for Guru. (3) 

He has incurred a heavy load of Karams. Kal has 

got all the Jivas in his strong grip. (4) 

Nobody befriends a Sadh. All have developed conceit 
and egotism. (5) 

All are in error due to their base understanding. They 
never care for good counsel. (6) 

Though endowed with the precious human form, 
nobody is vigilant enough. All run after pleasures, 
and become unmindful and negligent of their 
real interest. (7) 

The mind has cast a net in the world, into which all 

have ultimately fallen. (8) 

Radhasoami calls on you loudly to carefully grasp 

His Holy Feet. (9) 



BACHAN 20 



THE PRACTICE OF 
SURAT SHABD YOGA 



Shabd 1 

tr tr sft ^ tffa ^41* 11 q 11 

Come along my friend. I will today unite you with the 
Beloved and enable you to give up attachment 
for body, mind and riches. (1) 

I will enable you to secure release from the attach- 
ments of wife and son and hear the wondrous 
Shabd of Sunn. (2) 

I will seat you on a high celestial throne and confer 
on you the sovereignty of the three worlds. (3) 

I will enable you to bathe in Triveni and release you 
from the hold of mind which is drifting towards 
Maya. (4) 

I will save you from the wheel of Kal in no time, and 



352 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

take you to Nij Ghar (Original Home), after eradicating 
Karams. (5) 

After crossing the regions of Maha-sunn and Bhanwar- 
gupha, I will enable you to have Darshan of 
Sat Purush. (6) 

The Purush will give you such a telescope that you 

will penetrate beyond Alakh and Agam. (7) 

Your Surat will then recognize the region of Radhasoami. 
All speech and description end here. (8) 



Shabd 2 

wft ft "^tt 3to 3t h ^rft i 

*ll# ft ^T 3T5T tfr ^TSt I] S II 

O Surat! Wake up. Make no delay. Come on and 

ascend to Gagan. (1) 

Run away from the world, and meet the Beloved. 
Apply yourself to Shabd and enjoy the bliss. (2) 

Look up. Awaken 'Nirat'. Peep, and behold the form 

of Guru. (3) 

Bathe yourself and fill in water, and contemplate the 

form of Guru. (4) 

Sing the praises of Guru. Embark on Journey 

homeward. Be happy in the company of the beloved 
Guru. (5) 

Behold the latticed screen and utter Nam. Leave 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 353 

Banknal. Catch hold of Dhun coming from Gagan 
(Trikuti). (6) 

Leave Sunn, go to Maha-sunn and halt at Bhanwar- 

gupha. (7) 

Be drenched in the bliss of Satnarm in Sat Lok. Find 

abode beyond Alakh and Agam. (8) 

Recite RADHASOAMI RAD HAS OAM I , repeatedly. 
Much have I said. Let us now stop. (9) 



Shabd 3 

tfte sm qft -^ wi ii q a 

O my brother! Perform Bhakti and engender love for 
Radhasoami. (1) 

You have a marvellous opportunity. Radhasoami has 
now graciously come here. (2) 

Make a fence of Sewa and Darshan. Let plants of 

Shabd grow and bloom. (3) 

Brandish the sword of Surat and cut off the head of 

Kal. (4) 

Effect your ingress into Sunn where bright moonlight 
is visible. (5) 

Quit Shyarm (black), meet Sait Pad (Sunn) and lovingly 
enter Daswan Dwar. (6) 



354 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Pass through Maha-sunn and break open the door 

to Bhanwargupha. (7) 

Merge in the Shabd Pad (Sat Lok), and sing the 
praises of Alakh Purush and Agam Purush. (8) 

Radhasoami has revealed the inaccessible and 
unapproachable. Complete Saran has now been 
adopted. (9) 



Shabd 4 

«F>r?r ^ft ^sF x4c4Prr n <\ ii 

Beware. Jama has spread his net, and Kal has put 

his wheel in motion. (1) 

Take Saran of Sat Guru. You will be saved from 

Chaurasi. (2) 

Turn back and withdraw within yourself. You will enter 
the eye of the needle. (3) 

Catch hold of your mind and withdraw it inward. You 
will hear Anhad Shabd. (4) 

Follow in the direction of Jyoti. You will behold 

Niranjan. (5) 

Ascend to Banknal and penetrate Trikuti. You will attain 
Atrma Pad in Sunn. (6) 

Leave Kal's boundary. You will enter Dayal Desh. (7) 

Establish a link with Sant, and you will be able to 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 355 

break open the portal to Gagan (sky, heavenly 
region). (8) 

Crack the whip of Nirat. The horse of Surat will gallop. (9) 

Shoot the arrow of Surat. The whirl of Bhanwargupha 
will rotate. (10) 

Go on merging into Shabd after Shabd. You will attain 
Param Pad. (11) 

Hear the melodious Bin (harp). Your Surat will be 

absorbed in its bliss. (12) 

Now meet the Beloved, and you will behold the Sat 

Roop (true form) of your Surat. (13) 

See the refulgence of Alakh. You will enter Agam 

Lok. (14) 

Radhasoami has enriched me. I place my head at 

His Holy Feet. (15) 



Shabd 5 

*FSR ~$Z tlTT T?t TR $ II %3» II 

*ft TTt ?gm if II 1 II 

Perform Bhajan and be happy within. Those who shirk 
Bhajan will have to suffer. (1) 

They will be overpowered by sleep and laziness. They 
will remain steeped in doubts and misgivings. (2) 

They will get pushes and jolts from Kam (desire, passion) 



356 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

and Krodh (anger), and will drown into the river 

of Lobh (greed, avarice). (3) 

They do not engender sincere love for Guru nor do 

they hold firmly to the cord of Nam. (4) 

Day and night, they burn in the fire of Trishna (passions 
and desires), and are hurled down into the hell 
below. (5) 

They become inimical to Sants, and indulge in wrong 
dogmas. (6) 

They do not know the importance of Satsang. They 
always behave and act blindly like a flock of 
sheep. (7) 

They desire money, honour and pleasures. Hence, they 
remain overwhelmed by illness and sorrow. (8) 

These unlucky and unwise persons are simply wasting 
their human form. (9) 

They always behave in this manner. How can I convince 
them? (10) 

They do not heed what Sadh and Guru say. They obstinately 
stick to the dictates of their minds. (11) 

Know they are like donkeys and dogs. They uselessly 
fill their bellies. (12) 

Hurled into hell, they will repent a lot. But who will 
be there to listen to their lamentations? (13) 

For countless lives, they will remain in Chaurasi. They 
will not get the human form again. (14) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 357 

You are blessed with this precious human form. Behave 
in such a manner that you may save yourself. (15) 

Adopt Saran of Sat Guru this time. Your task will 

then be accomplished. (16) 

Sat Guru kindly gives you advice for your good. But 

you do not listen to Him. (17) 

Blind and deaf you are moving here like a destitute 
fellow. All your family members and relations are 
spelling your ruin. (18) 

Accept this advice. Attend Satsang. Your ears and 

eyes will open. (19) 

You will behold the dazzling flame and hear the wonderful 
Dhuns internally. (20) 

You will go to Sunn and bathe in Triveni, picking up 

diamonds, pearls and rubies. (21) 

When you ascend to pass through Maha-sunn, Sat 

Guru will accompany you. (22) 

When the flute of Bhanwargupha becomes audible to 
you, Kal will dash his head in utter despair. (23) 

(Maha-sunn is the final stage of Kal and Maha-kal. Without the 
constant company and assistance of Sat Guru, it is not possible 
for the spirit entity to pass through this impregnable region. The 
moment the flute of Bhanwargupha, the first spiritual region on 
the journey homeward, becomes audible to the Surat, Maha Kal 
knows that the spirit entity has escaped his region. He admits his 
defeat and dashes his head in utter despair.) 

Your Surat will then go to the Darbar (court) of Sat 
Purush, and hear the Dhun of the Bin (harp). (24) 



358 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Having received a Dur-been (telescope), you will march 
on to Alakh and Agam. (25) 

From there, you will proceed further and merge in 

the Holy Feet of Radhasoami. (26) 

You attain the final abode of rest and peace, sustenance 
and support. The bliss of that region cannot be 
described in words. (27) 



Shabd 6 

^ "srHt -&rik -om n s n 
Hearken me, and come along. (1) 

Why do you fall a victim to the treachery of Kal, and 

are getting yourself kicked by Jama? (2) 

Proceed towards Gagan; the doors of higher regions 
will be opened. (3) 

Resolve to tread the internal path and you will be released 
from the reversed position you are in. (4) 

Fill the jar of Surat with the bliss of Shabd. Ascend 

to Banknal and open Sukhmana. (5) 

I have tasted the wonderful bliss of Nam. I now sleep 
comfortably on the : sne Khat (cot). (6) 

The knot of ^cR Chetan (spirit) and w^ Jarh (matter) 
has been untied. The mind turns heels over head 
like a rope-dancer. (7) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 359 

I see the Mansarovar lake of vast dimensions. The 

barrier to Sunn is removed. (8) 

Kal is beheaded. The hard and difficult knot of Karams 
is untied. (9) 

The bliss of the region of Sunn is distributed as if a 
market of Shabd was opened in the heart. (10) 

TTte Moh (attachment, infatuation and A Mad (pride) 
run away helter-skelter and I find my beloved Sat 
Guru. (11) 

I am now happy as a child who finds his parents. It 

is not meet to describe this further. (12) 

Maya can now cause no harm. She fell down like dry 
leaves from the tree. (13) 

Karam has been defeated. In Sunn a melodious Dhun 
is heard. (14) 

My link with Pind has been severed. Guru has shown 
me a wonderful illumination. (15) 

I have attained peace. I have now no doubts or 

misgivings. (16) 

Guru has granted the gift of Prem. My Surat has 

become one with Shabd. (17) 

I now day and night remain absorbed in Shabd. I cannot 
part with the bliss of Shabd any more. (18) 

I now sing the praises of Guru every moment. I am 
free from bodily ties and bondages. I have attained 
Amar Pad (Sat Lok). (19) 



360 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

The sound of Nam is coming from the Highest Region. 
The whole firmament is moving like a spinning 
wheel. (20) 

Radhasoami has graciously placed His hand on my 
head. I will never forsake His company. (21) 



Shabd 7 

TO «0 ^TT 7T^ SJ/T igfi I 

wt x*% *k$ fa eft wrr II <\ II 

Listen to the Dhun of Nam and ponder over it. Enhancing 
your love and zeal, ascend to Gagan. (1) 

Associate with Guru. Mix with Sadhs. Always be vigilant 
and attentive. (2) 

Steady your mind. Take the Saran of Guru. Hold fast 
to the Holy Feet and taste the unattainable nectar 
of bliss. (3) 

Be patient. Cultivate humility. Burn Krodh (anger). Be 
calm and cool. (4) 

Crush the forces of Kal. Go to the region of Dayal 
(Merciful) Get into Param Pad (Highest Region) 
and be delighted. (5) 

The Journey will commence when the door of "^ Ghat 
(inner recesses) opens. You will enter the third 
Til and get to Shyam Pad. (6) 

You will seek ^ff "^ Sait Pad (region of luminous 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 361 

rays), behold Jyoti (flame), contact Sukhmana and 
enter Banknal. (7) 

The Dhun of the conch will become audible. Apply 
your Surat assiduously to it. Secrets and mysteries 
will then be unfolded and Nad or Anhad Shabd 
will be audible. (8) 

Surat will ascend to Sunn, bathe in the Mansarovar 
lake, attain the status of a Hansa and rush to the 
moon. (9) 

Surat will go on penetrating, reach Mahasunn, come 
to the special path, and become a swift winged 
bird. (10) 

Surat will penetrate the fort of Bhanwargupha, and hear 
the sound of Sohang Sohang and the melody of the 
flute. It will taste the ambrosia of that region. (11) 

Surat will enter the fourth Pad, viz, Sat Lok, engender 
love for Sat Purush, and hear the true sound of 
the Bin (harp). (12) 

Surat will come to Alakh, witness the wonderful panorama 
of Agam, go to the true Home, and complete its 
task. (13) 

Only the final and ultimate region now remains. Its 
secrets which were Gupt or hidden so far have 
now been revealed. I go to RADHASOAMI, and 
place my head at His Holy Feet. (14) 



362 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Shabd 8 

wrrfr f\ ■fel^grf wr if &6 Vm\ i 
^JtT H TZfm Tfti tts? m 'tfcTOf II <i n 

Open the door. Come to the balcony. Let not your 
Surat get dissipated. Let it enjoy the company of 
Shabd. (1) 

Learn the secrets and mysteries. Be free from death. 
Make your life fruitful. Awaken Nirat. Peep into 
the lane of Guru. (2) 

Let your Surat rush forward. Adopt Saran. Be delighted 
in the bliss of Nam. (3) 

Seek pristine purity. Ward off Jama (the angel of death). 
Get rid of the thoughts and reveries of the mind. 
Unite with Radhasoami Shabd. (4) 



Shabd 9 

^m "ft <*\M tr *mta fan PwT u <* it 

Throw away Lobh (greed, avarice). Crush Kam (desire, 
passion). Burn Krodh (anger). Be contented, and 
practise patience. (1) 

Wash off impurities. Ascend to Gagan. Be relieved 
of anguish and pain. Hold fast to the Holy feet of 
Guru. (2) 

Cast off egotism. The three Gunas will flee away. 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 363 

Apply yourself to Parmarth vigorously. Be alert and 
awake day and night. (3) 

Sing the praises of Guru. Rush to Dhun or Shabd. 
Extinguish the fire of anger and lust. Radhasoami 
will give tranquillity and impart rest and repose. (4) 



Shabd 10 

^> ^ TarrcT ^ *n? t 

■RTT ¥T*Z 3^TTf^ •3TTf II q It 

Guru enjoins upon you to apply yourself to Anhad 

Shabd. (1) 

Without Shabd, there is no other remedy by which 
you can escape from the pitcher of the body. (2) 

Guru shows you mansion within mansion, and gives 
out secrets of the five different sounds resounding 
in their five respective spheres. (3) 

Now apply your Surat to Dhun or Shabd, and repair 
from this home to that Home. (4) 

That Home is Agam (inaccessible) and Apar (infinite), 
and beyond Daswan Dwar (tenth door). (5) 

Elevate your Surat within yourself, and open the tenth 
door, and then hear Sat Shabd (which is audible 
above Pind and Brahmand). (6) 

Without the grace and mercy of Guru, you cannot 
find it (Sat Shabd of Sat Lok). Unless you practise 
Surat Shaba" Yoga in right earnest, you cannot 
attain it. (7) 



364 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Withdraw your Surat and raise it to Gagan, and hear 
Shabd. This is the ^Ht Kami (spiritual endeavour) 
you have to make. (8) 

But when the wanton mind does not become steady, 
how can purification be attained? (9) 

Practise Surat Shabd Yoga and give up all other 

endeavours. (10) 

Have firm faith in the efficacy of this practice. Never 

forsake it due to sloth. (11) 

This is Sant Mat, and the essence of all teachings. (12) 

Radhasoami has revealed this secret and explained the 
essential tenets. You should accept the same. (13) 



Shabd 11 

^t ^t ¥*m* ^-<*R<m it <\ it 

Ascend to Gagan (sky, heaven), peep through and 
enter the latticed screen and see Shyarm Sunder 
(dark and beautiful), i.e., the third Til. (1) 

Then behold the dazzling flame. Subdue pride, egotism 
and attachment. (2) 

All impurities will disappear, when Surat contacts and 
merges in Shabd. (3) 

Behold the lotus of Trikuti, and hear the sound of 

Sunn. (4) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 365 

There, Surat will begin to appear in its pure form. 

You should stick to this very practice. (5) 

When Surat catches hold of Shabd, the deceitful Maya 
runs away. (6) 

This unknowable secret is now given out by 
Radhasoami. Follow His precept. (7) 



Shabd 12 
■sjtjt "^ ^Tfr 'sjtr ^t «rrft I 

3TTt W$S Tfa MkI II S II 

O Surat! Darling of Sat Guru! Turn and hear the constant 
reverberations of Shabd. (1) 

Your stay in this world is for four days only. Why do 

you take up so much burden? (2) 

Guru repeatedly asks you to befriend and associate 
with Shabd. (3) 

Give up all sense of "meurm and tuurm". And let your 
Surat march to the inaccessible regions. (4) 

This is not the work of worldly people. Some Gurumukh 
(devotee) alone can undertake to do it. (5) 

Man-mukhs (persons following the dictates of mind) 
will lose the game. Attend Satsang. All evils will 
vanish. (6) 

Nam alone is pure. All else is saline. Make Nam 

your prop and support. (7) 



366 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

This unique Surat Shabd Yoga has been revealed 
now. The Vedas and other revealed books did 
not know about it. (8) 

Now, take my advice. Give up negligence; and be 

vigilant. (9) 

Disgorge passions and desires, and then bathe in 

the cool stream. (10) 

When you bring under control both Mana (mind) and 
Maya (matter), Kal and Karam will automatically 
be vanquished: (11) 

Your Surat will then embark upon the journey royal, 
and go straight to the mansion of Sat Guru. (12) 

O Surat! You are the darling of Agam Purush. You 

have now become dear to all. (13) 

Enhance love in the company of Sat Guru. You will 
see the refulgence of Shabd within you. (14) 

The current from Mansarovar is flowing. Radhasoami 
is imparting this knowledge. (15) 



Shabd 13 

wit ^ *tt*t ^ *rrsr n s n 

O Surat! Ascend to the alley of Gagan. Why are you 
getting yourself consumed in the furnace of doubts 
and misgivings? (1) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 367 

Why do you go Kal's way? Remove the covering of 

hypocrisy. (2) 

You have become enamoured of the pleasures of the 
world. Remember, one day you have to mingle 
with dust. (3) 

Make purchases from the shop, as it were, of Sat Guru, 
Withdraw inward and remove the inner curtains. (4) 

Now, make preparations for the journey of Surat. Close 
the account of Karams. (5) 

Loosen the knot and remove barriers. Ascend to Nabh 
(sky, heaven) and see the crystal clear courtyard. 
You will disengage yourself from the world and 
feel detached. (6-7) 

The mind will come round forsaking duplicity. Kal will 
be subdued posthaste. (8) 

The flame has been kindled in the"£R Ghat (inner 
recesses). I have become a minstrel at the court 
of Radhasoami. (9) 



Shabd 14 

tr mw TTsr fire *rrf it <\ u 

Rub and pulverize your mind within. Thus will all its 

desires be effaced. (1) 



368 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Hear the Shabd (sound) coming from the heavenly spheres 
above, and the Surat will be delighted. (2) 

When thoughts and vagaries of the mind are removed, 
you will attain purity and steadiness. (3) 

When you give up desires for pleasures, your mind 
will apply itself more assiduously to Sumiran.(4) 

When impure desires and base carvings are cast off 
from your mind, you will have Amrit (nectar) to 
drink to your heart's fill. (5) 

The efficacy of Surat Shabd Yoga is beyond description. 
The moment you succeed in curbing your mind, 
your Surat will merge in Shabd. (6) 

When Sat Guru is pleased with you, you will hear 

Anhad Shabd within. (7) 

The sun will rise within you. Thereafter, the flame of 

moon will be kindled. (8) 

I sing the greatness of Sant Mat. Shruti (Vedas) and 
Smriti (codes of laws) all pale into insignificance 
before it. (9) 

I resolve to perform Arti, and make all preparations 

for it. (10) 

I place all the things before Guru. He is very gracious 
with me. (11) 

I sing the hymn of Arti. Guru now helps me. (12) 

I am fortunate to be called "Guru Charnan Das" 
(a slave of the Holy Feet of Guru). I feel highly 
honoured. (13) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 369 

I meditate upon the Holy Name RADHASOAMI and 

behold very wondrous spectacles. (14) 



Shabd 15 

^ ^T W* IP ^^ " *> ll 

A loud roar is audible within. Now Surat has become 
steady. (1) 

My mind has given up all baneful desires. O Surat! 

Ascend and stay up there. (2) 

Vast is the expanse of Maha-sunn. It is enveloped in 
darkness. (3) 

On crossing this region, my Surat enters the Sait 

Kanwal (white lotus, i.e., Sat Lok), and truly becomes 
Dasi (servant, worthy recipient of a gift) of Shabd 
Guru. (4) 

O Sakhi (friend)! Listen to me. Sants daily visit that 

region. (5) 

When you have become one with the Shabd of that 
region, your victory (over Kal and Maya) is 
celebrated. (6) 

Those who fall at the Holy Feet of Radhasoami, are 
freed from the cycle of Chaurasi. (7) 



370] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Shabd 16 

^wr hr r^t 3m P& ■& n s n 

O Surat! Ascend quickly to Gagan (sky, heavens, regions 
above). First, behold the Nirgun Jyoti (the flame, 
beyond three Gunas or qualities). (1) 

Quit the whole expanse of Sargun, made of three Gunas 
(qualities). Cut the noose of three Gunas. (2) 

Leaving Nirgun, march onward, and come up to Maha- 
nirgun. (3) 

Quitting this, hear the Dhun or sound of Sunn. You 

will thus realize the teachings of Sants. (4) 

From there, you go to Maha-sunn, beyond which, you 
behold the region of Sohang. (5) 

Your Surat will attain the Satnam Pad, and then, touch 
the feet of Alakh and Agam. (6) 

Radhasoami has revealed the secrets of "Nij Ghar" 
(Original Home), and has done away with the cycle 
of births and deaths. (7) 



Shabd 17 

7*JFT *TrT T&rft "3FT ^7T «TTT I 
l| TO ^T 3 ^<m 3TRTT II S I! 

O Sajni 1 , Discard the current of world, do not drift with it. It 
will bring you untold pain and misery. (1) 

1. A virtuous woman, a sweet-heart, a female friend. 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 371 

Associate with Sat Guru by your Surat. Get both body and 
mind dissolved in Shabd. (2) 

Drink the nectar of association with Sat Guru all the 
twentyfour hours, and be careful and vigilant. (3) 

Hold fast to the door of Gagan. Cultivate love for 

Shabd now. (4) 

Radhasoami cautions you to ascend to Trikuti carefully. (5) 



Shabd 18 

^TTrT ^R #3 % 33 "3TFT II °i II 

O Surat! Be dyed in the colour of Nam and ascend 
to higher regions. The whole world is asleep. You 
awake. (1) 

Your lot will be wonderfully brightened; you will hear 
the melody of Anhad Shabd. (2) 

O my dear! you will attain true renunciation (detachment) 
from the world; and develop great love (attachment) 
for Dhun (sound). (3) 

Hopes and frustrations and likes and dislikes of the 
mind, will all go away. Ascend to Nabh 1 and kill 
the black cobra. (4) 

Daily play Holi 2 with Sat Guru. All desires will be 

snapped like a thread. (5) 

1. Sky Chidakash. Sahas-dal-kanwal. 2. See "Holi and" "Holi Khelna" 
at pp. 106-107, "Glossary of Radhasoami Faith". 



372] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

I am now fearless. I am not afraid of Jama (the angel 
of death). I have joined the company of Hansas 
(celestial beings) and have driven away ugly crows 
(evil propensities). (6) 

I am now purified. All blemishes have been removed. 
Radhasoami has bestowed on me the bliss of 
Shabd. (7) 



Shabd 19 

w ^frr *ttt ^ *te \ 

*M ^TcT tTpft II S tl 

O Hansani 1 (Surat)! Why do you drink water? An 
ocean of milk is within you. Withdraw inward and 
drink deep. (1) 

Let the world go its way. You enter Nabh and behold 
the inner scenes. (2) 

Enshrine Guru's image in your heart. Why do you 
move like a destitute fellow in the company of 
the mind? (3) 

Guru will accomplish your task. Hear Anhad Shabd. (4) 

The whole world is under the sway of rituals and 
delusions. Why should you also behave the same 
way? (5) 

Why do you mix poison with Amrit (ambrosia)? Take 
care of Surat and attend Satsang. (6) 

1. A female swan. 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 373 

Your abode is in the Highest Region. Why are you 

tied to the body? (7) 

Hurry up. Ascend. Radhasoami exhorts you. (8) 



Shabd 20 
f*Rt w^t ^8T affr vrtt ii f^ M 

foH t^TT 7?t 3TOpfr II 1 II 

O Hansani (Surat)! Separate milk from water. Discard 
water, and drink nectar to your heart's content. (1) 

Remain concentrated within by means of Jugti (Bhajan, 
Dhyan and Sumiran) and Jatan (efforts), and let 
your Surat be absorbed in Shabd. (2) 

Control eating, drinking, sleep and laziness, and hear 
Shabd (sound) coming from the heavenly regions 
above. (3) 

You will not get such an opportunity again. If you fail, 
you will remain wandering in the various species 
of life. (4) 

O Sakhi! Accept what Guru says. He teaches you 

because you are His. (5) 

Withdraw the current of the five senses. Annihilate 

desire, which brought you in the world. (6) 

Discipline your mind, rise to Gagan and hear Anhad 
Shabd. (7) 



374 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Shabd reverberates within you. Why are you slack? (8) 

Radhasoami gives you the call by delivering nectar- 
like discourses. (9) 



Shabd 21 

U*tT ^ W«J Uoftcft Iff tppfr I 
44R4I Vfal 3TSTT ^f ^IT TT% II <* 11 

O Chhabili (handsome darling)! Steady your Surat and 
be delighted. Wash your mantle clean and dye it 
in the colour of higher regions. (1) 

Burn all Karams. Set fire to your habitation (body, 
mind and senses). Give up pride and egotism. 
Remove all obstacles. (2) 

Stop sleeping. Keep awake in the night. Guru gives 
these instructions. Obey Him. Apply yourself to 
devotional exercises. (3) 

O Sajni (noble friend)! Listen. Take Saran. Implant the Holy 
Feet in your heart. O Surat! You are located in Pind. 
Accept what Radhasoami says. (4) 



Shabd 22 

^TH 3T^ "SIT -M^'lefl HT*T I) $tt II 

tsNj ^iHt tjtt "5nr "& are ~% \ 

ftpr affm ^ tjtq n <* ti 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 375 

O Surat! Adopt Nam. Awake, and leave the world this 
time. You will not get such an opportunity again. (1) 

Perform Guru Bhakti. Engender love for Him. He will 
accomplish your task. (2) 

He will reveal the secrets of Nam, raise your Surat 

and help you reach Nij Dham. (3) 

You will enjoy bliss and happiness and abide in peace 
and comfort. (4) 

Radhasoami says that you will be released from Shyarm 
(black) and attain Sait (white). (5) 



Shabd 23 

flg& ^f affcT ft yjrttSiri n ^ it 

O nightingale! Recognise the flower garden, where a 
great variety of flowers are blossoming. (1) 

Come along and live in close association with Guru. 
Go on elevating your mind and Surat. (2) 

Collect your diffused spirituality and be whole-heartedly 
attentive. You will gradually merge in Jyoti. (3) 

Remove the two slabs or curtains, and behold the 
thousand-petalled lotus of Sahas-dal-kanwal. (4) 

Peep into the creation there, then dwell freely and 
openly. Pass over the bridge and get across. (5) 



376 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

There, whiffs of sweet fragrance of sandal are enjoyed, 
and Surat and mind are cleansed of impurities. (6) 

The obstacles created by Kal will disappear, and 
then, your Surat will apply itself wholeheartedly to 
Shabd. (7) 

Extricated from the mire of Karam, you will proceed 

on and meet Radhasoami. (8) 



Shabd 24 

TTS^T TF tf tWT3TT II 1 11 

Apply your Surat to Dhun and be absorbed in the 

bliss of Shabd. (1) 

Turn the currents of the senses inward and concentrate 

the diffused mind. (2) 

Shun the poison of the three Gunas. Turn inward. 
Cast off laziness and enhance your longing and 
yearning. (3) 

Bring your mind round. Do not let the obstacles of 
^HT Lai and faSrN Vikshep overcome you. (4) 

(Sometimes during spiritual practice, the practitioner loses 
consciousness, as a result of overpowering drowsiness, very much 
like sleep. This obstacle is technically termed as "Lai" or "Lava". 
"Vikshep" is a sudden distraction of attention, or violent jerk.) 

Catch hold of Shabd and leave the rest. You have to 

perform this practice daily. (5) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 377 

Think of nothing except Surat Shabd Yoga. Check 
your mind and rush to Nabh, (sky, heavens). (6) 

Fix your Surat at the third Til. Perform Abhyas vigorously 
and break open the gate to Sahas-dal-kanwal. (7) 

You will have Darshan of Jyoti and Niranjan. Go on 

contacting Shabd after Shabd. (8) 

Enter Banknal (the crooked tunnel). Conquer the fort 
of Trikuti. (9) 

Penetrate into Sunn and let the spectacles thereof 
unfold themselves to you. Awaken the Shabd of 
that region also. (10) 

Surveying the region of Maha-Sunn, go on pene- 
trating further till you fully effect your ingress into 
Bhanwargupha. (11) 

Then proceed to Sat Lok, and from there ascend to 

Alakh Lok. (12) 

Then, enter Agam Lok, Finally, unite with Radhasoami. (13) 



Shabd 25 

\ ^ ^FT 3PT II <\ II 

O bride (Surat)! Live in the company of your Beioved. 
Your bridegroom abides in Gagan, while you reside 
in the house of your parents, i.e., in Pind. (1) 



378 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Go to that city with Guru, and then you will imbibe 

the colour of Prem. * (2) 

This youth of yours will soon be gone. You will then 

be in distress. (3) 

Therefore, take to the path of Parmarth right now 

and with zeal and enthusiasm. (4) 

Your bridegroom is absorbed in the bliss of Nam. 

Fly like a kite to Gagan. (5) 

Give up all desires. Get the string of your Surat tied 

to Guru. (6) 

Drums are sounding at the gate of your Beloved. A ^&Vu 
(Munh-chang) Jew's harp is also being played. (7) 

Radhasoami has given out the whereabouts of your 
Beloved. Go to Him, catching hold of the current 
(which is coming down from Him). (8) 



Shabd 26 

W^ ^ff "^ "STfT toPT g^il II 1 II 



+ 2 



Play the game of ^rg^st Kabaddi 1 in your"^re Ghat 2 

Do not lick poisonous bone like a dog. (1) 



1. Kabaddi is a boys' game resembling "Prisoners' base" Kabaddi 
Kabaddi is the cry of the boy who runs out to touch or capture 
an adversary. 2. See "Ghat" at the bottom of page 91 in "Glossary 
of Radhasoami Faith". 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 379 

Subdue the mind and ride on Kal's back. Go on uttering 
the Holy Name, and touch the ^TcTT Pala 1 
(partition line). Leave the region of the three Gunas 
(qualities). (2) 

Repair to your true home by means of Surat. Surpass 
all. Stand first. Don't lag behind. (3) 

Check the waverings of mind and gather your diffused 
spirituality. Eradicate deep-rooted "*rwr Marmta 
(affection for world and its objects). (4) 

Catch Kal by his beard and cut it. Renounce all objects of 
pleasures. Do not be deceived by the mind. (5) 

Throw away all desires of the world, and let your 
Surat be fixed at the Holy Feet of Guru. (6) 

Climb the ladder with the help of RADHASOAMI Nam, 
and Kal will be baffled. (7) 



Shabd 27 

mmm ^t ^i pftht ii q 11 

Be gentle of disposition and compassionate at heart 
and seek Parmarth. (1) 

Quit the plane of sensual pleasures. Always apply 

your Surat to Shabd. (2) 



1. Pala is a line of earth etc. made by children to separate the two 
sides in the game of Kabaddi or "Prisoners' base". 



380 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

You will get the essence from Guru. Enhance your 

love for His Holy Feet. (3) 

Catch hold of the Shabd current coming from inaccessible 
regions and apply your Surat to it. Be absorbed 
in this (inner) Satsang always. (4) 

Your Surat rises above, and peeps through the door 
to ^T Nabha; it then beholds sq^TAnda (egg- 
shaped sphere) of three Loks (of Shiva, Brahma 
and Vishnu). (5) 

Beyond sit And, you will go into ^WT Brahmand, 
and see the lotus blooming in the Mansarovar lake 
in the region of Sunn. (6) 

Now all the tricks of Kal will prove ineffective, and 
your Surat will bathe in Mansarovar lake. (7) 

You will proceed and go ahead beholding the form 
of Akshar Purush. The alien region will be left 
below. (8) 

When you soar high, the antiquated and old mansion 
(Pind) will be left below. (9) 

As you proceed towards the Highest Region, the 
Shabds of different intermediate regions become 
audible. (10) 

What your Surat now sees on its onward journey cannot 
be known to anybody except Sants. (11) 

The spectacles and creations of those regions cannot 
be described in words. People talk higgledy- 
piggledy. (12) 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 381 

Bachaks or sophists rely on their intellect. But without 
performing devotional exercises, no one can under- 
stand correctly. (13) 

The position and status of Sants is known to Sants 

alone. Who else can recognise them? (14) 

Give up your cleverness. Accept the words of Sants 
as true and authentic. (15) 

Sants say what they see with their own eyes. Why do 
you strain your intellect in vain on hearsay? (16) 

Radhasoami declares that the status of Sants is known 
only to a 'confidant' of the Lord. (17) 



Shabd 28 

3TST ^?RTTT 3 f^ffi W I II 1 II 

Hear the discourses of Guru. Attend Satsang 
carefully. (1) 

You have been initiated in the imperishable Nam. Cling 
fast to IT by your Surat. (2) 

Guru will elevate you to higher regions. Be prepared 
to go with Him. (3) 

Your spirituality is very much diffused. Guru will correct 
your blemishes. (4) 

He will kill Kal. He will remove your egotism and 

haughtiness. (5) 



382 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 

Apply your Surat steadfastly. Your transmigration will 
come to an end. (6) 

Tell your beads by uttering RADHASOAMI Nam. Hold 
the key provided by Guru. (7) 

Know the secrets of SFT^ TT^Anhad Shabd. Disperse 
the clouds in Gagan. (8) 

Shoot the arrows of f^TW Virah (yearning). Hear the 
"sift Ghor (roar), and proceed to Mansarovar. (9) 

Find abode at the Sunn Shikhar. Hearing Shabd, proceed 
to Sat Pur. (10) 

Then, get to Alakh and Agam. Beyond is the Radhasoami 
Dham, the Eternal Home. (11) 

Daily sing this hymn of Arti. Radhasoami will shower 
His grace and mercy on you. (12) 



Shabd 29 

O friend! Raise your Surat to Gagan, and be free 

from all fears, doubts and misgivings. (1) 

Leave this house and go to the mosque at higher 
regions. Hear the Bang 1 , and meditate upon the 
One who is undecaying and unconquered. (2) 

1. Bang = The call to prayer by the muazzim from the minarets 
or towers of the mosques : the crowing of a cock. 



20 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ 383 

Enjoy the bliss of Nam. This is the gist of Guru's 

teachings. Sing wondrous songs to the accompaniment 
of music of Shabd. (3) 

Let your mind remain absorbed, adopting the ways 

of Guru. Cultivate love for Him. (4) 

Conquer and disperse the forces of Kal and Karam, 
and cast off delusions. (5) 

Hear the sound in Sunn, free from Maya. Receive 77TT^ 
Prashad from Sants. (6) 

Adopt the Saran of Radhasoami. Make elexir of Nam 
internally. (7) 



Shabd 30 

^T ft IT^t ^ "R^cT f«TCT*f I 

^i 3ft ¥ta*r #t 3TTO n i ii 

O Sakhi (friend)! Come and take your seat in the 
palace. Your Beloved is awaiting you there. (1) 

Enjoy bliss. Run away from the world. Sit on the throne 
and reign. (2) 

Join the assembly of Hansas, and accomplish your 

task. (3) 

Give up all other considerations, and seize Guru's 
Holy Feet. Clean the mirror of your heart. (4) 

Sift and winnow the grain of Dhun (sound), in the 

winnowing basket of Surat and Nirat. (5) 



384 ] Practice of Surat Shabd Yoga [ Bachan 20 

Thank your great good fortune that you have got all 
the accoutrements. Sat Guru has bestowed on you 
the Crown and the Throne. (6) 

All the three worlds stand exposed before you. You 
will rise to the fourth Lok and enjoy the happiness 
of sovereignty. (7) 

As you are a recipient of this gift of Radhasoami, 

nothing detrimental can happen to you any more. (8) 



BACHAN 21 

HIDAYATNAMA 
(ESOTERIC INSTRUCTIONS) 



REVELATION GIVEN OUT IN THE COURSE 
OF TEACHINGS IMPARTED ABOUT THE VALUE 
OF ASSOCIATION WITH, AND SERVICE OF, 
THE PERFECT GUIDE, AND ABOUT THE 
DIFFERENT GRADES OF ADEPTS, AND 
INSTRUCTIONS ABOUT THE PRACTICE OF 
SHABD, AND THE SECRETS OF SHABD MARG, 
(YOGA) WITH DETAILS OF THE STAGES ON 
THE JOURNEY TO THE HIGHEST REGION. 

This discourse is meant for those who are desirous 
of finding the Supreme Being, and who are true seekers 
and want to know which religion is the highest and 
which path is the most sure and direct. They should 
minimise their worldly attachments. In other words, 
leaving the care for wealth, wife and children to fate 
they should give paramount importance to the company 
of saintly persons. And out of saintly persons, the 



386] Hidayatnama [ Bachan 

company of that Adept should be adopted, who is a 
practitioner of Surat Shabd or of ^f^ Drishti (sight), 
that is to say, who is conversant with the technique 
of the Yoga of Surat Shabd, has perfected the practice 
of withdrawing the spirit currents from the pupils of 
the two eyes, and of uniting them; and who performs 
the practice of raising the spirit, by hearing, internally, 
celestial sounds. In case an Adept of this class is 
not available, they should search out one who performs 
the practice of 'striking the solar plexus with Name' 
(repeating the Holy Name in a particular manner at 
the heart centre), or one who performs the practice 
of 'breath control'. The company of such a person 
would also purify the heart, curb evil propensities and 
confer some inner joy. But the ascension of the spirit 
can be achieved through the practice of Surat Shabd 
Yoga alone. It behoves the seeker to develop love 
and devotion for such a personage, to perform His 
service with zeal, to solicit His attention and kindness 
by rendering service of all kinds with body, mind and 
wealth, and to gaze at His eyes continuously for an 
hour or two, without letting the eye-lids close, as long 
as possible. The duration of this practice should be 
prolonged day by day. Whenever He casts His benign 
gaze on you, your heart will be purified. When, in 
His grace, He initiates you into the secrets and methods 
of the practice referred to above, your spirit will begin 
to catch hold of the celestial sounds. You should perform 
this practice daily, twice, four times or as many times 
as you find time. If your mind gives rise to delusions 
and wanderings, prayers should be offered to Sant 
Sat Guru and the practice should be performed with 
greater effort. Guru's kindness and your application 



21 ] Hidayatnama [ 387 

would certainly result in progress day by day. It is 
not proper to be hasty or impatient, because haste 
makes waste, and is characteristic of the devil. 

Whatever is achieved gradually is beneficial, and 
whatever is acquired pronto does not last, because 
such an acquisition is the gift of Satan. Whatever is 
obtained from the Merciful Guru endures. All this refers 
to external modes of devotion. The inner state and 
the stages to which Sants have access are described 
below. 

When your eye turns inward in the brain and you 
see the firmament within, and your spirit leaves the 
body and rises upward, you will see the Akash in 
which is located Sahas-dal-kanwal, the thousand petals 
of which perform the various functions pertaining to 
the three worlds. Its effulgence will exhilarate your 
spirit. You will at that stage, witness Niranjan, the 
lord of three worlds. Several religions which attained 
this stage and took the deity hereof to be the lord of 
all, were duped. Seeing the light and refulgence of 
this region they felt satiated. Their progress was stopped. 
They did not find the guide to higher regions. Hence 
they could not proceed further. 

At the apex of this Akash, there is a passage 
which is very small like the eye of a needle. Your 
Surat (spirit) should penetrate this eye. Further on, 
there is Banknal, the crooked path, which goes straight 
and then downward and again upwards. Beyond this 
passage comes the second stage. 

Trikuti (region having three prominences) is situ- 



388 ] Hidayatnama [ Bachan 

ated here. It is one Lakh 1 Yojan 2 in length and one 
Lakh Yojan in width. There are numerous varieties of 
glories and spectacles at that plane which are diffi- 
cult to describe. Thousands of suns and moons look 
pale in comparison to the light there. All the time, 
melodious sounds of Ong Ong and Hoo Hoo, and 
the sounds resembling thunder of clouds, reverber- 
ate there. On attaining this region, the spirit becomes 
very happy, and purified and subtle. From here on- 
ward, it becomes cognizant of the spiritual regions. 

After having enjoyed the bliss of this region for 
some time, the spirit goes up one crore 3 Yojans and 
reaches Sunn, the third stage. Mohammedan Faqirs 
(Saints) have called it "Lahoot." It is indescribable. 
Here, the spirits enjoy great beatitude. The refulgence 
of this region is twelve times that of Trikuti. Pure 
pools of ambrosia, called HHwVk "Mansarovar", abound 
here. There are innumerable flower pots and gardens. 
Spirits, like beauties, dance at various places. There 
are pleasing and sweet victuals, all savoury and fresh, 
and sonorous and musical strains can be heard 
everywhere. All this bliss can be experienced by the 
spirit only when it reaches there. It cannot be 
described. At every place, fountains of nectar are at 
play; in other words, pools of nectar are overflowing 
and streams of nectar are gushing out. How can one 
describe the splendour and decoration of this region? 
There are platforms of diamonds, beds of emeralds 



1. A hundred thousand. 2. A unit of a measurement of dis- 
tance. Commonly, it is reckoned to four Kos or nine miles. 
According to some it is equal to one thousand Kos or two 
thousand miles 3. Ten millions, one hundred lakhs (lacs.) 



21 ] Hidayatnama [389 

and plants of jewels, all studded with rubies and precious 
stones. Bejewelled fish, swimming in pools there, display 
their beauty and ornamentation and their glitter and 
sheen attract attention. Beyond this, there are innu- 
merable palaces of crystals and mirrors, in which spirit 
entities reside at their respective spots, as allocated 
by the Lord. They witness and exhibit ever changing 
revels. In Hindi, they have been described as ITS H^4v\\ 
"Hansa Mandlies'^.The decoration and embellishment 
of these regions can be appreciated only by seeing 
them. The entire creation there is purely spiritual. It 
is free from material constituents. The denizens, there, 
are spiritual and free from physical taints. Full par- 
ticulars of these regions are known only to Sants. It 
is not meet to describe them in greater detail. 

Having sojourned there and having enjoyed the 
glory thereof for a very long time, the spirit of this 
Faqir moved on, in accordance with the instructions 
of the Guides. After traversing five arab 2 and sev- 
enty five crore yojans upward, the spirit entity effected 
ingress into the bounds of ^r^cfHahoot and witnessed 
the panorama of that region. There an expanse of 
ten Neel 3 is enveloped in darkness. The depth of 
this dark region cannot be fathomed. The spirit went 
down one kharab 4 yojans, still the bottom was 
nowhere to be found. Then the spirit turned upward 
and proceeded on the path chalked out by Guru. It 
was not considered advisable to go down right to 
the bottom of this region This region is called wi 
^g^T Maha-sunn. There are four extremely subtle sub- 

1. Congregation of Hansas. 2. One thousand million. 3. Ten 
million. 4. Hundred thousand million. 



390 ] Hidayatnama [ Bachan 

regions there, the secrets whereof have not been revealed 
by any Sant. There are prison cells for the condemned 
spirits ejected from the court of the True Supreme 
Being. Although these spirits are not subjected to 
any trouble and they perform their functions by their 
own light, yet, as they do not get Darshan of the 
Lord, they are restless. However, there is a way of 
their remission also. Whenever Sants happen to pass 
that way with spirits reclaimed from the lower regions, 
some of these spirits fortunately get Their Darshan. 
Such spirits go along with the Sants who very gladly 
take them to the court of the Lord and get them 
pardoned. 

The spirit, thereafter, went to T£cra ira Hootal 
Hoot, which, in Hindi, has been described as Bhanwar- 
gupha. There is a rotating swing here which is all 
the time in subtle motion, and the spirits ever swing 
on it. All round, there are innumerable spiritual is- 
lands from which the sounds of "Sohang Sohang" 
and "Anahoo Anahoo" rise all the time. Spirit enti- 
ties playfully and rapturously enjoy these sounds. Other 
characteristics of this region cannot be reduced to 
writing, as they can be realized by the spirit only 
when it reaches there by performing Abhyas. Hence 
it is necessary to continue the practice of this mode 
of devotion and it is called the Shabd (sound) prac- 
tice. Do not give it up. 

Having witnessed spectacle of this region, the 
spirit entity proceeded upward and went on ascend- 
ing. Whiffs of scents of various kinds and sweet fra- 
.grance of sandal were enjoyed by the spirit and the 
melodies of flutes were heard, while it proceeded 



21 ] Hidayatnama [391 

onward. On crossing this plane, the spirit entity reached 
the outpost of Sat Lok, where melodious sounds of 
"Sat. Sat" and "Haq Haq" were heard coming out of 
the Bin 1 . On hearing this, the spirit penetrated further 
rapturously. There rose to view silver and golden streams 
full of nectar, and vast gardens, each tree thereof 
being one crore-Yojans in height. Crores of suns and 
moons hang from them as flowers and fruits. Innu- 
merable spirits and Hansas sing, chatter and play 
on those trees like birds. The wondrous beauty of 
this region is ineffable. While enjoying it, the spirit 
entered Sat Lok and came into the presence of Sat 
Purush. 

Now as regards the glory of the person of Sat 
Purush, each hair of His is so brilliant that crores of 
suns and moons look pale in comparison. When such 
is the refulgence of each hair, how is it possible to 
describe the glory of all His hair, and where are the 
words to describe the beauty and glory of His entire 
person? How can one describe His eyes, nose, ears, 
face, hands and feet? They are all nothing but reful- 
gence; even to describe them as oceans of reful- 
gence does not give even the remotest idea. 

The expanse of Sat Lok is one padarm 2 Palang, 
a Palang being equal to Triloki 3 in vastness. Hence 
it is difficult to imagine the stupendous vastness of 
Sat Lok. There dwell spirit entities called Hansas who 
enjoy the Darshan of Sat Purush, hear the music of 
the Bin and partake of ambrosial food. 

After witnessing the glory of this region, the spirit 

1. Harp. 2. One thousand billion. 3. Three worlds. 



392] Hidayatnama [ Bachan 

proceeded to Alakh Lok and got Darshan of Alakh 
Purush. The expanse of this region is one sankh 1 , 
and each hair of Alakh Purush has the effulgence of 
arab kharab suns. 

Thereafter the spirit entity went on and attained 
Agam Lok, which is Maha Sankh 2 Palang in expanse 
and the magnitude of the person of Agam Purush 
equals a crore Sankhs. The forms of Hansas of this 
region are amazingly wondrous, and the state of esctasy 
and bliss that obtains there passes description. The 
spirit entity sojourned there for a long time and, on 
going beyond, it got the Darshan of Radhasoami, 
that is, Anarmi Purush, and merged in Him. Radhasoami 
Dharm is boundless, infinite, endless and immeasur- 
able. It is thef^sr ^TH Nij Sthan, the special rest- 
ing place of Sants (Faqirs). That region is the Ultima 
Thule of all Sants and all speech and description 
end here. I also conclude here. 

So great and exalted is the status of Sants (Faqirs). 
Hence, how can the followers of all those who stopped 
at the very first stage, calling it limitless and boundless, 
be convinced of the existence of these higher regions? 
No one but Sants and perfect Faqirs knows them. 
Only those who have met Sants and Faqirs can be 
convinced about the existence of these regions, provided 
that they have faith in Their words. Neither the Prophet 
nor Vyas and Vashishtha knew of these regions. Hence 
no Hindu or Muslim can believe in their existence. It 
is not desirable to tell them about this, because they 

1. Hundred thousand billions. 2. Sankh is a hundred thousand 
billion. Maha means great. Heance Maha Sankh is still 
greater than hundred thousand billions 



21 ] Hidayatnama [393 

are faltered by the teachings of the prophet and Quran, 
and Hindus are slaves of Vyas, Vashishtha and the 
Vedas. They cannot even tolerate hearing these words. 
As such, communication of this revelation will do good 
only to those persons who have faith and belief in 
the words of Sants and who accept that the status 
of Sants is exalted above all and that Sants are, in 
fact, the creators of Khuda and Parmeshwar (God). 
For this reason, this secret should not be divulged 
to any one until and unless his faith and conviction 
have been ascertained as conforming to what has 
been stated above. 



GHAZALS 



ASCENSION OF ROOH (SPIRIT, SURAT) 
TO SAT LOK AND WITNESSING 
SPECTACLES ON THE WAY 



Ghazal 1 1 

% ^ If (ft ^krr ^t 3it(>ich ^fr ^am 

O Guru ! I am enamoured of your Darshan. I have 
become disgusted with my mind. I sacrifice my 
Surat at Your Holy Feet. (1) 

O My Beloved ! One glance of Yours has completely 
unsettled me, rendering me desperately restless 
like Majnun 2 in love with Laila. (2) 

lam sick at heart. There is no remedy for me except 
Your Darshan. Your voice alone will act like soothing 
balm on my lacerated heart. (3) 



1. An ode. 2. Name of a celebrated Eastern lover whose 
amours with Laila are the subject of a famous Persian 
poem. 



Bachan 21 ] Ghazals [ 395 

The lustre of Your face has illumined my heart. Thousands 
of suns and moons feel ashamed before Your 
radiance. (4) 

A lover attains celebrity by falling at the feet of his 
beloved. Such is the way of the world and such 
is the practice of this age. (5) 

All worldly thoughts and desires have vanished from 
my mind. I am filled with intense longing for Your 
Darshan. (6) 

Lo ! My fortune has brightened, for my Surat has 
united with Guru's Holy Feet. Piercing the sphere 
of the moon, it forthwith entered Gagan. (7) 

I withdrew inward and heard sweet celestial music. 
Both Hindus and Mohammedans appear heretical 
to me. (8) 



Ghazal 2 

<sth ^r TTTT tt ^f ifgjT ^r II i n 

On reaching the Arsh (sky, heavens, Sahas-dal- 
kanwal), I saw light. I vaquished Kal and blew the 
trumpet. (1) 

When my Surat began to ascend, I became oblivious 
of my body. I repaired to my original seat. (2) 

Now I take out of the crowd those who are the lovers 
of the Beloved's lane. (3) 



396 ] Ghazals [ Bachan 

Listen with care to what I now say : Withdraw your 
Surat, elevate it and hear the resounding of Shabd 
within you. (4) 

There are flower-gardens and Satsang within your head. 
Take stroll there and get dyed quickly in the colour 
of Guru. (5) 

Withdraw the spirit current from the pupils and do 
not open your eyes. Ascend and open the door 
to Akash (heavens). (6) 

When your Surat ascends within, you will take stroll 
inside your body and witness the bloom of spring (7) 

It will be a wonderful stroll for you within. You will 

find the earth above and the sky below. (8) 

Passing through Banknal, my Surat proceeded onward 
and reaching Trikuti, met Guru. (9) 

How am I to describe the beauty of the red morning 
sun, each ray of which has the refulgence of a 
thousand suns? (10) 

Proceeding further, my Surat reached Sunn and heard 
the melodious sounds of Kingri and Sarangi (fiddle 
and violin). (11) 

Pools of Amrit (nectar) were visible on all sides. The 
denizens of that region, called Hansas, pick up 
and feed upon pearls. (12) 

Leaving Sunn, I went further ahead and reached 
Mahasunn, from where the Shabd of Sohang can 
be heard. (13) 



21 ] Ghazals [397 

What should I say about that region? He alone knows 
it who has been there. (14) 

The whole passage is enveloped in darkness. It can 
be crossed only in the company of Sat Guru. (15) 

I crossed the vast expanse of Mahasunn in the company 
of Sat Guru. Seeing Him, Kal was stunned. (16) 

My Surat ascended and rushed to Bhanwargupha 

and heard the sound of Sohang. (17) 

Having witnessed the glory of this marvellous region, I 
opened the window and proceeded within. (18) 

Further ahead, I rushed to Sat Lok and fed upon 

nectar. (19) 

Higher up are the regions of Alakh and Agam, beyond 
which is Radhasoami Nam. (20) 

This region is Akah, Apar and Anarm, (indescribable, 
infinite and nameless). Except Sants who else can 
have access there? (21) 

This place marks the end of all secrets and mysteries. 
All speech and description end here. I also conclude 
here. (22) 



Ghazai 3 



398] Ghazals [ Bachan 

Love for the Nij Rup (real Form) of Sat Guru pervades 
my heart. His discourses are like a current of nectar. 
As I listen to them, I bathe in ambrosia. (1) 

Ever since I came in His Saran and placed the dust 
of His holy feet on my head, all the darkness and 
impurities of my mind vanished. (2) 

His charming face, stately figure, graceful gait and 
majestic refulgence are piercing my heart. (3) 

When I attended the Satsang of Sat Guru and heard 
His discourses, both the world and the worldly 
religions appeared false and flimsy and I did not 
at all feel sorry for missing them. (4) 

The hidden mysteries of Pind, i.e., the human microcosm, 
unfolded themselves before me. By the grace 
and mercy of the perfect Guru, my task is being 
accomplished. (5) 

When my Surat caught hold of Shabd, it at once ascen- 
ded to Asman (heavens). It became fit to stay there. 
All griefs and sorrows were now gone. (6) 

^Nt "g^f xrr 3TSR ^fa ^FRI 

alt? a*3*icr wu tuviu n % u 

It went ahead catching hold of the sound. It reached 
Sahas-dal-kanwal and got acquainted with the 
secrets. (7) 

It saw there the marvellous and novel bloom of spring. It 
developed intuition and was absorbed in bliss. (8) 



21 I Ghazals [399 

Pain and suffering of recurrent births and deaths and 
also all troubles and miseries were gone. (9) 

When I posed a question to Sat Guru, all inner secret 
and mysteries were revealed to me. (10) 

I left the mortal body. Kal, too, admitting defeat, kept 
away from me. (11) 

As soon as I ascended to Akash (sky, heavens), all 
my Karams and activities came to an end. My 
Surat became the creator (12) 

When my Sat Guru became merciful to me, I went 
and met Him in His region and my separation 
from Him ended for good. (13) 

What do the observers of rituals, followers of religious 
codes of conduct and the utterers of prayers know 
of this? Only those who perform spiritual practices 
know the secrets and mysteries. (14) 

The learned and the intellectual all remain ignorant. 
They know nothing of the inner secrets. (15) 

People of the world remain steeped in doubts and delu- 
sions. They are Bachaks (quibblers), and are mere 
talkers, unable to meet the perfect Guru. (16) 

They alone are fortunate who have met Sat Guru. All 
others will remain entangled in discussions and 
argumentations. (17) 

Sat Guru Radhasoami has showered His grace and 
mercy on me. My luck for repairing to the Highest 
Region has now awakened. (18) 



[ 401 ] 






3RfT^, 3TW, 3PTP*, SRRt 

y if 

^HsT^ ^ ^T3? J T T H ^ 
3ffi ^ TJCtl "^StTC 

^t *r ^3 ^?f wan 

3^ *R ff\ Sfi Wj$ Tfttl 

3TR 3TRat ^ ^\ ifift 
SIR f^TO ^[fe TTTO "*3pft 

31R ^ 31FPC ?fa spin 

3H3 $* «p ^ $ *trft 

3ffi[ ?ife ^ra ^rt ^ 3q*HI 

3TPR WF Srra Tira ^ 

sura 3r^ sir wu$&- ~^\ 

am ^ ^thi imr 

3?RtI T TT# ^=F 3n 
3IR? yd'Jfc ^ft -SPSJ 3^ 



43 
277 
216 
139 
349 
115 
348 
313 
395 
102 
120 

89 
177 

91 
316 
123 
128 
144 
140 
100 
178 
151 



[ 402 ] 



^ SHTcft TTWF^Pft 
^ Wit TFtllWml 31Ft 

^nt ft ^W ^t#T *tra -^tpt 

3jRfcPU ^n '#5 ^t 

^j^ ^pt ^*nft ^ra 

^r ft fw ^Jt Pra ^ *f 
Tsftrt ft f^rf^ff 

5f^f ft tjf wr?r ^=n3' 
•g? aim MM Tft ^cijf 
■35 3?ft sra ^r ^ 
35 ^ 73H3 wi mi 

^ ^n ^75 5 iM ft 

TH? ^t ^T "?? ^ 1J3FI 

7j? ^fr ^r ?t w^ ~wzn. 
"5? w ^tt *Ft <k| 

*P ^PR ^T4 SR ^ 3 



142 
130 
165 
161 

165 
254 
226 
1% 
286 
276 
358 
379 
258 



362 
394 



363 
339 
290 

98 
305 
207 

97 
342 
335 
193 

m 

307 
IfiX 



[ 403 ] 

~%$ ^&l ^5%R "3Fra ft' 249 

^ wA v& ^rft 341 

3*r ^um ^# *p$ W5Rt 317 

"5? Sjn tjft -^ th ft 306 

t|S tftr! *fST f^cTT=T ft 1 75 

*g$ Wl 3ft" lJ ^=1 t 38! 

"5? irai 3T#ST ^TOT 109 

3? farl ""RH K ^rft 174 

■JFJ^ ^IRJ ^ SltTRf 156 

^ ftt ^tH ftTR 187 

t$ wt ara t inf i9i 

^ps ^i «ir f»| ^rrt 326 

^ 3ft 3JTH 3^rft iso 

■3?; ~$s *fto x%\ gq sir 314 

^ ^ *f ftW KTTtft 167 

^ fe 3J*ft 1 ^cR TIR 328 

^ fa=? 3&1 S'Wm 327 

IS* ftt| ^T 7P^ w^i 243 

■^2 ft ^ 7^ ^T^t 378 

"*H ^TC^ g^i^fi ii?rft 369 

W 3ffi ^rcrft wit 248 

^R ^ W3 m ^ *R$ 365 

3£ W$t fpR WfWT 364 

■^ W3 ?FTC ^ WZt 366 

WT 3T7 ^ ft f^Jf3 375 

^R "5? ft^ *WC T?t 137 

•^ "ft m<l m ^ -$ i$\ 263 

^# "ft Wt OTD f*R] ft fftcTT# 351 

^fi ft Wt Ifttl StRW ^f 32 

^ffi ^ "JfTTtf ft ^ 272 

•m ~*m ^ wt jfajra 265 

ft^i ftr ^ H # ^i ^f 322 



[ 404 ] 



wj $ ^ arau *ro 

wis H "^n f^t f^fti ?fa 
wi ^r 1JJ3 #f ^fpr 

"SJRrt ff ^?T 3PR ^* ^ 37Tt 

; fTftra{ ^st *rr ^ ^irc 
■sffst ff ^ ffra "srm ^ 
Wfim sifart raw d*i'ii*i 
<m m v? 5*3 "^3 ^r *irt 
frRT *faR f^i "^te 

eft 'ifrW "*. *!^ \ WIf 
^^-f ■_??- ^R 1H 3 

?qm ^ ^tsfti ^n •& **r 
^r?=ft ^r. fw tj ^ri 

■^3Tt Tt TER-ft I fi1? l^FT ^m^ 
*. , , *% *i _____ „___ ____ 

^_n w tt ^ra ^ ^ 
^31 ^ *pt ^fffi ^rp 

q^I epi *R tp*I pRR 

tp 3 arc 1R3 wn-Tt 
*fT ^ ^R *n «h^ 

E[R_7 ^?r WIT ^Rf OTq 

_____ rs„,,J ,„ ______ f 

:: Tr«. to '^fR-fr ]]? ^i w 

Pra 5p9 ^ WR* ^T 
^H ^W?( ^R» rTT^r 



.*.•-. 
..*-.. 
-..*-- 



354 
261 
239 
284 
256 
352 
159 
93 
283 
253 
273 
149 
126 
300 
336 
370 
377 
88 
96 
275 
201 
345 
376 
214 
252 
241 
106 
360 
218 
223 
397 
319 



[405 ] 



Oft 3TfcI ^IZ «IR 

"IHt ^fft 4 1 ? ^ ^RI 

4^ tp "TT^ M*F1 31B 
*?fol 3R^*«^ 

. . r .-, ■ , , , -r ■-. _ii ■. -_,- £ 

SR 5 ! ^T TTT Tfl *H "tf 
*R *TC fo 3flTtft "TRi 

*Fl T. 3*ff ^H 3*f Wlrti 
■g-fflfoiT WH jp §i5|WK 

^f^N ^rqfir j<gni 
■"fa ^ ^w TFt f^=i Tra 

^ ^1 TT>T$ ^N 3fT ^i=n 

Ti^n*^ ^iFi wz ^ *ra t} 
ti^imh! ^n ttt ^ arra 

TTOST^Pft MTf IT &J "5IT3 *f 

Trare^nft "=1^, trr^ci ^ ~$q "=jr ^ft 
Tivn^Fft to "^tot tmwwi 



148 

186 

333 

271 

353 

237 

355 

134 

298 

27 

267 

367 

344 

282 

279 

268 

394 

267 

194 

53 

270 

126 

292 

280 

69 

95 

146 

37 

42 

40 

63 

118 



[ 406 ] 



TR TR "^ jp? 3?RR 

^?r ~^n -^j^ fwsr i 

7F%. f^RT T3RT "*Tt 3T9T 
3F5^ WT ^fa Tpfl ^1 5$C£ 

wfj? ^i "tr ■5^ 

TZPJF WfaT tt WCt 

-mm wm ^a far **R 

Jgsl TPJF 3RH t^Z sSRT 

m ft 'ff®i "^ t?^[ rtr 

"SB ^ ■'H 3R?^ ^=t 

^3 3R ^^ TR VI ?IR 

~^si sr tr^ irfF Ra *irt 
■gR ^r -m «**i<ril tr 

*S$R 3?ra "^ft OTRt *-HT 
"S£R S?ra cRt ^PR *p *iR 

^Sl ^, W "=! "^ *R "TR 

^pf 1, ^3 ^" fR 7 ' I H 8$ 

^§P ^,^3T T# jR ^TFfif 
ijra £R *TR Tt 



76 
162 
266 
362 
302 
211 
202 
209 
2)2 
312 
309 
250 
190 
320 
204 
347 
112 
383 
337 
371 
213 
374 
152 
135 
374 
331 
253 
260 
255 
370 
259 
329 
340 



[407 ] 

^ra "wal 3?r ^rra siRfft 131 

•gra *n W3 ^ 330 

"^a "H*I WJP MtWfl I TT ^ 334 

^N WI ^a^r ifa 382 

"*jf 3JRM ^Jt W£ ^ "T^ 39fi 

#33 ^?T ^^f 3H^ SIKfi 299 

"Fftll iH ^El ^ ^ 286 

wft *pfr FRfift f^rat 166 

t&ft ^RR 1 ft^ ^ ~<ti% 372 

&Fft wft $£ 3fk ^pft 373 

fa ^7 q^tfT TH ^f ^ffi 257 

f^PRRRI 385 

t'^p'.Ti H ^R m. snf^f ^ pR 394 

* ttct gq irfa a# «nrfr 116 

t wrat are ■gF * tuft w^rr 258 



INDEX OF 
THE OPENING SENTENCES OF SHABDS 



Page 

Adopt Guru (Spiritual Guide) after thorough search. Nobody 

finds the right path without Guru 304 

After wandering through crores of lives, you have now got 

this human form, which is a rare asset 292 

A loud roar is audible within 369 

Among your associates and companions none is a friend 268 

Apply your Surat to Dhun 376 

Arise and awake, my dear, I say this for thy good 322 

Ascend to Gagan (sky, heaven) peep through and enter 

the latticed screen 364 

Awake! leave the world 273 

Be afraid of death day and night 270 

Be gentle of disposition and compassionate at heart, and 

seek Parmarth 379 

Beware, Jama has spread his net, and Kal has put his 

wheel in motion 354 

Blessed is my darling Shabd 201 

By associating with Sat Guru, Surat washes her mind 334 

By the Daya (grace) of Radhasoami, a spark of love has 

been kindled in my heart 147 

Cling fast to the Holy Feet of Guru, and associate with 

Him. 307 

Collect your mind at the third Til, and take your seat in 

Sahas-dal-kanwal 149 



[409 ] 

Come along my friend. I will today unite you with the 
Beloved and enable you to give up attachment for 
body, mind and riches 351 

Come along, O Surat, to the Guru's place, where there is 

neither body nor any activity nor pain and anguish 263 

Come my dear companions, let us sing Arti 32 

Conduct yourself cautiously and prudently in the world 280 

Conform to the Mauj (Will) of Guru. Comply with the 

pleasure of Guru, dear friend 314 

Connect your Surat with the Holy Name (Nam) 283 

Curb the mind and control brutish tendencies 344 

Darso (desirous of Darshan of the Lord) sings his Arti 140 

Devote yourself every moment to Shabd 211 

Do not find faults with others 267 

Do what Sat Guru orders you to do. Follow not the dictates 

of your mind. 312 

Enshrine the form of Guru in your heart. Utter the Name 

of Guru every moment 306 

Ever since the advent of Radhasoami into this world, He 

has been preaching the Holy Word RADHASOAMI 69 

Fear and regard for the world mar progress, and attachment 

for the world is a noose 266 

Give up the fear and regard for the world 239 

Guru and Guru alone do I keep in my heart 167 

Guru declares that the whole world is blind and ignorant 339 

Guru enjoins upon you to attach and apply yourself to 

Anhad Shabd 363 

Guru explains to me how to perform Arti 182 

Guru is my life and breath 187 

Guru repeatedly enjoins upon you : Reconcile your mind 
and devote yourself to Sumiran (repetition) of 
RADHASOAMI Nam 290 

He alone is Guru, who is attached to Shabd (spiritual 

sound) 243 



[ 410 ] 

Hearken me, and come along 358 

Hear the discourses of Guru. Attend Satsang carefully. 

381 
He who sets fire to his house, merges in the cool sea 

248 

How am I to be awakened from the world? Moh (attachment) 

has now tied me tightly 284 

How far should I go on depicting the crookedness of 

Mana (Mind) ? 226 

How foolish I am that I give up the Darshan of Guru and 

go back to my house to attend household duties? 194 

I am gazing at the countenance of the perfect Guru and 

enjoying the bliss of love 96 

I am the darling of Radhasoami 53 

I ask you, how do you claim to be a Sadh? 300 

I experienced the bliss of Nam, in the company of Guru 223 

I have implanted the Holy Feet of Guru in my heart 137 

I have met the Guru who is the bestower of Param Pad 

(Highest Abode) 174 

I have today made preparations for Arti. Announcement 

has been made in the city of Prem (Love) 123 

I hymn a song of Arti. Radhasoami has become gracious 

upon me 142 

I look at a wonderful city 106 

Indescribable, infnite, unfathomable and Anami is my 

beloved RADHASOAMI 43 

I now perform Arti of Sat Guru, I apply my Surat to Shabd 

every moment 178 

I now sing Arti of Sat Guru 115 

In the company of Shabd, withdraw and concentrate 

your spirituality 212 

I pay my obeisance before RADHASOAMI 28 

I perform Arti of my Soami and open the way of salvation 

to my kith and kin 139 

I perform Arti of Radhasoami whole-heartedly with my 

body, mind and Surat 130 



[ 411 ] 

I sacrifice myself at the Darshan of Guru 97 
I sacrifice myself at the Holy Feet of my Guru, who has 

enabled me to behold Jyoti (flame) within me. 183 

I will perform Arti of Guru 180 

It is all happiness within me 112 

It went ahead catching hold of the sound 398 

Kal has badly beguiled the world 196 

Know ye, that Shabd is the beginning and the end of all 205 

Let me use the dust of the Feet of Guru as collyrium 193 

Listen to Anhad Shabd 337 
Listen to me. I give out the attributes of RADHASOAMI 

NAM 40 

Listen to the Dhun of Nam and ponder over it 360 

Lo! The whole world is drifting 275 
Love for the Nij Rup (Real Form) of Sat Guru pervades my 

heart 398 

Mind my words. Hear attentively what I say 276 
Moved by the pangs of separation from the Beloved, 

peep through the latticed screen 254 

My brother ! I am going to define Nam (Name) 218 

My brother! Listen to the importance of Bhakti (devotion) 237 

My dear ! Do not be deceived on coming in this world 241 

My dear, Seek Sat Guru, He is a rare jewel in the world. 250 

My joy is unbounded today 177 

My love for Guru has grown very intense 175 

My noble friend, curbing the vagaries of the mind, come 

to the Satsang of the Guru 317 

My Radhasoami is a profound ocean of serenity which 

none can fathom 118 

Now apply your Surat to Shabd 213 

Now attend Satsang Carefully 254 

O bride (Surat) ! Live in the company of your Beloved 377 



[ 412 ] 

O brother! Make for your true and real home. Why stay 

in an allien land 345 

O Chhabili (handsome darling)! Steady your Surat and be 

delighted, 374 

O dear brother! I tell you now how to awaken the dormant 

mind 287 

O dear! Perform Dhyan of Guru. You cannot be liberated 

without it 326 

O friend ! Follow now the guidance of Guru and keep off 

from the path of Mana (mind) every moment 258 

O friend ! Listen, I explain to you how to perform Arti, in 

clear terms 298 

O friend ! Raise your Surat to Gagan, and be free from all 

fears, doubts and misgivings 382 

O Guiyan ! Guru is imparting proper understanding 184 

O Guru ! I am enamoured of Thy Darshan 394 

O Hansani (Surat)! Separate milk from water 373 

O Hansani (Surat)! Why do you drink water ' 372 

O mind, Get dyed in the colour of love of Sat Guru, Do 

not make friend with anyone else 313 

O mind ! Leave this region of pain and pleasure 273 

O mind ! Look at the world, What is it worth ? 348 

O mind ! What makes you proud ? 282 

O my Bhonra like mind ! Gaze at the lotus eyes of Guru 319 

O my brother ? Perform Bhakti and engender love for 

Radhasoami 353 

O my darling ! Adopt the Saran of Guru so that the toll 

of Karams be paid off -jgg 

O my dear companion ! Radhasoami has graciously made 

me His own 76 

O my friend ! Do something to do good to your soul 3-16 

O my mind ! Go to Guru-ghat, and get the sheet of your 

Surat washed clean 335 



[413 ] 

O nightingale ! Recognise the flower garden, where a 

great variety of flowers are blossoming 375 

On reaching the Arsh, I saw light 395 

Open the door. Come to the balcony 362 

O Premi (lover) ! Hearken what I say about Prem (love) 186 

O Radhasoami ! Deliverer and Liberator of the fallen ! 

Thou art my sole prop and support 162 

O Radhasoami ! I beseech Thee with folded hands to 

hear my prayer 161 

O Radha ! Your status is most sublime. O 

Soami! Your Dham (Abode) is Apar (infinite). 

Radhasoami has taken me in His lap 116 

O Sajni ! Discard the current of world, do not drift in it. 370 

O Sakhi (friend) ! Come and take your seat in the palace 383 

O Sakhi (friend) ! Congratulate me heartily. My heart is 

now overflowing with bliss 88 

O Sakhi (friend) ! This day is very auspicious. I have 

resolved to perform the Arti of Radhasoami 120 

O Soami ! I pray Thee. Listen to my prayer 166 

O Surat ! Adopt Nam 375 

O Surat ! Ascend quickly to Gagan 370 

O Surat ! Ascend to the alley of Gagan 366 

O Surat ! Be dyed in the colour of Nam and ascend to 

higher regions 371 

O Surat! Darling of Sat Guru ! Turn and hear the incessant 

reverberations of Shabd 365 

O Surat ! Hear me, I tell you for your own good. Do not 

get drowned with the foolish mind 257 

O Surat ! Hear me. Your Lord dwells high above 330 

O Surat ! I know you are unhappy here, since the very 

moment you parted company with Shabd and engendered 
friendship with the mind 259 

O Surat! Listen to Dhun (Shabd, sound). Give up pleasures 

of the world, which are worthless 329 



[414 ] 

O Surat ! Wake up. Make no delay 352 
O Surat ! What folly is this on your part that you are 

going astray in the company of the mind? 260 

O Surat ! Who are you and whence have you come? 253 

O Surat ! Why do you not listen to the Dhun of Nam? 255 
O Surat ! Why have you become mad? Your life is being 

uselessly spent 331 

O Surat ! You have had enough sleep 256 

O traveller ! Beware, swindlers spread their nets 267 

O Virahni (sick at heart)! Take Saran of your Guru 333 

Perform Arti of Radhasoami with love and affection 148 

Perform Bhajan and be happy within 355 

Play the game of Kabaddi in your Ghat 375 

Proceed carefully. The world is a place of fraud and deception 347 

Proceed carefully, this world is a snare 265 

Radhasoami has assumed human form in this world 37 

Radhasoami has revealed the Name RADHASOAMI 63 

RADHASOAMI Nam whoever recites, gets across the 

ocean of life 42 

Radhasoami, who dwells in Sat Lok and Radhasoami 

Dham and Anami Pad, is awakening the Jivas 159 

Relying on the grace and mecry of Guru, grasp Shabd 

firmly 207 

Rub and pulverize your mind within 367 

Seek the Beloved within yourself 289 

Shabd has created the three worlds 203 

Surat is drifting in mid-stream. Who else except Guru 

can ferry it across 349 

Surat separated from Dhun (Shabd) 252 

Surat today sets out for performing the Arti of Guru 152 

Take your seat at the third Til and have Guru's 

Darshan there 98 



[415 ] 

The darling devotee, who has reliance and trust on the 

Guru alone, resolves to perform Arti 156 

The Holy Feet of Guru are enshrined in my heart 188 

The mind is now delighted to hear Anhad Shabd 

resounding in Gagan 216 

The relationship between Guru and Chela, as is 

prevailing in the world, is all hypocritical 249 

The seeker Surat ascended beyond Gagan 93 

The Surat does not ascend. What should be done? So 
long as it does not quit the body, you will remain 
in grief 340 

The Surat Sakhi today performs Arti 131 

The vicious mind is after me. How can I get rid of it? 286 

The world is pitch dark and the body is full of evil. 261 

This Arti has been composed by Surat-dasi who is a 

current from the ocean of Prem (Love) 126 

This Sewak (servant) of Thy Holy Feet sings Arti 

(prayer) 100 

Thou art the lamp and I am a moth 126 
Throw away Lobh (greed, avarice). Crush Kam (desire, 

Passion) 362 

Today I am in a state of supreme exhilaration 91 

Today I am performing a grand Arti 102 

Today I have come under the Saran (protection and 

care) of Guru. My joy knows no bounds. 191 

Today I perform Arti of Sat Guru and dedicate my 

body and mind to Him 144 

Today I pray to Radhasoami to accomplish my task 

and protect my honour 165 

Today I sing the praises of Radhasoami in profound 

thankfulness 89 

Today it is all happiness as all are ready for 

performing the ceremony of Arti 128 

Today I will have Darshan of Radhasoami 95 



[416 ] 

Today my heart is filled with great enthusiasm 151 

Today my Surat eagerly attaches itself to the Holy feet 

of the Guru 135 

Turn and look within yourself 336 

Unique is the path shown by the Guru 109 

Utter the Name of Sat Guru. Enshrine Sat Guru in 

your heart 309 

We know Guru will redeem us 341 

What are you thinking about, my dear? Why do you 
not perform Arti ? You will not get such an 
opportunity again 299 

When one begins to hear Shabd, one's mind is 

brought under control 214 

Who else but the Guru will emancipate you ? Who 

else but the Nam will reform you ? 327 

Why do you not take the Saran of Guru ? Your human 

life is being wasted in delusions 342 

Why do you remain entangled in the world ? 277 

Why do you wander deluded in the world ? 259 

With every surging waves of love, I sing Arti 134 

Without Guru, you can never be redeemed. Without 
Nam, you can never secure the salvation of your 
soul 328 

Without Shabd, the whole world is groping in the dark 209 

Worship Guru every moment. There is no deity equal 

to Him 30£ 

You are blessed with the human form. Do something 

for your real good 27S 

You are tied to gross bondages 271 

You have been attending Satsang for long. It is now 

high time that you give up your old habits 32( 

You have not practised Shabd. Then how can you 

know the Reality ? 30;